0% found this document useful (0 votes)
3K views311 pages

GE Multilin F650 Instruction Manual

Uploaded by

Tan Phuong Luong
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
3K views311 pages

GE Multilin F650 Instruction Manual

Uploaded by

Tan Phuong Luong
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 311

GE

Grid Solutions

F650 Digital Bay Controller

Instruction Manual
Firmware version: 7.2x
EnerVista F650 Setup version: 7.2x
GE publication code: GEK-113000AD

LISTED

*GEK-113000AD*
© 2016 GE Multilin Inc. All rights reserved.
GE Multilin F650 Feeder Protection System instruction manual for revision AD.

F650 Feeder Protection System, EnerVista, and EnerVista 650 family


Setup are registered trademarks of GE Multilin Inc.
The contents of this manual are the property of GE Multilin Inc.
This documentation is furnished on license and may not be reproduced in
whole or in part without the permission of GE Multilin. The content of
this manual is for informational use only and is subject to change without notice.

Part number: GEK-113000-AD (March 2016)


TABLE OF CONTENTS

1. GETTING STARTED 1.1 IMPORTANT PROCEDURES


1.1.1 CAUTIONS AND WARNINGS ........................................................................... 1-1
1.1.2 INSPECTION CHECKLIST ................................................................................ 1-4
1.1.3 SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS ................................................................................. 1-6
1.2 OVERVIEW
1.2.1 INTRODUCTION TO 650 FAMILY OF RELAYS ............................................... 1-8
1.2.2 HARDWARE ARCHITECTURE ......................................................................... 1-8
1.2.3 SOFTWARE ARCHITECTURE........................................................................ 1-10
1.2.4 COMMUNICATIONS ARCHITECTURE .......................................................... 1-10
1.3 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE
1.3.1 SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS ............................................................................ 1-12
1.3.2 INSTALLATION................................................................................................ 1-12
1.3.3 CONNECTING ENERVISTA 650 SETUP WITH F650 .................................... 1-16
1.4 650 HARDWARE
1.4.1 MOUNTING & WIRING .................................................................................... 1-18
1.4.2 650 COMMUNICATIONS................................................................................. 1-18
1.4.3 FACEPLATE DISPLAY .................................................................................... 1-19
1.4.4 MAINTENANCE ............................................................................................... 1-19

2. PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.1 OVERVIEW


2.1.1 F650 OVERVIEW............................................................................................... 2-1
2.2 SUMMARY
2.2.1 ANSI DEVICE NUMBERS AND FUNCTIONS ................................................... 2-2
2.2.2 OTHER DEVICE FUNCTIONS ......................................................................... 2-3
2.3 ORDERING CODE
2.4 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
2.4.1 PROTECTION ELEMENTS ............................................................................... 2-6
2.4.2 CONTROL........................................................................................................ 2-16
2.4.3 MONITORING .................................................................................................. 2-20
2.4.4 USER-PROGRAMMABLE ELEMENTS ........................................................... 2-22
2.4.5 METERING ...................................................................................................... 2-23
2.4.6 INPUTS ............................................................................................................ 2-24
2.4.7 REAL TIME CLOCK ......................................................................................... 2-26
2.4.8 OUTPUTS ........................................................................................................ 2-26
2.4.9 CONTROL POWER SUPPLY .......................................................................... 2-27
2.4.10 COMMUNICATIONS........................................................................................ 2-27
2.4.11 OPTIC FEATURES .......................................................................................... 2-29
2.4.12 ENVIRONMENTAL CHARACTERISTICS ....................................................... 2-30
2.4.13 PACKAGING AND WEIGHT ............................................................................ 2-30
2.4.14 TYPE TESTS ................................................................................................... 2-30
2.4.15 APPROVALS ................................................................................................... 2-30
2.5 EXTERNAL CONNECTIONS

3. HUMAN INTERFACES. 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE


SETTINGS & ACTUAL 3.1.1 INTRODUCTION................................................................................................ 3-1
3.1.2 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE OVERVIEW ......................................... 3-1
VALUES
3.1.3 MAIN SCREEN .................................................................................................. 3-3
3.1.4 COMMUNICATION MENU ................................................................................ 3-4
3.1.5 FILE MANAGEMENT ......................................................................................... 3-6
3.1.6 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP MENU STRUCTURE .............................................. 3-10
3.1.7 FILE MENU OVERVIEW.................................................................................. 3-11
3.1.8 SETPOINT MENU OVERVIEW ....................................................................... 3-16
3.1.9 ACTUAL VALUES MENU OVERVIEW ............................................................ 3-25
3.1.10 OPERATIONS MENU OVERVIEW.................................................................. 3-28
3.1.11 COMMUNICATION MENU OVERVIEW .......................................................... 3-29
3.1.12 SECURITY MENU OVERVIEW ....................................................................... 3-32
3.1.13 VIEW MENU OVERVIEW ................................................................................ 3-32

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 1


TABLE OF CONTENTS

3.1.14 HELP MENU OVERVIEW ................................................................................3-32


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)
3.2.1 DISPLAY...........................................................................................................3-34
3.2.2 FRONT LED INDICATORS ..............................................................................3-35
3.2.3 PUSHBUTTONS...............................................................................................3-35
3.2.4 FRONT PORT AND COVER SEALING SYSTEM............................................3-37
3.2.5 TEXT MENUS...................................................................................................3-38
3.2.6 GRAPHIC DISPLAY .........................................................................................3-57
3.3 WEB SERVER
3.3.1 HOME ...............................................................................................................3-66
3.3.2 SNAPSHOT EVENTS.......................................................................................3-67
3.3.3 CONTROL EVENTS .........................................................................................3-68
3.3.4 ALARMS ...........................................................................................................3-69
3.3.5 OSCILLOGRAPHY ...........................................................................................3-70
3.3.6 FAULT REPORT ..............................................................................................3-71
3.3.7 DATA LOGGER ................................................................................................3-72
3.3.8 METERING .......................................................................................................3-73

4. SECURITY 4.1 ADDING USERS


4.1.1 USER RIGHTS ...................................................................................................4-1
4.2 CHANGING PASSWORDS
4.3 ENABLING SECURITY
4.4 LOGING INTO ENERVISTA 650 SETUP

5. BOOTCODE AND 5.1 INTRODUCTION


FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5 COMMUNICATION PARAMETERS
5.2 BOOTWARE UPGRADE
5.3 FIRMWARE VERSION UPGRADE
5.3.1 INTRODUCTION ..............................................................................................5-14
5.3.2 FIRMWARE UPGRADE ...................................................................................5-14
5.4 SUMMARY OF MAIN STEPS
5.4.1 BOOT CODE UPGRADE (*).............................................................................5-24
5.4.2 FIRMWARE UPGRADE (*)...............................................................................5-24

6. COMMISSIONING 6.1 VISUAL INSPECTION


6.2 OUT OF SERVICE SETTING
6.3 GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS ON THE POWER SUPPLY NETWORK
6.4 ISOLATION TESTS
6.5 INDICATORS
6.6 POWER SUPPLY TESTING
6.7 COMMUNICATIONS
6.8 VERIFICATION OF MEASUREMENT
6.8.1 VOLTAGES ........................................................................................................6-8
6.8.2 PHASE CURRENTS...........................................................................................6-8
6.8.3 ACTIVE, REACTIVE POWER, AND COSJ METERING ....................................6-9
6.8.4 FREQUENCY .....................................................................................................6-9
6.9 INPUTS AND OUTPUTS
6.9.1 DIGITAL INPUTS..............................................................................................6-11
6.9.2 CONTACT OUTPUTS ......................................................................................6-12
6.9.3 CIRCUIT CONTINUITY SUPERVISION INPUTS.............................................6-12

2 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


TABLE OF CONTENTS

6.9.4 LATCHING CIRCUITS ..................................................................................... 6-12


6.10 CONNECTIONS FOR TESTING PROTECTION ELEMENTS
6.11 INSTANTANEOUS OVERCURRENT (50PH, 50PL, 50N, 50G Y 50SG)
6.12 TIME OVERCURRENT (51PH, 51PL, 51N, 51G AND 46)
6.13 DIRECTIONAL ELEMENTS (67P, 67N, 67G, 67SG)
6.13.1 67P ELEMENT................................................................................................. 6-16
6.13.2 67N ELEMENT................................................................................................. 6-16
6.13.3 67G ELEMENT ................................................................................................ 6-18
6.13.4 67SG ELEMENT .............................................................................................. 6-19
6.14 UNDERVOLTAGE ELEMENTS (27P, 27X)
6.14.1 27P ELEMENT................................................................................................. 6-20
6.14.2 27X ELEMENT................................................................................................. 6-20
6.15 OVERVOLTAGE ELEMENTS (59P, 59X, 59NH, 59NL, 47)
6.15.1 59P ELEMENT................................................................................................. 6-21
6.15.2 59X ELEMENT................................................................................................. 6-21
6.15.3 59NH AND 59NL ELEMENTS ......................................................................... 6-22
6.15.4 47 ELEMENT - NEG SEQ OV ......................................................................... 6-23
6.16 FREQUENCY ELEMENTS (81O/81U)
6.17 RECLOSER (79)
6.17.1 RECLOSING CYCLE ....................................................................................... 6-25
6.17.2 RECLOSER STATUS ...................................................................................... 6-26
6.17.3 EXTERNAL RECLOSE INITIATION ................................................................ 6-26
6.18 THERMAL IMAGE ELEMENT (49)

7. FREQUENTLY ASKED 7.1 COMMUNICATIONS


QUESTIONS 7.2 PROTECTION
7.3 CONTROL AND HMI
7.4 RELAY CONFIGURATION

8. F650TROUBLESHOOTING 8.1 SYMPTOMS AND RECOMMENDED ACTIONS


GUIDE

A. LOGIC OPERANDS A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

B. FACTORY DEFAULT B.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS


CONFIGURATION B.2 FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATION

C. FACTORY DEFAULT LOGIC C.1 FACTORY DEFAULT LOGIC

D. MISCELLANEOUS DI.1 GE MULTILIN WARRANTY

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3


TABLE OF CONTENTS

4 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


1 GETTING STARTED 1.1 IMPORTANT PROCEDURES

1 GETTING STARTED 1.1IMPORTANT PROCEDURES


Use this chapter for initial setup of your new F650 Feeder Protection Relay.
1
1.1.1 CAUTIONS AND WARNINGS

To help ensure years of trouble free operation, please read through the following chapter for information to help guide you
through the initial installation procedures of your new relay.
Before attempting to install or use the relay, it is imperative that all warnings and cautions in this manual are reviewed to
help prevent personal injury, equipment damage, and/or downtime.
The following safety and equipment symbols are used in this document.

Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.

Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.

Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in minor or moderate injury.

Indicates practices not related to personal injury.

a) GENERAL CAUTIONS AND WARNINGS


The following general safety precautions and warnings apply.

Ensure that all connections to the product are correct so as to avoid accidental risk of shock
and/or fire, for example such as can arise from high voltage connected to low voltage
terminals.
Follow the requirements of this manual, including adequate wiring size and type, terminal torque settings, voltage, current
magnitudes applied, and adequate isolation/clearance in external wiring from high to low voltage circuits.
Use the device only for its intended purpose and application.
Ensure that all ground paths are uncompromised for safety purposes during device operation and service.
Ensure that the control power applied to the device, the AC current, and voltage input match the ratings specified on the
relay nameplate. Do not apply current or voltage in excess of the specified limits.
Only qualified personnel are to operate the device. Such personnel must be thoroughly familiar with all safety cautions and
warnings in this manual and with applicable country, regional, utility, and plant safety regulations.
Hazardous voltages can exist in the power supply and at the device connection to current transformers, voltage
transformers, control, and test circuit terminals. Make sure all sources of such voltages are isolated prior to attempting work
on the device.
Hazardous voltages can exist when opening the secondary circuits of live current transformers. Make sure that current
transformer secondary circuits are shorted out before making or removing any connection to the current transformer (CT)
input terminals of the device.
For tests with secondary test equipment, ensure that no other sources of voltages or currents are connected to such
equipment and that trip and close commands to the circuit breakers or other switching apparatus are isolated, unless this is
required by the test procedure and is specified by appropriate utility/plant procedure.
When the device is used to control primary equipment, such as circuit breakers, isolators, and other switching apparatus,
all control circuits from the device to the primary equipment must be isolated while personnel are working on or around this
primary equipment to prevent any inadvertent command from this device.
Uses an external disconnect to isolate the mains voltage supply.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 1-1


1.1 IMPORTANT PROCEDURES 1 GETTING STARTED

1 LED transmitters are classified as IEC 60825-1 Accessible Emission Limit (AEL) Class 1M. Class
1M devices are considered safe to the unaided eye. Do not view directly with optical instruments.

This product is rated to Class A emissions levels and is to be used in Utility, Substation Industrial
environments. Not to be used near electronic devices rated for Class B levels.

Figure 1–1: FRONT VIEW OF F650 UNITS

1-2 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


1 GETTING STARTED 1.1 IMPORTANT PROCEDURES

1.1.1.1 COMMUNICATION BOARDS WITHDRAWAL / INSERTION

1
MODULE WITHDRAWAL AND INSERTION SHALL ONLY BE PERFORMED BY
DULY QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL. FOR PERSONAL SECURITY
PURPOSES, BEFORE ACCOMPLISHING ANY WITHDRAWAL OR INSERTION
OPERATION, THE RELAY MUST BE POWERED OFF AND ALL THE REAR
TERMINALS MUST BE POTENTIAL FREE. THE RELAY MUST BE GROUNDED
USING THE REAR GROUNDING SCREW.

The modular design of the relayallows for the withdrawal and insertion of the communication module.
Figure 1–2: shows the location of communication modules on the rear part of the relay. Qualified personnel must carry out
the insertion or extraction of the communication boards only after interrupting the relay auxiliary voltage and ensuring that
all the rear terminals are potential free.
Communication boards are installed on the rear of the unit, the upper port being reserved for the asynchronous
communications board and CAN, and the lower port for the ETHERNET board in any of its configurations.

Before performing any of these actions, control power must be removed from the relay and all the rear terminals must be
potential free. A grounded antistatic wristband must be used when manipulating the module in order to avoid
electrostatic discharges that may cause damage to the electronic components.
WITHDRAWAL: Loosen the small screws that keep the faceplate in place and extract the module.
INSERTION: Insert the module and press it firmly in the case, until it is completely fixed. After this, bolt the faceplate
screws and replace the control power. Check that the relay is fully operative.

Figure 1–2: MODULE WITHDRAWAL/INSERTION

GE Multilin will not be responsible for any damage of the relay, connected equipment or personnel whenever
these safety rules are not followed.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 1-3


1.1 IMPORTANT PROCEDURES 1 GETTING STARTED

1.1.1.2 MAGNETIC MODULE TERMINALS

1 The transformer module for the VTs and CTs is already connected to a female connector screwed to the case. The current
inputs incorporate shorting bars, so that the module can be extracted without the need to short-circuit the currents
externally. It is very important, for safety reasons not to change or switch the terminals for CTs and VTs.

Figure 1–3: REAR VIEW OF F650 UNIT

GE Multilin will not be responsible for any damage of the relay, connected equipment or personnel
whenever these safety rules are not followed.

1-4 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


1 GETTING STARTED 1.1 IMPORTANT PROCEDURES

1.1.2 INSPECTION CHECKLIST

1. Unwrap the relay and inspect the relay for physical damage. 1
2. View the nameplate and verify that the correct model has been ordered and delivered. The model number is at the top.

Figure 1–4: IDENTIFICATION LABEL (A4454P6)

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 1-5


1.1 IMPORTANT PROCEDURES 1 GETTING STARTED

1 Please ensure that you received the following items with your relay:
• Mounting screws for fixing the relay to a cabinet
• GE EnerVista™ DVD (includes the EnerVista 650 Setup software and manuals in PDF format)
• Wiring diagram.
• Certificate of Compliance
For product information, instruction manual updates, and the latest software updates, please visit the GE Multilin Home
Page: http://www.gegridsolutions.com/index.htm

New Note: If there is any physical damage detected on the relay, or any of the contents listed are missing, please
contact GE Multilin immediately at:

EUROPE, MIDDLE EAST AND AFRICA:


GE
Grid Solutions
Av. Pinoa, 10
48170 Zamudio, Vizcaya (SPAIN)
Tel.: (34) 94-485 88 54, Fax: (34) 94-485 88 38
E-mail: [email protected]

AMERICA, ASIA AND AUSTRALIA:


GE
Grid Solutions
650 Markland Street
Markham, Ontario
Canada L6C 0M1
Tel.: +1 905 927 7070, Fax: +1 905 927 5098
E-mail: [email protected]

The information provided herein is not intended to cover all the details of the variations of the
equipment, nor does it take into account the circumstances that may be present in your
installation, operating or maintenance activities.

Should you wish to receive additional information, or for any particular problem that cannot be solved by referring to the
information contained herein, please contact GENERAL ELECTRIC, GRID SOLUTIONS.

1-6 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


1 GETTING STARTED 1.1 IMPORTANT PROCEDURES

1.1.3 SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS

The F650 ground screw shown in Figure 1–5: must be correctly grounded. 1

Figure 1–5: LOCATION OF GROUNDING SCREW

Before communicating with a F650 unit through the front USB port, please ensure that the computer's power supply is
grounded. In case of using a laptop, it is recommended not to have it connected to its power supply.
In many cases it might not be correctly grounded either due to the power supply or to the connector cables used.
GE Multilin will not be responsible for any damage to the relay or connected equipment whenever this elemental safety rule
is not followed.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 1-7


1.1 IMPORTANT PROCEDURES 1 GETTING STARTED

1.1.3.1 GENERAL SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS

1
• Failure to practice safe working procedures is likely to damage the equipment, cause severe injury and/or death.
• The use of appropriate safety gloves, safety glasses and protective clothing are recommended during equipment
installation, maintenance and service of the equipment.
• All procedures must be strictly adhered to.
• Failure to observe and follow the instructions provided in the equipment manual(s) could cause irreversible damage to
the equipment and could lead to property damage, personal injury and/or death.
• Before attempting to use the equipment, it is important that all danger and caution indicators are reviewed.
• If the equipment is used in a manner not specified by the manufacturer or functions abnormally, proceed with caution.
Otherwise, the protection provided by the equipment may be impaired and can result in Impaired operation and injury.
• Beware of potential hazards, wear personal protective equipment and carefully inspect the work area for tools and
objects that may have been left inside the equipment.
• Caution: Hazardous voltages can cause shock, burns or death.
• Test/Installation/Service personnel must be familiar with general device test practices, safety precautions and follow
standard ESD precautions to avoid personal injury or equipment damage.
• Before performing visual inspections, tests, or periodic maintenance on this device or associated circuits, isolate or
disconnect all hazardous live circuits and sources of electric power.
• Failure to shut equipment power off prior to removing the power connections could expose you to dangerous voltages
causing injury or death.
• All recommended equipment that should be grounded must have a reliable and un-compromised grounding path for
safety purposes, protection against electromagnetic interference and proper device operation.
• Equipment grounds should be bonded together and connected to the facility's main ground system for primary power.
• Keep all ground leads as short as possible.
• At all times, equipment ground terminal must be grounded during device operation.
• While the equipment manual may suggest several safety and reliability steps, safety precautions must be used in
conjunction with the safety codes in force at your location.
• LED transmitters are classified as IEC 60825-1 Accessible Emission Limit (AEL) Class 1M. Class 1M devices are
considered eye safe to the unaided eye. Do not view directly with optical instruments
• It is the responsibility of the user to check the equipment ratings and installation instructions prior to commissioning,
service.
• Use a lift system with side rails/bucket to reduce a fall hazard as opposed to other means when installing or servicing.
• In addition to the safety precautions mentioned all electrical connections made must respect the applicable local
jurisdiction electrical code.
• Before working on CTs, they must be short-circuited.
• Do not remove the voltage terminal blocks or disconnect the voltage input wires when the voltage phases are live. The
voltage inputs must be de-energized prior to any servicing.

1-8 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


1 GETTING STARTED 1.1 IMPORTANT PROCEDURES

1.1.3.2 WARNING SYMBOLS

The following table explains the meaning of warning symbols that may appear on the device or in this manual
1

The relevant circuit is direct current.


Le circuit principal est à courant continu.
The relevant circuit is alternating current.
Le circuit principal est à courant alternatif.
CAUTION: Refer to the documentation for important operating and maintenance
instructions. Failure to take or avoid a specified action could result in loss of data
! or physical damage.
AVERTISSEMENT: Se réferer à la documentation pour l'entretien et l'utilisation.
L'absence ou èviter de prender des mesures spècifiques peut entraîner des pertes
de données ou même causer des dommages physiques.
WARNING! Dangerous voltage constituting a risk of electric shock is present
within the unit. Failure to take or avoid a specified action could result in physical
harm to the user.
AVERTISSEMENT! Tensions dangereuses comportant un risque de choc électrique
sont presents dans l'equipement. L'absence ou èviter de prender des mesures
spècifiques peut causer des dommages physiques à l'utilisateur.
CAUTION: Class 1M Laser (IEC 60825-1 Safety of laser products)
DO NOT VIEW DIRECTLY WITH OPTICAL INSTRUMENTS.
AVERTISSEMENT: Laser de classe 1M (IEC60825-1) ÉVITER DE REGARDER
DIRECTEMENT LE DISPOSITIF QUI ÉMET LE LASER OPTIQUE.
CAUTION: Hot surface.
AVERTISSEMENT: Surface chaude.

Earth (Ground) Terminal.


Terminal de terre (masse).

Protective Earth Terminal.


Terminal de terre de protection.

Note: Read all instructions included in package before using your product. Additional safety information
Product Safety Supplement document available at; http://www.gegridsolutions.com/ProductSafety/

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 1-9


1.2 OVERVIEW 1 GETTING STARTED

1.2OVERVIEW 1.2.1 INTRODUCTION TO 650 FAMILY OF RELAYS

1 The GE 650 family relay is a new generation of digital and multifunction equipment that is easily incorporated into
automation systems, at both the station and enterprise levels.

1.2.2 HARDWARE ARCHITECTURE

a) F650 BASIC DESIGN


The 650 is a digital-based device containing a central processing unit (CPU) that handles multiple types of input and output
signals. The 650 family can communicate over a local area network (LAN) with an operator interface, a programming
device, or another 650 device.
The CPU module contains firmware that provides protection elements in the form of logic algorithms, as well as
programming logic gates, timers, and latches for control features.
Input Elements accept a variety of analog or digital signals from the field. The 650 isolates and converts these signals into
logic signals used by the relay.
Output Elements convert and isolate the logic signals generated by the relay into digital signals that can be used to control
field devices.

1-10 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


1 GETTING STARTED 1.2 OVERVIEW

Figure 1–6: 650 CONCEPT BLOCK DIAGRAM

b) F650 SIGNAL TYPE


Contact Inputs/Outputs are digital signals.
CT and VT inputs: are signals coming from the inputs of current and voltage transformers, used for monitoring the power
system signals.
CAN Bus Inputs/Outputs: are signals associated to physical input/output contacts from independent modules connected to
the 650 unit via a CAN Bus.
PLC: Programmable Logic Controller. Control module that enables the unit configuration (assignment of inputs/outputs)
and the implementation of logic circuits.
Protection Elements: Relay protection elements, for example: Overcurrent, overvoltage, etc.
Remote inputs and outputs provide a means of sharing digital point state information between remote devices using IEC
61850 GSSE and GOOSE messages.
Analog Inputs are signals associated with transducers.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 1-11


1.2 OVERVIEW 1 GETTING STARTED

1 1.2.3 COMMUNICATIONS ARCHITECTURE

A dedicated serial port is used for communication between the main processor and the human-machine interface. The
serial connection provides great immunity against electromagnetic disturbances, thus increasing system safety.
All 650 units incorporate an RS232 (USB or DB9) serial port on the front of the relay. There is also a possibility to
incorporate up to two additional communication modules on the rear.
One of the modules provides asynchronous serial communications, using different physical media (RS485 + cable remote
CAN bus I/O, plastic or glass fiber optic) depending on the selected model. The module incorporates two identical ports,
COM1 and COM2. The COM2 port is multiplexed with the front port. Additionally, this module may incorporate a port for
CAN BUS communications, used for the connection to the Remote CAN BUS I/O module. This feature allows increasing up
to 100% the I/O capability, when the maximum number of I/Os available inside the relay is not enough for a specific
application. Available options are:
Table 1–1: REAR SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS BOARD 1
BOARD CODE FUNCTIONALITY
F Without additional communication ports
A Two RS485 ports
P Two Plastic F.O. ports
G Two Glass F.O. ports
X Two RS485 ports and a CAN port for remote CAN Bus Inputs/Outputs
Y Two Plastic F.O. ports and a CAN port for remote CAN Bus Inputs/Outputs (fiber)
Z Two Glass F.O. ports and a CAN port for remote CAN Bus Inputs/Outputs (fiber)
C CAN port for remote CAN Bus I/O (cable)
M RS485 + RS485 port and a CAN port for remote CAN bus I/O (cable)

The other module provides Ethernet communications (ETH Port), using 10/100BaseTX (self-negotiable speed) or
100BaseFX connectors, depending on the selected model. The most complete models include a double redundant
100BaseFX fiber optic port. Redundancy is provided at the physical level, for options D and E; the unit incorporates
internally duplicated and independent controllers for extended system reliability and accessibility.
Available Options are:
Table 1–2: REAR ETHERNET COMMUNICATIONS BOARD 2
BOARD CODE FUNCTIONALITY
B One 10/100BaseTX port (self-negotiable speed)
C One 10/100BaseTX port and one 100BaseFX port.
D One 10/100BaseTX port and redundant 100BaseFX ports
E Redundant 10/100BaseTX ports

For options C and D it is required to select the active physical media, by means of an internal selector inside the
module.The factory configuration for this selection is the 10/100BaseTX port. Starting from the version 7.00 the following
options are available.

G 1588, 10/100 Base TX* + 100 Base TX


H 1588, 10/100 Base TX* + 100 Base FX
J PRP, 1588, 10/100 Base TX* + Redundant 100 Base FX
K PRP, HSR, RSTP, 1588, 10/100 Base TX* + Redundant 100 Base FX
L PRP, 1588, 10/100 Base TX + Redundant 100 Base TX
M PRP, HSR, RSTP, 1588, 10/100 Base TX + Redundant 100 Base TX

Finally, internal communication with input and output modules is performed via an internal CAN bus, independent from the
one used for remote CAN BUS I/Os. This fact provides increased communication speed, as well as the possibility of
acknowledgement of modules, abnormalities, etc. As this is a serial port supporting a communications protocol, it provides
extraordinary immunity against external or internal disturbances.

1-12 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


1 GETTING STARTED 1.2 OVERVIEW

CAN COM1 COM2

ETHERNET COMMUNICATIONS

CAN
REMOTE
ETH1 Redundancy I/O
(Optional)

SERIAL
MAIN PROCESSOR COM 1
DIGITAL SUPERVISION
ETH2 ETH3
COMMUNICATION
CONTROL I/O I/O
PROTECTION
CAN I/O
INTERNAL

SERIAL MULTIPLEXED
SERIAL COM 2
DSP COM H
MEASUREMENT
PROCESSOR

ANALOG
SERIAL
INPUTS COM2
COM H
CURENT AC
AND FRONT
VOLTAGE AC HMI HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE SERIAL
PORT

Figure 1–7: COMMUNICATIONS ARCHITECTURE (B6816F2)

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 1-13


1.3 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE 1 GETTING STARTED

1.3ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE 1.3.1 SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS

1 The relay front panel or the EnerVista 650 Setup software can be used to communicate with the relay. The software
interface is the preferred method to edit settings and view actual values because the computer monitor can display more
information.
The minimum system requirements for the EnerVista 650 Setup software are as follows:
• Pentium® 4 (Core Duo recommended).
• Windows® XP with Service Pack 2 (Service Pack 3 recommended), Windows 7, or Windows Server 2008 Release 2
64-bit.
• 1 GB of RAM (2 GB recommended).
• 500 MB free hard drive space (1 GB recommended).
• 1024 x 768 display (1280 x 800 recommended).
• RS232C and USB serial and/or Ethernet port for communications to the relay.

1.3.2 INSTALLATION

After ensuring the minimum requirements for using EnerVista 650 Setup are met (see previous section), install the software
from the GE EnerVista DVD. Or download the 650 EnerVista software from http://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/ and
install it.

1. Insert the GE EnerVista DVD into the DVD drive of your computer.
2. Click the Install Now button and follow the installation instructions to install the no-charge EnerVista software.
3. When installation is complete, start the EnerVista Launchpad application.
4. Click the IED Setup section of the Launch Pad window.

Figure 1–8: LAUNCHPAD WINDOW

1-14 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


1 GETTING STARTED 1.3 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE

5. In the EnerVista Launch Pad window, click the Add Product button and select the “F650 Bay Controller” relay from the
Install Software window as shown below. Select the “Web” option to ensure the most recent software release, or select
“CD” if you do not have a web connection, then click the Add Now button to list software items for the F650. 1

Figure 1–9: ADD PRODUCT WINDOW

6. EnerVista Launchpad will obtain the installation program from the Web or CD. Once the download is complete, double-
click the installation program to install the EnerVista 650 Setup software.
7. Select the complete path, including the new directory name, where the EnerVista 650 Setup will be installed.
8. Click on Next to begin the installation. The files will be installed in the directory indicated and the installation program
will automatically create icons and add EnerVista 650 Setup to the Windows start menu.
9. Follow the on-screen instructions to install the EnerVista 650 Setup software. When the Welcome window appears,
click on Next to continue with the installation procedure.

Figure 1–10: ENERVISTA 650 SETUP INSTALLATION

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 1-15


1.3 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE 1 GETTING STARTED

10. When the Choose Destination Location window appears, and if the software is not to be located in the default
directory, click Change… and type in the complete path name including the new directory name and click Next to
1 continue with the installation procedure.

Figure 1–11: ENERVISTA 650 SETUP INSTALLATION CONT.

11. The default program group where the application will be added to is shown in the Selected Program Folder window.
Click Next to begin the installation process, and all the necessary program files will be copied into the chosen directory.

Figure 1–12: SELECT PROGRAM FOLDER

12. To finish with the installation process, select the desired language for startup.

1-16 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


1 GETTING STARTED 1.3 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE

Figure 1–13: LANGUAGE WINDOW

13. Click Finish to end the installation. The F650 device will be added to the list of installed IEDs in the EnerVista
Launchpad window, as shown below.

Figure 1–14: ENERVISTA LAUNCHPAD

1.3.3 CONNECTING ENERVISTA 650 SETUP WITH F650

This section is intended as a quick start guide to using the EnerVista 650 Setup software. Please refer to section 4.1 in this
manual for more information about the EnerVista 650 Setup software interface.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 1-17


1.3 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE 1 GETTING STARTED

1 a) CONFIGURING AN ETHERNET CONNECTION


Before starting, verify that the Ethernet network cable is properly connected to the Ethernet port on the back of the relay.
1. Install and start the latest version of the EnerVista 650 Setup software (available from the GE EnerVista DVD or online
from http://www.gegridsolutions.com/index.htm (see previous section for installation instructions).
2. Go to “Communication>Computer” and enter the following data referring to communications:
3. Select Control Type as MODBUS TCP/IP from the drop-down list. This option will display a number of interface
parameters that must be entered for proper Ethernet communications.
4. Enter the relay IP address (from “Setpoint>Product Setup >Communication Settings>Network>IP ADDRESS”) in
the IP Address field in MODBUS TCP/IP SETUP.
5. Enter the relay ModBus address (from “Setpoint>Product Setup >Communication Settings>ModBus
Protocol>ModBus Address COM1/COM2 setting”) in the Unit Identifier (Slave Address) field.
6. Enter the ModBus port address (from “Setpoint>Product Setup >Communication Settings>ModBus
Protocol>ModBus Port Number” setting) in the ModBus Port field.
7. The Device has now been configured for Ethernet communications. Proceed to press the ON button to begin
communicating.

b) CONFIGURING AN RS232 CONNECTION


Before starting, verify that the RS232 serial cable, or the USB Cable, is properly connected to the RS232 port or the USB
port on the front panel of the relay.
1. Install and start the latest version of the EnerVista 650 Setup software (available from the GE EnerVista DVD or online
from http://www.gedigitalenergy.com (see previous section for installation instructions).
2. Go to “Communication>Computer” and enter the following data referred to communications:
3. Select Control Type as No Control Type from the drop-down list. This option will display a number of interface
parameters that must be entered for proper serial communications.
4. Enter the relay Slave Address (“Setpoint>Product Setup >Communication Settings>ModBus Protocol” menu) in
the Slave Address field. The default value is 254.
5. Enter the physical communications parameters (Baudrate and parity settings) from the “Setpoint>Product Setup
>Communication Settings>Serial Ports” menu, in their respective fields. Default values are 19200 for baudrate and
none for parity.
6. The Device has now been configured for RS232 communications. Proceed to press the ON button to begin
communicating.

1-18 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


1 GETTING STARTED 1.4 650 HARDWARE

1.4650 HARDWARE 1.4.1 MOUNTING & WIRING

Please refer to Chapter 3. Hardware for detailed mounting and wiring instructions. 1

1.4.2 650 COMMUNICATIONS

The Enervista 650 Setup software communicates to the relay via the faceplate USB port in hardware 04(E in ordering
code) or RS232port or the rear RS485/Ethernet ports. To communicate via the faceplate , RS232 port, a standard
“straight-through” serial cable is used. The DB-9 male end is connected to the relay and the DB-9 or DB-25 female end is
connected to the PC COM1 or COM2 port as described in Figure 1–15:. To communicate via USB port a male A / male B
USB shielded wire is needed
To communicate through the F650 rear RS485 port from a PC RS232 port, the GE Multilin RS232/RS485 converter box is
required. This device (catalog number F485) connects to the computer using a “straight-through” serial cable. A shielded
twisted-pair (20, 22 or 24 AWG according to American standards; 0.25, 0.34 or 0.5 mm2 according to European standards)
connects the F485 converter to the F650 rear communication port.
In order to minimize communication errors that could be caused by external noise, it is recommended to use a shielded
twist pair. In order to avoid loops where external currents could flow, the cable shield must be grounded only at one end.
The converter box (-, +, GND) terminals are connected to the relay (SDA, SDB, GND) terminals respectively. For long
communications cables (longer than 1 km), the RS485 circuit must be terminated in an RC network (i.e. 120 ohm, 1 nF).
This circuit is shown on Figure 1–16: RS485 CONNECTION FOR 650 UNITS, associated to text Zt(*).

Figure 1–15: RELAY- PC CONNECTION FOR RS232 FRONT PORT


To minimize errors from noise, the use of shielded twisted pair wire is recommended. For correct operation, polarity must
be respected, although a different polarity will not damage the unit. For instance, the relays must be connected with all
RS485 SDA terminals connected together, and all SDB terminals connected together. This may result confusing
sometimes, as the RS485 standard refers only to terminals named “A” and “B”, although many devices use terminals
named “+” and “-“.
As a general rule, terminals “A” should be connected to terminals “-“, and terminals “B” to “+”. The GND terminal should be
connected to the common wire inside the shield, when provided. Otherwise, it should be connected to the shield. Each
relay should also be daisy chained to the next one in the link. A maximum of 32 relays can be connected in this manner

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 1-19


1.4 650 HARDWARE 1 GETTING STARTED

without exceeding driver capability. For larger systems, additional serial channels must be added. It is also possible to use
commercially available repeaters to increase the number of relays on a single channel to more than 32. Do not use other
1 connection configurations different to the recommended.
Lightening strikes and ground surge currents can cause large momentary voltage differences between remote ends of the
communication link. For this reason, surge protection devices are internally provided. To ensure maximum reliability, all
equipment should have similar transient protection devices installed.

Figure 1–16: RS485 CONNECTION FOR 650 UNITS


To communicate through the F650 rear Ethernet port from a PC a crossover cable is required. If the connection is
performed through a hub or a switch, a direct Ethernet cable is required.

1.4.3 FACEPLATE DISPLAY

All messages are displayed on a 20x4 character LCD display. An optional graphic display is also available. Messages are
displayed in different languages according to selected model.

1.4.4 MAINTENANCE

1.4.4.1 GENERAL MAINTENANCE

F650 requires a minimum amount of maintenance when it is commissioned into service. F650 is a microprocessor based
relay and its characteristics do not change over time, as such no further functional tests are required. While the F650
performs continual self-tests, it is recommended that maintenance be scheduled with other system maintenance. This
maintenance can involve in-service, out-of-service, or unscheduled maintenance.

1-20 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


1 GETTING STARTED 1.4 650 HARDWARE

If it is concluded that the relay or one of its modules is of concern, contact GE Multilin or one of its representative for prompt
service. 1

1.4.4.2 IN-SERVICE MAINTENANCE

In-service maintenance:
1. Visual verification of the analog values integrity such as voltage and current (in comparison to other devices on the
corresponding system).
2. Visual verification of active alarms, relay display messages and LED indications.
3. Visual inspection for any damage, corrosion, dust or loose wires.
4. Event recorder file download with further event analysis.

1.4.4.3 OUT-OF-SERVICE MAINTENANCE

Out-of-service maintenance:
1. Check wiring connections for firmness.
2. Analog values (current, voltages, analog inputs) injection test and metering accuracy verification. Calibrated test
equipment is required.
3. Protection elements setpoints verification (analog values injection or visual verification of setting file entries against
relay settings schedule).
4. Contact inputs and outputs verification. This test can be conducted by direct change of state forcing or as part of the
system functional testing.
5. Visual inspection for any damage, corrosion or dust.
6. Event recorder file download with further events analysis.

To avoid deterioration of electrolytic capacitors, power up units that are stored


in a de-energized state once per year, for one hour continuously.

1.4.4.4 UNSCHEDULED MAINTENANCE

Unscheduled maintenance such as during a disturbance causing system interruption:

1. View the event recorder and oscillography or fault report for correct operation of inputs,outputs and elements.

1.4.5 STORAGE

Store the unit indoors in a cool, dry place. If possible, store in the original packaging. Follow the storage temperature range
outlined in the Specifications.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 1-21


1.4 650 HARDWARE 1 GETTING STARTED

1 To avoid deterioration of electrolytic capacitors, power up units that are stored


in a de-energized state once per year, for one hour continuously.

1.4.6 REPAIRS

The firmware and software can be upgraded without return of the device to the factory.
For issues not solved by troubleshooting, the process to return the device to the factory for repair is as follows:
• Contact a GE Grid Solutions Technical Support Center. Contact information is found in the first chapter.
• Obtain a Return Materials Authorization (RMA) number from the Technical Support Center.
• Verify that the RMA and Commercial Invoice received have the correct information.
• Tightly pack the unit in a box with bubble wrap, foam material, or styrofoam inserts or packaging peanuts to cushion
the item(s). You may also use double boxing whereby you place the box in a larger box that contains at least 5 cm of
cushioning material.
• Ship the unit by courier or freight forwarder, along with the Commercial Invoice and RMA, to the factory.
• Fax a copy of the shipping information to the GE Grid Solutions service department.Customers are responsible for
shipping costs to the factory, regardless of whether the unit is under warranty.
Use the detailed return procedure outlined at
https://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/support/ret_proc.htm
The current warranty and return information are outlined at
https://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/warranty.htm

1.4.7 DISPOSAL

The F650 is intended to be part of defective large-scale stationary industrial tools and large-scale fixed installations. This
product cannot be disposed of as unsorted municipal waste in the European Union. For proper recycling return this product
to your supplier or a designated collection point. For more information go to www.recyclethis.info.

1-22 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.1 F650 OVERVIEW

2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.1 F650 OVERVIEW


F650 is a protection, control, monitoring, metering and registering unit, suitable for many different applications, such as
main protection for distribution feeders and transmission lines, as well as backup protection for transformers, busbars,
capacitor banks, etc.
Overvoltage and undervoltage protection, overfrequency and underfrequency protection, breaker failure protection,
directional current supervision fault diagnostics and programmable logic functions are provided.
This relay also provides phase, neutral, ground and sensitive ground, instantaneous and time overcurrent protection. The
time overcurrent function provides multiple curve shapes or FlexCurves™ for optimum co-ordination. Automatic reclosing, 2
synchrocheck, and line fault locator features are also provided.
Voltage, current, power, and energy metering is built into the relay as a standard feature. Current parameters are available
as true RMS magnitude, or as RMS magnitude of fundamental frequency and angle (phasor).
Diagnostic features include a sequence of records. The internal clock used for time-tagging can be synchronized with an
IRIG-B signal or via SNTP, DNP or Modbus protocol over the Ethernet port. Besides this, starting from the version 7.00
IEEE1588 time protocol is also available. The precise time stamping allows the sequence of events to be determined
throughout the system. Oscillography data capture may be set to record the measured parameters before and after the
event for viewing on a personal computer (PC). These tools significantly reduce troubleshooting time and simplify report
generation in the event of a system fault.
A faceplate RS232 or USB port may be used to connect to a PC for the programming of settings and the monitoring of
actual values.
A variety of communications modules are available. Two rear RS485 ports allow independent access by operating and
engineering staff. All serial ports use the Modbus® RTU protocol. Optional communications modules include a 100BaseFX
Ethernet interface which can be used to provide fast, reliable communications in noisy environments.
Another option provides two 100BaseFX fiber optic ports for redundancy. The Ethernet port supports IEC 61850, Modbus®/
TCP, DNP 3.0 and TFTP protocols, and allows access to the relay via any standard web browser. The IEC 60870-5-104
protocol is supported on the Ethernet port. The Ethernet port also supports the Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP) and
High-availability Seamless Redundancy (HSR) of IEC 62439-3 (clause 4 (PRP) and clause 5 (HSR)) for firmware version
7.00 and so on.
Rear port COM1 could be set to support IEC60870-5-103 protocol
The F650 IEDs use flash memory technology which allows field upgrading as new features are added:

Figure 2–1: FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-1


2.2 ANSI DEVICE NUMBERS AND FUNCTIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.2ANSI DEVICE NUMBERS AND FUNCTIONS

DEVICE NUMBER FUNCTION


25 Synchronism Check
27/27X Bus/Line Undervoltage
32 Sensitive Directional Power
32FP Forward Power
2 32N
46
Wattmetric Zero-Sequence Directional
Negative Sequence Time Overcurrent
47 Negative Sequence Voltage
48 Locked Rotor
49 Thermal Image - overload protection
50 BF Breaker Failure
50PH/PL Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent (High/Low)
50N Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent
50G Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent
50SG Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent for sensitive ground systems (measured from 5th current
transformer input)
50IG Isolated Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent (measured from 5th current transformer input)
51N Neutral Time Overcurrent
51G Ground Time Overcurrent
51SG Sensitive Ground Time Overcurrent
51PH/V Voltage Restraint Phase Time Overcurrent
51PL/V Voltage Restraint Phase Time Overcurrent
59/59X Bus/Line Overvoltage
59NH/NL Neutral Overvoltage - High/Low
67P Phase Directional Overcurrent
67SG Sensitive Ground Directional Overcurrent
79 Autoreclose (Four shot recloser)
81 U/O Under/Over Frequency Broken Conductor Detection
N/A Load Encroachment
81R Frequency Rate of Change
VTFF VT Fuse Failure Detection

2-2 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.3 OTHER DEVICE FUNCTIONS

2.3OTHER DEVICE FUNCTIONS


INPUTS/OUTPUTS METERING COMMUNICATIONS
9 Analog Inputs: 5 current inputs (3 for phases, Metering Current for phases, ground and Front RS232 port, USB port in HMI
1 for ground, 1 for sensitive ground), 4 voltage sensitive ground inputs option E, Two rear RS485/fibre optic
inputs (3 for phases, 1 for busbar or auxiliary ports, 10/100 TX and 100 FX Mbps
voltage) Ethernet port
Digital Programmable Contact Inputs (up to 64) Voltages phase to phase and phase to ModBus Communications RTU and
ground over TCP/IP
Digital Programmable Contact Outputs (up to Real, Reactive and Apparent Power and DNP Multimaster (3.0 Level 2)
16)
32 Latched Virtual Inputs
Power Factor
Three Phase Energy IEC 870-5-104
2
32 Self-Reset Virtual Inputs
Virtual Outputs (up to 512) Frequency ModBus User Map
Tripping and closing circuit supervision Sequence components of currents and IEC 61850
voltages
Remote Inputs/Outputs (GSSE and GOOSE Pulse Counters IEC 870-5-103 protocol
messages)
Analog Inputs (dCmA) Analog Comparators
*Digital Counters

*This functionality is available from firmware version 7.00

USER INTERFACE RECORDS OTHERS


Alphanumerical display (4x20) Data Logger Breaking Arcing Current (I2t)
Graphic display (16 x 40) Demand Breaker Control
User Programmable LEDs (15) Event Recorder (up to 128 configurable IRIG-B synchronization/SNTP/
events) IEEE 1588
User Programmable Keys (up to 5) Fault Locator and Fault report (up to 10 Logic Equations (PLC Editor)
records)
Easy menu management Oscillography (up to 20 records) Operations (up to 24)
Configurable One-Line Diagram (Graphic Snapshot Events (up to 512) Web Server Application
model only)
Phasor Diagram (available in EnerVista 650
Setup)

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-3


2.4 ORDERING CODE 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.4 ORDERING CODE


F650 units are supplied as ½ 19” rack, 6 units high, containing the following modules: power supply, CPU, I/O modules,
communication modules. The required information to completely define an F650 model is shown on Table 2–1:
Table 2–1: ORDERING CODE
F650 - - - F - G - - - - - DESCRIPTION
B Basic Display (See note 2)

2 M
N
Graphic Display with Standard Symbols (See note 2)
Graphic Display with IEC symbols (See note 2)
REAR SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS BOARD 1
F None
A Redundant RS485
P Redundant plastic fiber optic
G Redundant glass fiber optic
X Redundant RS485 + fiber remote CAN bus I/O
Y Redundant plastic fiber optic + fiber remote CAN bus I/O
Z Redundant glass fiber optic + fiber remote CAN bus I/O
C Cable Remote CAN Bus I/O
M RS485 + cable Remote CAN Bus I/O
REAR ETHERNET COMMUNICATIONS BOARD 2
B 10/100 Base TX
C 10/100 Base TX + 100 Base FX
D 10/100 Base TX + Redundant 100 Base FX
E Redundant 10/100 Base TX
G 1588, 10/100 Base TX* + 100 Base TX (See Note 3)
H 1588, 10/100 Base TX* + 100 Base FX (See Note 3)
J PRP, 1588, 10/100 Base TX* + Redundant 100 Base FX (See
note4)
K PRP, HSR, RSTP, 1588, 10/100 Base TX* + Redundant 100 Base
FX (See note4)
L PRP, 1588, 10/100 Base TX*+ Redundant 100 Base TX (See note4)
M PRP, HSR, RSTP, 1588, 10/100 Base TX*+ Redundant 100 Base
TX (See note4)
I/O BOARD IN SLOT F
1 16 Digital Inputs + 8 Outputs
2 8 Digital Inputs + 8 Outputs + 2 trip/close circuit supervision circuits
4 32 Digital Inputs
5 16 Digital Inputs + 8 Analog Inputs
I/O BOARD IN SLOT G
0 None
1 16 Digital Inputs + 8 Outputs
4 32 Digital Inputs (see Note 1)
5 16 Digital Inputs + 8 Analog Inputs (See Note 1)
AUXILIARY VOLTAGE
LO 24-48 Vdc (range 19.2 – 57.6)
110-250 Vdc (range 88 – 300).
HI
120-230 Vac (range 96 – 250)
LOR Redundant LO
HIR Redundant HI
LANGUAGE
- English/English
C Chinese/English (See Note 2)
F French/English
P Russian/English (See Note 2)
S Spanish/English

2-4 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.4 ORDERING CODE

T Turkish/English
COMMUNICATION PROTOCOL
- Modbus® RTU, TCP/IP, DNP 3.0 Level 2, IEC 60870-5-104
3 IEC 60870-5-103, Modbus® RTU,TCP/IP
IEC 61850, Modbus® RTU and TCP/IP,DNP 3.0 Level 2,
6 IEC 60870-5-104
ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION
- Without Harsh (Chemical) Environment Conformal Coating
H Harsh (Chemical) Environment Conformal Coating 2
ENHANCED DISPLAY
- Display with RS232
E Enhanced Display with USB

SPECIAL MODELS MOD001 (Abbreviation "+M1"): 6A output contacts instead of 16A.

Notes:
(*) For firmware version 7.00 or above, Port E is intended for maintenance purposes.

(1) The digit selected for option G must be equal or higher than the digit selected for option F for models including boards 4 and 5 only.
F1G5 is a valid selection and F5G1 is and invalid selection.
(2) Display options with language selection:
Graphic display: available for English, French, Spanish and Chinese languages. For Chinese and Russian only IEC symbols
option is available (N in ordering code).
Basic display: available for all languages
(3) Advance functionalities Level I:
G, H: IEEE1588 Precision Time Protocol (PTP), 61850 Edition 2.0. Digital counters. Max numbers of starts and Cold Load
Pick-up functionalities.
(4) Advance functionalities Level II:
J, L: Parallel Redundancy Port (PRP,) IEEE1588 Precision Time Protocol (PTP), 61850 Edition 2.0. Digital counters, DFT, 16
Switchgear mapped in IEC61850, 16 nodes CILO, mapping of BlkOpn and BlkCls leafs of XSWI nodes, Max numbers of starts
and Cold Load Pick-up functionalities.
K, M: High-Availability Seamless Redundancy (HSR), Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol (RSTP), Parallel Redundancy Port (PRP,)
IEEE1588 Precision Time Protocol (PTC), 61850 Edition 2.0. Digital counters, DFT, 16 Switchgear mapped in IEC61850, 16
nodes CILO, mapping of BlkOpn and BlkCls leafs of XSWI nodes, Max numbers of starts and Cold Load Pick-up
functionalities.
(5) For special models requested, relay ordering code shall be codified as a standard model (Table 2-1) following by Abbreviation +
MX where X indicates the number of special model selected.
(6) For non-last released firmware version models requested, relay ordering code shall be codified as standard model (Table 2-1),
following by Abbreviation +VXXXXXBYYYYY where XXXXX is the firmware version requested and YYYYY is the corresponding
bootcode version.

For ordering codes with options: G, H, J, K, L, M, for REAR ETHERNET COMMUNICATIONS BOARD, the display is
always Enhanced “E”. All this models include PTP 1588, and if IEC 61850 is selected the Edition 2 of this protocol will be
served. Chinesse language is not available for these options.

For those applications requiring a high number of inputs and outputs, F650 units can be connected to a CIO module
(Remote CAN Bus I/O module) for using up to 2 additional boards.

F650 units allow monitoring and configuring these I/O boards as if they were internal boards, located on slots F and G. In
this case, slots are labeled as H y J.
The required information to completely define a CIO Module is shown on Table 2–2:.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-5


2.4 ORDERING CODE 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

Table 2–2: ORDERING CODE FOR CIO MODULE

CIO H - J - - DESCRIPTION
I/O BOARD IN SLOT H
1 16 Digital inputs + 8 outputs
2 8 Digital Inputs + 8 Outputs + 2 trip/close circuit supervision circuits
4 32 Digital Inputs
2 5 16 Digital Inputs + 8 Analog Inputs
I/O BOARD IN SLOT J
0 None
1 16 Digital inputs + 8 outputs
4 32 Digital Inputs (See Note 1)
5 16 Digital Inputs + 8 Analog Inputs (See Note 1)
AUXILIARY VOLTAGE
LO 24-48 Vdc (range 19.2 – 57.6)
HI 110-250 Vdc (range 88 – 300)
120-230 Vac (range 96 – 250)
ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION
H Harsh (Chemical) Environment Conformal Coating

(1) The digit selected for option J must be equal or higher than the digit selected for option H for models including boards 4 and 5.
CIOH1J5**: is a valid selection CIOH5J1**: is an invalid selection

2-6 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

2.5TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS ARE SUBJECT TO CHANGE WITHOUT NOTICE

2.5.1 PROTECTION ELEMENTS

Phase and ground units use as operation magnitude the current value received by the unit in current inputs, while the
neutral unit uses the calculated current value from the three phase currents.
The sensitive ground unit will be used only for those applications where the neutral is completely isolated, and it uses the 2
fifth CT of the unit. This CT has a sensitivity that is 10 times higher than the universal model (connected to 1A or 5A
transformers). Therefore, it does not admit such a high permanent overload.

2.5.1.1 PHASE TIME OVERCURRENT (51PH/51PL)

Current Input Phasor (without harmonics) or RMS


Rated current For connection to 1 or 5 A CTs.
Pickup level 0.05 to 160.00 A in steps of 0.01 A
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Level Accuracy Values at nominal frequency:
±0.5% of the reading ± 10 mA from 0.05 to 10 A
±1.5% of the reading for higher values.
Curve Shapes IEEE extremely / very / moderately inverse
IEC A/B/C/long-time inverse/short time inverse curve
IAC extremely / very / moderately inverse
ANSI extremely / very / normally / moderately inverse
I2t
Definite time
Rectifier curve
FlexCurve™ A/B/C/D user curve
Curve Multiplier (Time Dial) 0.00 to 900.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Reset type Instantaneous or time delayed according to IEEE
Timing accuracy Operate at > 1.03 times the pickup ±3% of operate time or
50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Voltage restraint Selectable by setting
Saturation Level 48 times the pickup level
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-7


2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.5.1.2 GROUND TIME OVERCURRENT (51G)

Current Input Phasor (without harmonics) or RMS


Rated current For connection to 1 or 5 A CTs.
Pickup level 0.05 to 160.00 A in steps of 0.01 A
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level

2 Level Accuracy Values at nominal frequency:


±0.5% of the reading ± 10 mA from 0.05 to 10 A
±1.5% of the reading for higher values.
Curve Shapes IEEE extremely / very / moderately inverse
IEC A/B/C/long-time inverse/short time inverse curve
IAC extremely / very / moderately inverse
ANSI extremely / very / normally / moderately inverse
I2t
Definite time
Rectifier curve
FlexCurve™ A/B/C/D user curve
Curve Multiplier (Time Dial) 0.00 to 900.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Reset type Instantaneous or time delayed according to IEEE
Timing accuracy Operate at > 1.03 times the pickup ±3% of operate time or
50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Saturation Level 48 times the pickup level
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.1.3 NEUTRAL TIME OVERCURRENT (51N)

Current Input Fundamental Phasor (without harmonics)


Pickup level 0.05 to 160.00 A in steps of 0.01 A
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Level Accuracy Values at nominal frequency:
±0.5% of the reading ± 10 mA from 0.05 to 10 A
±1.5% of the reading for higher values.
Curve Shapes IEEE extremely / very / moderately inverse
IEC A/B/C/long-time inverse/short time inverse curve
IAC extremely / very / moderately inverse
ANSI extremely / very / normally / moderately inverse
I2t
Definite time
Rectifier curve
FlexCurve™ A/B/C/D user curve
Curve Multiplier (Time Dial) 0.00 to 900.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Reset type Instantaneous or time delayed according to IEEE
Timing accuracy Operate at > 1.03 times the pickup ±3% of operate time or
50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Saturation Level 48 times the pickup level
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2-8 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

2.5.1.4 SENSITIVE GROUND TIME OVERCURRENT (51SG)

Current Input Phasor (without harmonics) or RMS


Rated current For connection to 1 or 5 A CTs.
Pickup level 0.005 to 16.000 A in steps of 0.001 A
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Values at nominal frequency:
Level Accuracy
±1.5% of the reading ± 1 mA from 0.005 to 16 A
2
Curve Shapes IEEE extremely / very / moderately inverse
IEC A/B/C/long-time inverse/short time inverse curve
IAC extremely / very / moderately inverse
ANSI extremely / very / normally / moderately inverse
I2t
Definite time
Rectifier curve
FlexCurve™ A/B/C/D user curve
Curve Multiplier (Time Dial) 0.00 to 900.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Reset type Instantaneous or time delayed according to IEEE
Timing accuracy Operate at > 1.03 times the pickup ±3% of operate time
or 50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Saturation Level 48 times the pickup level
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.1.5 PHASE AND GROUND INSTANTANEOUS OVERCURRENT (50PH/50PL/50G)

Current Input Phasor (without harmonics) or RMS


Rated current For connection to 1 or 5 A CTs.
Pickup level 0.05 to 160.00 A in steps of 0.01 A
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Level Accuracy Values at nominal frequency:
±0.5% of the reading ± 10 mA from 0.05 to 10 A
±1.5% of the reading for higher values
Overreach < 2%
Trip delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s.
Reset delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s.
Operate time <50 ms at 3 x Pickup at 50 Hz, typically
Timing accuracy at 0 ms time delay (no intentional delay): 50ms
at non-zero time delay: ±3% of operate time or 50 ms
(whichever is greater)
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-9


2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.5.1.6 NEUTRAL INSTANTANEOUS OVERCURRENT (50N)

Current Input Fundamental Phasor (without harmonics)


Pickup level 0.05 to 160.00 A in steps of 0.01 A
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Level Accuracy Values at nominal frequency:
±0.5% of the reading ± 10 mA from 0.05 to 10 A
2 ±1.5% of the reading for higher values
Overreach < 2%
Trip delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s.
Reset delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s.
Operate time <50 ms at 3 x Pickup at 50 Hz, typically
Timing accuracy at 0 ms time delay (no intentional delay): 50ms
at non-zero time delay: ±3% of operate time or 50 ms
(whichever is greater)
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.1.7 SENSITIVE GROUND INSTANTANEOUS OVERCURRENT (50SG)

Current Input Phasor (without harmonics) or RMS


Rated current For connection to 1 or 5 A CTs.
Pickup level 0.005 to 16.000 A in steps of 0.001 A
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Level Accuracy Values at nominal frequency:
±1.5% of the reading ± 1 mA from 0.005 to 16 A
Overreach < 2%
Trip delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s.
Reset delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s.
Operate time <50 ms at 3 x Pickup at 50 Hz, typically
Timing accuracy at 0 ms time delay (no intentional delay): 50ms
at non-zero time delay: ±3% of operate time or 50 ms
(whichever is greater)
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2-10 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

2.5.1.8 ISOLATED GROUND INSTANTANEOUS OVERCURRENT (50IG)

Current Input Fundamental Phasor (without harmonics)


Voltage Input Fundamental Phasor (without harmonics)
Current Pickup level 0.005 to 0.400 A in steps of 0.001 A
Voltage Pickup level 2 to 70 V in steps of 1 V
Dropout level 97 to 98% of the pickup level 2
Level Accuracy ±1.5% of the reading ± 1 mA from 0.005 to 16 A
Trip delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s.
Time to instantaneous 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s.
Operate time <50 ms at 3 x Pickup at 50 Hz, typically
Timing accuracy at 0 ms time delay (no intentional delay): 50ms
at non-zero time delay: ±3% of operate time or 50 ms
(whichever is greater)
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.1.9 NEGATIVE SEQUENCE CURRENT (46)

Current Input Fundamental Phasor (without harmonics)


Pickup level 0.05 to 160.0 A in steps of 0.01 A
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Level Accuracy Values at nominal frequency:
±0.5% of the reading ± 10 mA from 0.05 to 10 A
±1.5% of the reading for higher values
Curve Shapes IEEE extremely / very / moderately inverse
IEC A/B/C/long-time inverse/short time inverse curve
IAC extremely / very / moderately inverse
ANSI extremely / very / normally / moderately inverse
I2t
Definite time
Rectifier curve
FlexCurve™ A/B/C/D user curve
Curve Multiplier (Time Dial) 0.00 to 900.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Reset type Instantaneous or time delayed according to IEEE
Timing accuracy Operate at > 1.03 times the pickup ±3% of operate time
or 50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Saturation Level 48 times the pickup level
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-11


2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.5.1.10 PHASE DIRECTIONAL (67P)

Directionality Forward and reverse selectable by setting


Polarizing Quadrature Voltage:
ABC seq: Phase A (VBC), Phase B (VCA), Phase C
(VAB)
ACB seq: Phase A (VCB), Phase B (VAC), Phase C
2 (VBA)
Polarizing voltage threshold 0 to 300 Vac in steps of 1 V
Current Sensitivity Threshold 50 mA
Characteristic angle -90º to +90º in steps of 1º
Block Logic Permission or Block selectable by setting
Angle accuracy ±3º for I>0.1 A and V>5 Vac
Voltage Memory Time 0.00 to 3.00 in steps of 0.01 s
Operate time <30ms, typically

2.5.1.11 GROUND DIRECTIONAL (67G)

Directionality Forward and reverse selectable by setting


Polarizing Voltage, current, dual
Polarizing Voltage VN (measured or calculated, selected by setting)
Polarizing Current Isg (measured from 5th current transformer)
Operating Current Ig (measured from 4th current transformer)
Polarizing Voltage threshold 0 to 300 Vac in steps of 1 V
Polarizing Current threshold 0.005 A
Characteristic angle -90º to +90º in steps of 1º
Block Logic Permission or Block selectable by setting
Angle accuracy ±3º for I>0.1 A and V>5 Vac
Operate time <30ms, typically

2.5.1.12 NEUTRAL DIRECTIONAL (67N)

Directionality Forward and reverse selectable by setting


Polarizing Voltage, current, dual
Polarizing Voltage VN (measured or calculated, selected by setting)
Polarizing Current Isg (measured from 5th current transformer)
Operating Current IN
Polarizing Voltage threshold 0 to 300 Vac in steps of 1 V
Polarizing Current threshold 0.005 A
Characteristic angle -90º to +90º in steps of 1º
Block Logic Permission or Block selectable by setting
Angle accuracy ±3º for I>0.1 A and V>5 Vac
Operate time <30ms, typically

2-12 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

2.5.1.13 SENSITIVE GROUND DIRECTIONAL (67SG)

Directionality Forward and reverse selectable by setting


Polarizing Voltage
Polarizing Voltage VN (measured or calculated, selected by setting)
Operating Current Isg (measured from 5th current transformer)
Polarizing Voltage threshold 0 to 300 Vac in steps of 1 V 2
Characteristic angle -90º to +90º in steps of 1º
Block Logic Permission or Block selectable by setting
Angle accuracy ±2º for I>0.1 A and V>5 Vac
Operate time <30ms, typically

2.5.1.14 THERMAL MODEL (49)

Current Input Fundamental Phasor (without harmonics)


Rated current For connection to 1 or 5 A CTs.
Pickup level 0.05 to 160.0 A in steps of 0.01 A
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Level Accuracy Values at nominal frequency:
±0.5% of the reading ± 10 mA from 0.05 to 10 A
±1.5% of the reading for higher values
Timing accuracy ±3.5% of operate time or 50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Heating constant 3.0 to 600.0 minutes in steps of 0.1 minute
Cooling constant 1.00 to 6.00 times the heating constant in steps of 0.01
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.1.15 PHASE OVERVOLTAGE (59P)

Voltage Input Fundamental Phasor (without harmonics) of phase-to-


phase voltages
Pickup level 3 to 300 in steps of 1 V
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Level Accuracy ±1% of reading from 10 to 208 V at Nominal Frequency
Trip delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s.
Reset delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s.
Timing accuracy ±3.5% of operate time or 50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Logic Any/Two/All phases logic selectable by setting
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-13


2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.5.1.16 PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE (27P)

Voltage Input Fundamental Phasor of phase-to-ground or phase-to-


phase voltages (selectable by setting)
Pickup level 3 to 300 in steps of 1 V
Dropout level 102% to 103% of the pickup level

2 Level accuracy
Curve Shapes
±1% of reading from 10 to 208 V at nominal frequency
Fixed time or inverse curve
Reset type Instantaneous
Curve Multiplier (Time Dial) 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s.
Timing accuracy ±3.5% of operate time or 50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Minimum Voltage Threshold 0 to 300 in steps of 1 V
Logic Any/Two/All phases logic selectable by setting
Supervised by Breaker Selectable by setting
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.1.17 NEUTRAL OVERVOLTAGE (59NH/59NL)

Voltage Input Fundamental Phasor of the neutral voltage


Pickup level 3 to 300 in steps of 1 V
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Level accuracy ±1% of reading from 10 to 208 V at nominal frequency
Trip delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s
Reset delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s
Timing accuracy ±3.5% of operate time or 50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.1.18 NEGATIVE SEQUENCE OVERVOLTAGE (47)

Voltage Input Fundamental Phasor


Pickup level 3 to 300 in steps of 1 V
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Level accuracy ±1% of reading from 10 to 208 V
Trip delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s
Reset delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s
Timing accuracy ±3.5% of operate time or 50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2-14 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

2.5.1.19 AUXILIARY OVERVOLTAGE (59X)

Voltage Input Fundamental Phasor of the auxiliary voltage


Pickup level 3 to 300 in steps of 1 V
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Level accuracy ±1% of reading from 10 to 208 V at nominal frequency
Trip delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s 2
Reset delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s
Timing accuracy ±3.5% of operate time or 50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.1.20 AUXILIARY UNDERVOLTAGE (27X)

Voltage Input Fundamental Phasor of the auxiliary voltage


Pickup level 3 to 300 V in steps of 1 V
Dropout level 102% to 103% of the pickup level
Level accuracy ±1% of reading from 10 to 208 V at nominal frequency
Curve Shapes Fixed time or inverse curve
Reset type Instantaneous
Curve Multiplier (Time Dial) 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s
Timing accuracy ±3.5% of operate time or 50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.1.21 UNDERFREQUENCY (81U)

Pickup level 20.00 to 65.00 Hz in steps of 0.01 Hz


Dropout level Pickup + 0.03 Hz
Level accuracy ±0.05 Hz of the reading from 30 to 80 Hz
Trip delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s
Reset delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s
Minimum voltage threshold 10 to 300V in steps of 1 V
Time Delay Accuracy 0 to 7 cycles
Operate time Typically 10 cycles at 0.1Hz/s change
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-15


2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.5.1.22 OVERFREQUENCY (81O)


Pickup level 20.00 to 65.00 Hz in steps of 0.01 Hz
Dropout level Pickup - 0.03 Hz
Level accuracy ±0.05 Hz of the reading from 30 to 80 Hz
Trip delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s
Reset delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s

2 Minimum voltage threshold


Time Delay Accuracy
10 to 300V in steps of 1 V
0 to 7 cycles
Operate time Typically 10 cycles at 0.1 Hz/s change
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.1.23 FORWARD POWER (32FP)

Current, Voltage Fundamental Phasor (primary values)


Number of stages 2
Pickup level (two stages) 0.00-10000.00 MW in steps of 0.01 MW
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Level accuracy for primary magnitudes ±3% complete range.
Trip delay (two stages) 0.00 to 900.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Timing accuracy ±3.5% of operate time or 50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Block Time after close 0.00 to 900.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.1.24 DIRECTIONAL POWER (32)

Current, Voltage Fundamental Phasor (primary values)


Number of stages 2
Pickup level (two stages) -10000.00 to 10000.00 MW (primary values) in steps of
0.01 MW
Characteristic Angle (two stages) 0.00 to 359.99 in steps of 0.01
Accuracy for primary magnitudes ±3% complete range
Trip delay (two stages) 0.00 to 900.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Timing accuracy ±3.5% of operate time or 50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Block Time after close 0.00 to 900.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting
Operate time: < 45 ms at 50 Hz, typically

2-16 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

2.5.1.25 WATTMETRIC ZERO-SEQUENCE DIRECTIONAL (32N)

Measured Power Zero sequence


Number of elements 6 (3 High level, 3 Low level)
Voltage Pickup Level (VN) 2.00 to 70.00 Volts in steps of 0.01
Voltage calculated from phases if Auxiliary voltage is set
to Vx
Voltage Measured directly from the fourth voltage 2
transformer if Auxiliary voltage is set to VN.
Level Accuracy for Voltage ±1% of reading from 10 to 208 V
Current Selection IN (calculated from phases)
IG (measured directly from the fourth current
transformer)
OC Pickup Level 0.005 to 0.400 Amps in steps of 0.001
Level Accuracy for current ±0.5% of the reading ± 10 mA from 0.05 to 10 A
±1.5% of the reading for higher values
OC Pickup Delay 0.00 to 600.00 seconds in steps of 0.01
Power Pickup Level 0.01 to 4.50 Watts in steps of 0.01
Characteristic Angle (MTA) 0 to 360º in steps of 1
Power Pickup Delay 0.00 to 600.00 seconds in steps of 0.01
Level Accuracy for Power ±2.5% of the reading at -0.8 = PF = -1 and 0.8 <PF=1
Curve Shapes Inverse Curve
Definite time
FlexCurve™ A/B/C/D user curve
Curve Multiplier (Time Dial) 0.02 to 2.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Tripping time accuracy ±3.5% of operate time or 50 ms whichever is greater
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting
Operate time < 45 ms at 50 Hz, typically

2.5.2 CONTROL

2.5.2.1 AUTORECLOSE (79)

Schemes Three-pole tripping schemes


Number of shots Up to 4 reclose attempts before lockout
Dead time Independent dead time setting before each shot
adjustable between 0 and 900 s in steps of 0.01 s
Reclaim time 0.00 to 900.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Condition permission Selectable by setting
Hold time 0.00 to 900.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Reset time 0.00 to 900.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting
Possibility to modify protection settings after each shot programmable through PLC (block signals available after each
shot)

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-17


2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.5.2.2 SYNCHROCHECK (25)

Dead/live levels for line and bus 0.00 to 300.00 in steps of 0.01 V
Maximum voltage difference 2.00 to 300.00 V in steps of 0.01 V
Maximum angle difference 2.0º to 80.0º in steps of 0.1º
Maximum frequency slip 10 to 5000 mHz in steps of 10 mHz

2 Synchronism time
Angle accuracy
0.01 to 1.00 s in steps of 0.01 s

Dead Source function None
(DL-DB) Dead Line - Dead Bus
(LL-DB) Live Line-Dead Bus
(DL-LB) Dead Line – Live Bus
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.2.3 FUSE FAILURE

Algorithm based on positive sequence of voltage and current


Activation by V2/V1 ratio

2.5.2.4 BREAKER FAILURE (50BF)

Current Input Fundamental Phasor (without harmonics)


Rated current For connection to 1 or 5 A CTs.
Pickup level for supervision 0.05 to 160.00 A in steps of 0.01 A
Pickup level for high level 0.05 to 160.00 A in steps of 0.01 A
Pickup level for low level 0.05 to 160.00 A in steps of 0.01 A
Pickup level for internal arcing 0.05 to 160.00 A in steps of 0.01 A
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Level Accuracy ±0.5% of the reading ± 10 mA from 0.05 to 10 A
±1.5% of the reading for higher values.
Timing accuracy ±3.5% of operate time or 50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.2.5 BROKEN CONDUCTOR (I2/I1)

Pickup level 20.0-100.0% (I2/I1 ratio) in steps of 0.1%


Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level
Trip delay 0.00 to 900.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Timing accuracy ±3.5% of operate time or 50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting
Operation Threshold 0.000 to 1.000 A in steps of 0.001 A
I2/I1 current inhibition level Selectable by setting from 0.000 to 1.000 in steps of
0.001 A

2-18 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

2.5.2.6 LOCKED ROTOR (48)

Current Input Phasor (without harmonics) or RMS


Rated current For connection to 1 or 5 A CTs.
Full Load Current 0.10 to 10.00 kA in steps of 0.01 kA
Pickup level 1.01 to 109.00 in steps of 0.01 x FLC
Dropout level 97% to 98% of the pickup level 2
Level accuracy for primary magnitudes ±3% complete range.
Trip delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s.
Reset delay 0.00 to 900.00 s. in steps of 0.01 s.
Operate time 20 ms at 3 x Pickup at 50 Hz, typically
Timing accuracy ±3% of operate time or 50 ms. (whichever is greater)
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.2.7 PULSE COUNTERS

Number of Pulse counters available Up to 8


Multiplier factor 0.000 to 65000.000 in steps of 0.001
Overload factor 0 to 1000000 in steps of 1
Board Origin All available input/outputs boards in the device. See
ordering code [F, G, H, J]
Input origin up to 32 [depending on the board type selection]

2.5.2.8 ANALOG COMPARATORS

Analog Input Any analog value available in the device


Analog Maximum Threshold value -100000.000 to 100000.000 in steps of 0.001
Analog Minimum Threshold value -100000.000 to 100000.000 in steps of 0.001
Analog Delay 0.00 to 900.00 in steps of 0.01
Analog Hysteresis 0.0 to 50.00 in steps of 0.1
Analog Direction (for activation inside or outside the IN or OUT
deadband)

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-19


2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.5.2.9 FREQUENCY RATE OF CHANGE

df/dt trend increasing, decreasing, bi-directional


df/dt pickup level 0.10 to 10.00 Hz/s in steps of 0.01
df/dt level accuracy 80 mHz/s or 3.5%, whichever is greater
Overvoltage supv. 0.00 to 110.00 % in steps of 0.01

2 95% settling time for df/dt


Operate time:
< 24 cycles

at 2 x pickup 12 cycles
at 3 x pickup 8 cycles
at 5 x pickup 6 cycles
Frequency Rate min. 20.00 to 80.00 Hz in steps of 0.01
Frequency Rate max. 20.00 to 80.00 Hz in steps of 0.01
Frequency Rate delay 0.00 to 60.00 s in steps of 0.01
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.2.10 LOAD ENCROACHMENT

Responds to: Positive-sequence quantities


Minimum voltage: 0.00 to 300.00 V in steps of 0.01
Reach (sec. Ω): 0.02 to 250.00 Ω in steps of 0.01
Impedance accuracy: ±3%
Angle: 5 to 50º in steps of 1
Angle accuracy: ±3º
Pickup delay: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
Reset delay: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
Time accuracy: ±3.5% or ±60 ms, whichever is greater
Operate time: <60 ms at 50 Hz typically
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2.5.2.11 BREAKER SETTINGS

Number of Switchgear 1 to 16 (selection of switchgear for breaker control)


Maximum KI2t 0.00 to 9999.99 in steps of 0.01 (kA)2 s
KI2t integration Time 0.03 to 0.25 s in steps of 0.01 s
Maximum openings 0 to 9999 in steps of 1
Maximum Openings in one hour 1 to 60 in steps of 1
Snapshot Events Selectable by setting

2-20 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

2.5.2.12 BREAKER MAINTENANCE

KI2t Breaker Counters for Phases A, B, C 0.00 to 9999.99 in steps of 0.01 (kA)2 s
Breaker Openings Counter 0 to 9999 in steps of 1
Breaker Closings Counter 0 to 9999 in steps of 1

2.5.2.13 SWITCHGEAR
2

Switchgear 1 to16 (configurable in “relay configuration” screen).


Snapshot Events Selectable by setting (for each switchgear in “system setup”)

2.5.2.14 MAXIMUM NUMBER OF STARTS

Metering algorithm Fundamental


Tripping time accuracy ±250ms or 5% whichever is greater
Full load amps 0.5 to 10.0 A in steps of 0.1
Breaker supervision Selectable by setting
Min. Stop time 0.0 to 900.0 in steps of 0.1
Number of starts 0 to 10 in steps of 1
Time to restart 0 to 100 minutes in steps of 1
Reset Counter Selectable by setting
Snapshot events: Selectable by setting
Operate time <45ms at 50Hz, typically

2.5.2.15 DIGITAL COUNTERS

FUNCTION Disabled, Enabled


Name Any 12 alphanumeric characters
Preset -2147483648, 0, +2147483647
COMPARE -2147483648, 0, +2147483647

2.5.2.16 COLD LOAD PICKUP

Cold Outage time 1 -1000 in steps of 1min


Cold Blocking time 1-1000 in steps of 1s

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-21


2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.5.3 MONITORING

2.5.3.1 OSCILLOGRAPHY

Maximum Records: Up to 20 Oscillography records.


Sampling rate: Programmable to 4, 8, 16, 32 or 64 samples per power cycle
2 Capacity per record: 27592 samples

No of Oscillos * No of samples/cycle
Trigger position: 5% to 95% of total length
Trigger: Programmable via PLC
Data: 5 current channels and 4 voltage channels
Up to 16 digital channels programmable through PLC
Data Storage: In non volatile memory (flash) without battery
Format: International Standard COMTRADE ASCII - IEEE C37.111-1999.
Automatic Overwrite: Selectable by setting. (Oscillography records can be concatenated)
Snapshot Events: Selectable by setting

2.5.3.2 FAULT LOCATOR

Method: Single-ended
Positive Sequence Module: 0.01 to 250.00 Ohm in steps of 0.01 Ohms
Positive Sequence Angle: 25 to 90º in steps of 1º
Zero Sequence Module: 0.01 to 750.00 Ohms in steps of 0.01 Ohm
Zero Sequence Angle: 25 to 90º in steps of 1º
Line Length: 0.0 to 2000.0 in steps of 0.1 (miles or km)
Accuracy: 5% (typical)
Show Fault on HMI: Selectable by setting
Snapshot Events: Selectable by setting
Maximum Records: Up to 10 fault report records.
Data: Fault date and time, pre-fault currents and voltages, fault currents and voltages,
fault type, distance to the fault (fault location), line parameters, recloser and
breaker status information.
Data Storage: In non volatile memory (flash) without battery available through communications
In volatile memory (ram) available through HMI (if selectable by setting)
Format: Text in ASCII format

2.5.3.3 SNAPSHOT EVENTS

Capacity: 512 scrolling events


Time-tag 1 ms using an internal clock of 100 μs
Timing Accuracy: 1 ms (using the IRIG-B synchronization input)
Triggers: Any element pickup, dropout or operation
Digital input /output change of state

2-22 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

By virtual inputs and control events


Data Storage In non volatile memory (flash) without battery
The snapshot event recording procedure can be enabled or disabled by setting for each protection function

2.5.3.4 CONTROL EVENTS

Capacity: 128 events programmable through PLC


2
Time-tag: 1 ms plus one plc cycle using an internal clock of 100 μs. For Digital Inputs, the
debounce time of these digital inputs must be added.
Timing Accuracy: 1 ms (using the IRIG-B synchronization input)
Triggers: By any digital signal programmable through PLC
Alarm Possibility to display the event as an alarm on the alarms panel.
Information available always through Communications for all models and also in
HMI for models with graphical display (M in ordering code).
Data Storage: In non volatile memory (flash) without battery
Control events are also displayed in the snapshot events recording

2.5.3.5 DEMAND

Channels: 9
Parameters: Ia (kA RMS), Ib (kA RMS), Ic (kA RMS), Ig (kA RMS), Isg (kA RMS), I2 (kA), P
(MW), Q (MVAr) and S (MVA)
Current and Power Method Thermal Exponential, Block Interval, Rolling Demand
Measurements: Each channel shows the present and maximum measured value, with date and
time for the maximum recorded value.
Samples: 5, 10, 15, 20, 30, 60 minutes.
Accuracy: ±2%
Trigger Input Selectable by setting (operation mode selection for the Block Interval calculation
method)
Snapshot Events: Selectable by setting

2.5.3.6 DATA LOGGER

Number of Channels: 1 to 16
Parameters Any available analog actual value
Samples 1 sec., 1, 5, 10, 15, 20, 30, 60 min.
Storage Capacity Fixed, 32768 measures

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-23


2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.5.4 USER-PROGRAMMABLE ELEMENTS

2.5.4.1 PLC LOGIC

Programming language: The logical configuration is performed using graphical functions based on the
IEC 61131-3 standard.
2 Lines of code for versions previous to
7.00:
640 lines of code (*)

Lines of code for version 7.00 or newer: 1600 total equations (*)
(*) Note: 15360 bytes of PLC equations in text format (Reserved Modbus space)
Supported operations: NOT, XOR, OR (2 to 8 inputs), AND (2 to 8 inputs), NOR (2 to 8 inputs),
NAND (2 to 8 inputs), Latch (Reset Dominant), Edge Detectors, Timers.
2 inputs default gates, from 3 to 8 inputs provided in library format.
Starting in version 7.20, analog operators as also available.
Libraries: Logical gates fully programmable by user. To create user-programmable logic
to be distributed as a single object.
Inputs: Any logical variable, contact or virtual input
Number of timers: 8 maximum in each logic scheme (provided in library format)

2.5.4.2 FLEXCURVES

Number: 4 (A through D)
Reset points: 40 (0 through 1 of pickup)
Operate points: 80 (1 through 20 of pickup)
Time delay: 0 to 65535 ms in steps of 1
Saturation Level 20 times the pickup level

2.5.4.3 USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS

Number: 15 configurable LEDs plus a ready non configurable LED


Programmability: from any logical variable, contact, or virtual input
Reset mode: Self-reset or Latched.
The first 5 LED’s are latched by hardware (red color ones), usually configured for
trip signals.
The following 10 ones (yellow and green) are self-reset but can be latched
through PLC configuration.
Reset Signal: The LED’s can be reset by hardware, pressing the front “esc” key during more
than 3 seconds or using the LED reset signal through PLC configuration.

2-24 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

2.5.4.4 USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS

Number of configurable displays: 1 (one line diagram fully configurable). In graphical displays only
Number of fixed displays: 6, Metering (Selectable between Primary and Secondary values), Snapshot
events (all and new), Alarms, Inputs and outputs screen with test functionality for
inputs and outputs. In graphical displays only
Number of selectable displays: Logotype, metering or both in scrolling mode, can be selectable as default
screen in text display for all models (basic and mimic). The metering screen 2
contains current and voltages for phases and ground in primary or secondary
values.

2.5.4.5 USER-PROGRAMMABLE FRONT KEYS

Number of configurable Keys: 5


Operation: drive PLC operands

2.5.5 METERING

2.5.5.1 CURRENT

Accuracy: ±0.5% of the reading ± 10 mA from 0.05 to 10 A (for phases and ground)
(at nominal frequency) ±1.5% of the reading ± 1 mA from 0.005 to 5 A (for sensitive ground)
±1.5% of the reading for higher values
% of load-to-trip accuracy: ±0.5% of full-scale

2.5.5.2 VOLTAGE

Accuracy: ±1% of reading from 10 to 208 V

2.5.5.3 REAL POWER (WATTS)

Accuracy: ±2.0% of the reading at -0.8 ≤ PF ≤ -1.0 and 0.8 <PF≤1.0

2.5.5.4 REACTIVE POWER (VARS)

Accuracy: ±2.0% of the reading at-0.2 ≤ PF ≤ 0.2

2.5.5.5 APPARENT POWER (VA)

Accuracy: ±2.0% of the reading

2.5.5.6 WATT-HOURS (POSITIVE AND NEGATIVE)

Accuracy: ±2.0% of the reading


Range: -2147483 to +2147483 MWh
Parameters: 3-phase only
Update rate: 100 ms

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-25


2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.5.5.7 WAR-HOURS (POSITIVE AND NEGATIVE)

Accuracy: ±2.0% of the reading


Range: -2147483 to +2147483 MVArh
Parameters: 3-phase only
Update rate: 100 ms
2 2.5.5.8 FREQUENCY

Accuracy: +/- 0.03Hz From 30 to 80 Hz


Note: Voltage input must be above 10V to start measuring frequency.

2.5.5.9 ANGLE

Accuracy: ±3º

2.5.6 INPUTS

2.5.6.1 AC CURRENT INPUTS

CT Ratio: 1.0 to 6000.0 in steps of 0.1


Rated currents: Appropriate for 1 or 5 A. F650 has universal range for CT (valid for 1 or 5 A to
only one terminal).
Relay Burden: <0.2 VA
Current Withstand Continuous at 20 A
1 second at 500 A for phases and ground
1 second at 50 A for sensitive ground

2-26 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

2.5.6.2 AC VOLTAGE INPUTS

VT Ratio 1.0 to 6000.0 in steps of 0.1


Rated Voltages 275 Vac
Metering range: From 2 to 275 Vac
Relay Burden: 0.05 VA at 120 Vac (50 or 60 Hz)
Voltage Withstand: Continuous at 275 V to neutral 2
1 min/hr at 420 to neutral
VAC inputs do not need varistors, as the impulse test is applied to 100% of the transformers

2.5.6.3 CONTACT INPUTS

Input Activation Voltage Threshold: 10 to 230 Vdc in steps of 1 V (selectable by setting)


Impedance: > 100 kOhm
Maximum error: ±10% setting or ± 5 V
Load for voltage supervision inputs: 2 mA + V/100 kOhm
Voltage threshold for voltage < 10 V (fixed)
supervision inputs:
Debounce Time: 1 to 50 in steps of 1 ms
Recognition time: < 1ms
Timing resolution: 1 ms
For Input Activation Voltage Threshold and Debounce Time there is a single setting for all inputs in the same group (inputs
sharing the same common).
Input Type and Delay Input Time are not grouped; there is a different setting for each input.
Input Type Positive-Edge / Negative-Edge / Positive/ Negative
Delay Input Time 0 to 60000 ms in steps of 1 ms (Input signal time delay)

2.5.6.4 REMOTE INPUTS (IEC61850 GSSE/GOOSE)

Number of input points: 32, configured from 64 incoming bit pairs


Number of remote devices: 16 (24 for relay version 7.00 and above)
Default states on loss of comms: On, Off, Latest/on, Latest/off

2.5.6.5 ANALOG INPUTS

Input impedance 116Ω


Current Input (mADC): 0 to -1; 0 to +1; -1 to +1; 0 to 5; 0 to 10; 0 to 20; 4 to 20 (programmable)
Conversion Range: -1 to +20mA
Accuracy: ±0.2% of full scale
Type: Passive

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-27


2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.5.6.6 IRIG-B INPUT

Amplitude modulation: DC SHIFT = Demodulated input (no carrier)


Input Voltage: TTL
Input Burden: 1.5 mA
Input Impedance: 3.3 kOhm

2 Minimum Input Voltage: 2.4 V


Maximum Input Voltage: ± 24 V
Formats: B000 (*) B001, B002 and B003 (*)
(*) Signal combinations recognized in accordance with IRIG Standard 200-95
Isolation: 2 kV

2.5.7 REAL TIME CLOCK

Accuracy: Typical ±20 ppm


Backup energy: More than 1 week
Note: For relay's versions previous to 7.00, when the relay's date and time is changed using any of the documented
methods (Modbus, IRIG-B, SNTP, Front Panel...) the relay acknowledges and updates the time instantly but it is not until
after nearly 3 minutes that it is permanently stored in the Real Time Clock’s NVRAM.

2.5.8 OUTPUTS

Single Contact Carry continuous: 16 A


Make and Carry for 1 sec. 60 A
Break at L/R of 40 ms: 0.3 A DC max. at 125 Vdc
0.25 A DC max. at 250 Vdc
Operate Time: < 8 ms
Contact material: Silver Alloy

Output Logic Type, Output Type and Pulse Output Time are selectable by setting for each output
Output Logic Type Positive / Negative
Output Type Normal / Pulse / Latch (Selectable by setting for each output)
Pulse Output Time 0 to 60000 ms in steps of 1 ms (applicable only to signals set as pulse type)
Separate operate and reset signal can be configured by any digital signal programmable through PLC

Contact Outputs (F31-F33, F34-F36) for The current seal-in circuit is used for verifying the current condition in a circuit
board type 2 (supervision) in slot F: during the time that the tripping contact remains closed. If the current in the
tripping circuit is maintained over 500 mA, the function is sealed independently of
the status of the function that caused the trip.

2.5.8.1 REMOTE OUTPUTS (IEC61850 GSSE/GOOSE)

Standard output points 32


User output points 32

2-28 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

2.5.9 CONTROL POWER SUPPLY

LOW RANGE (LO) ALL RANGES


Nominal DC Voltage: 24 to 48 V Power consumption Typical =25 VA, Maximum =45 VA
Min/Max DC Voltage 19.2 / 57.6 V Display backlight auto power-off mode after 15 minutes without
Note: Low range is DC only touching any key, in order to ensure long life and minimum
consumption 2
Voltage Loss hold-up time: 24Vdc 30 ms
48Vdc100ms
HIGH RANGE (HI) INTERNAL FUSE
Nominal DC Voltage: 110 to 250 V V 250VAC
Min/Max DC Voltage 88 / 300 V I 2,5A
Nominal AC Voltage: 120 to 230 V Size 5 x 20 mm
Min/Max AC Voltage 102 / 250 V Type Quick acting (F)
Voltage Loss hold-up time 200m typical, worst UL, listed miniature Fuse
case 100 ms without
unit reset

2.5.10 COMMUNICATIONS

FRONT PORT:
Front port: COM2
Type RS232/USB
Baud Rate 300, 600, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600 y 115200 bauds
Default Baud Rate 19200
Protocols available: ModBus® RTU / DNP 3.0
Typical distance: 3m
Isolation: 2 kV
ASYNCHRONOUS REAR PORTS:
None or two rear ports (depending on model): COM1, COM2 (rear COM2 multiplexed with front port)
Type (depending on model):
Model F None
Model A Redundant RS485
Model X Redundant RS485 + fiber CAN for inputs/outputs module
Model P Redundant 1mm-plastic F.O.
Model Y Redundant 1mm-plastic F.O. + fiber CAN for inputs/outputs module
Model G Redundant multimode glass F.O.
Model Z Redundant multimode glass F.O. + fiber CAN for inputs/outputs module
Model C Cable CAN port for I/O module
Model M Cable CAN port for I/O module (cable) + RS485 (ModBus RTU)
Optic Features for ST connectors devices: Wave length: 1300nm
Fiber type: multimode 62.5/125 μm or 50/125 μm
Baud Rate: 300, 600, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600 y 115200 bauds
Default Baud Rate 19200

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-29


2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

Protocols available: ModBus® RTU / DNP 3.0/IEC103


Typical distance: 1200 m for cooper cable, 1000 m for glass fiber and 50 m for
plastic fiber
Isolation: 2 kV
CAN PORT:
Rear port: CAN port in models C, M, X, Y, Z for asynchronous rear ports
2 Type: Multimode glass F.O. port with ST connectors
Fiber Wave length: 820 nm
Fiber type: multimode 62.5/125 μm or 50/125 μm
Maximum recommended length 300m for cooper cable and glass fiber
Isolation: 2 kV
ETHERNET PORT:
Rear port:
For models B, C, D, E ETH_1/ ETH_2
For models G,H,J,K,L,M ETH_E/ ETH_A/ ETH_B
Type (depending on model):
Model B: 10/100BaseTX self-negotiable
Model C: 10/100BaseTX + 100Base FX
Model D: 10/100BaseTX + redundant 100BaseFX (Physical media redundancy)
Model E: Redundant 10/100BaseTX self-negotiable ports
Model G: 1588, 10/100 Base TX* + 100 Base TX
Model H: 1588, 10/100 Base TX* + 100 Base FX
Model J: PRP, 1588, 10/100 Base TX* + Redundant 100 Base FX
Model K: PRP, HSR, RSTP, 1588, 10/100 Base TX* + Redundant 100 Base FX
Model L: PRP, 1588, 10/100 Base TX* + Redundant 100 Base TX
Model M: PRP, HSR, RSTP, 1588, 10/100 Base TX* + Redundant 100 Base TX
NOTE: (*) This Ethernet port (ETH_E) is intended only for maintenance purpose.
10/100BaseTX RJ45 connector
100BaseFX ST connectors
Wave length: 1300 nm
Fiber type: multimode 62.5/125 . m or 50/125 . m
Protocols available: ModBus® TCP/IP
DNP over TCP/IP and UDP/IP
IEC 61850
Http, ftp, tftp (allow the use of a standard Internet browser)
Typical distance: 1000 m for glass fiber and 150 m for RJ45 cable
Response time to ModBus commands: 10 ms Typical
Isolation: 2 kV
In Models C and D, the 10/100BaseTX port is selected by an internal switch (see 3.3.3)
Two witness LED’s for transmission and reception are included
SIMPLE NETWORK TIME PROTOCOL (SNTP)
Clock synchronization error: <10 ms (typical)
PRECISION TIME PROTOCOL (PTP)
PTP IEEE Std 1588 2008 (version 2)
Power Profile (PP) per IEEE Standard PC37.238TM2011
Slave-only ordinary clock

2-30 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Peer delay measurement mechanism


PARALLEL REDUNDANCY PROTOCOL (PRP) (IEC 62439-3 CLAUSE 4, 2012)
Ethernet ports used A and B
Networks supported 10/100 MB Ethernet
PARALLEL REDUNDANCY PROTOCOL (HSR) (IEC 62439-3 CLAUSE 5, 2012)
Ethernet ports used A and B
Networks supported 10/100 MB Ethernet 2
RAPID SPANNING TREE PROTOCOL (RSTP) (IEC 62439-1, IEEE 801.2D)
Ethernet ports used A and B
Networks supported 10/100 MB Ethernet

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-31


2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.5.11 OPTIC FEATURES

Wave length: 1300nm


Connector types: ST package style
Fiber type: multimode 62.5/125 mm or 50/125 mm

2 TRANSMITTER CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter Min. Typ. Max. Unit Reference
Output Optical Power BOL -19 -14 dBm avg. Note 1
62.5/125 μm, NA = 0.275 Fiber EOL -20
Output Optical Power BOL -22.5 -14 dBm avg. Note 1
50/125 μm, NA = 0.275 Fiber EOL -23.5
Output Optical Power at -45 dBm avg. Note 2
Logic “0” State

RECEIVER CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter Min. Typ. Max. Unit Reference
Input Optical Power -33.9 -31 dBm avg. Note 3
Minimum at Window Edge
Input Optical Power -35.2 -31.8 dBm avg. Note 4
Minimum at Eye Center
Input Optical Power Maximum -14 dBm avg. Note 3

Notes:
1. These optical power values are measured with the following conditions:
The Beginning of Live (BOL) to the End of Life (EOL) optical power degradation is typically 1.5 dB per industry
convention for long wavelength LEDs. The actual degradation observed in Agilent’s 1300nm LED products is <1 dB, as
specified in this data sheet.
Over the specified operating voltage and temperature ranges.
With HALT Line State, (12.5 MHz square-wave), input signal.
At the end of one meter of noted optical fiber with cladding modes removed.
The average power value can be converted to a peak power value by adding 3 dB. Higher output optical power
transmitters are available on special request.
2. The transmitter provides compliance with the need for Transmit_Disable commands from the FDDI SMT layer by
providing an Output Optical Power level of <-45 dBm average in response to a logic “0” input. This specification applies
to either 62.5/125 mm or 50/125 mm fiber cables.
3. This specification is intended to indicate the performance of the receiver section of the transceiver when Input Optical
Power signal characteristics are present per the following definitions. The Input Optical Power dynamic range from the
minimum level (with a window time-width) to the maximum level is the range over which the receiver is guaranteed to
provide output data with a Bit Error Ratio (BER) better than or equal to 2.5e-10.
At the Beginning of Life (BOL).
Over the specified operating temperature and voltage ranges.
4. All conditions for Note 3 apply except that the measurement is made at the center of the symbol with no window time-
width.

2-32 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

2.5.12 ENVIRONMENTAL CHARACTERISTICS

Operating temperature: - 10°C to + 60°C


Storage temperature: - 40°C to + 85°C
Humidity (non condensing): 95%
Altitude Up to 2000 m
Class of equipment I
2
Equipment mobility Fixed
Overvoltage category III
Pollution degree 2

2.5.13 PACKAGING AND WEIGHT

Net weight: 5 kg
Packaged: 6 kg
Package dimensions: 30x40x40 cm (DxWxH)

2.5.14 TYPE TESTS

CATEGORY STANDARD CLASS TEST


Dielectric voltage withstand IEC60255-27 2 KV / 2.3 KV
SAFETY Dielectric voltage withstand IEC60255-27 5 KV
Insulation resistance IEC60255-27 500 V (test level)
Electrostatic Discharge Immunity IEC60255-26/IEC61000-4-2 Level 4
Radiated RF Electromagnetic Field Immunity IEC60255-26/IEC61000-4-3 Level 3
Electrical Fast Transient Immunity IEC60255-26/IEC61000-4-4 Zone A
Surge Immunity IEC60255-26/IEC61000-4-5 Zone A
Conducted RF Immunity IEC60255-26/IEC61000-4-6 Level 3
Power magnetic Immunity IEC60255-26/IEC61000-4-8 Level 5
EMC Power Frequency Immunity IEC60255-26/IEC61000-4-16 Zone A
Damped Oscillatory Wave Immunity IEC60255-26/IEC61000-4-18 2.5 KV Common Mode 1 KV Diff. Mode
Voltage Dips & Interruptions IEC60255-26/IEC61000-4-11/ Levels based on IEC61000-4-11 &
IEC61000-4-29 IEC61000-4-29
Ripple on DC IEC60255-26/IEC61000-4-17 15% Rated DC value
Radiated & Conducted Emissions IEC60255-26/CISPR11/ Class A
CISPR22
Sinusoidal Vibration IEC60255-21-1 Class 1
Shock & Bump IEC60255-21-2 Class 1
MECHANICAL
Seismic IEC60255-21-3 Class 2
Enclosure Protection IEC60255-27/IEC60529 IP52
Cold test (storage) IEC60068-2-1 -40˚C 16 hrs
Cold test (operational) IEC60068-2-1 -20˚C 16 hrs
Dry heat test (storage) IEC60068-2-2 85˚C 16 hrs
CLIMATIC Dry heat test (operational) IEC60068-2-2 60˚C 16 hrs
Change of Temperature IEC60068-2-14 5 cycles (3+3) -20˚C/60˚C
Damp Heat Humidity Cyclic IEC60068-2-30 6 cycles (12+12) 55˚C @ 93% R.H.
Damp Heat steady state IEC60068-2-78 40˚C @ 93% R.H.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-33


2.5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

Type test report available upon request.


F650 has been designed to comply with the highest existing requirements. More specifically, UNIPEDE recommendations
for high voltage substations are followed, even if for most applications such high classes are not required.
The relay complies with ANSI C37.90 standards, and has been designed to comply with international standards.

2.5.15 APPROVALS

2
APPROVALS
Applicable Council Directive According to
CE Compliance Low voltage directive IEC60255-27
EMC Directive EC60255-26
North America UL UL508
EAC Machines and Equipment TR CU 010/2011
ISO Manufactured under a registered quality program ISO9001

EAC

The EAC Technical Regulations (TR) for Machines and Equipment apply to the Customs Union (CU) of the Russian
Federation, Belarus, and Kazakhstan

Item Description
Country of origin Spain
Date of manufacture See label on the F650 unit
Declaration of Conformity and/or Certificate of Conformity Available on request

2-34 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION 2.6 EXTERNAL CONNECTIONS

2.6EXTERNAL CONNECTIONS

Figure 2–2: F650 WIRING DIAGRAM (189C4216H2)

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 2-35


2.6 EXTERNAL CONNECTIONS 2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

INPUTS / OUTPUTS CONFIGURATION FOR BOARDS F1 AND F2


SLOT F CONFIGURATION (BOARD TYPE 1)
INPUTS F1 OUTPUTS F1
F1 + CC1 52b F19
F2 + CC2 50P BLOCK O1 F20 79 BLOCK
F3 + CC3 51P BLOCK F21

USER CONFIGURABLE OUTPUTS


USER CONFIGURABLE INPUTS
F4 + CC4 67P BLOCK F22
F5 + CC5 50G BLOCK O2 F23 27/59 PICKUP
2 F6 + CC6 51G BLOCK F24
F7 + CC7 79 INITIATE F25
O3 50/67G PICKUP
F8 + CC8 79 BLOCK F26
F9 - COMMON 1/8 COMMON 1/8 F27
O4 51/67G PICKUP
F10 - COMMON 9/16 COMMON 9/16 F28
F11 + CC9 NOT USED F29
O5 50/67P PICKUP
F12 + CC10 NOT USED F30
F13 + CC11 NOT USED F31
O6 51/67P PICKUP
F14 + CC12 NOT USED F32
F15 + CC13 NOT USED F33
O7 RECLOSE
F16 + CC14 NOT USED F34
F17 + CC15 NOT USED F35
O8 TRIP
F18 + CC16 NOT USED F36

SLOT F CONFIGURATION (BOARD TYPE 2)


INPUTS F2 OUTPUTS F2
F1 + COIL 1 F19
52/a SUPERVISION O1 79 BLOCK
COIL 1
V

F2 - 52/a F20
F3 + COIL 1 F21
52/b SUPERVISION O2 27/59 PICKUP
V

USER CONFIGURABLE OUTPUTS

F4 - 52/b F22
F5 + CC1 52b F23
O3 50/67G PICKUP
USER CONFIGURABLE INPUTS

F6 + CC2 50P BLOCK F24


F7 + CC3 51P BLOCK F25
O4 51/67G PICKUP
F8 + CC4 67P BLOCK F26
F9 - COMMON 1/4 COMMON 1/4 F27
O5 50/67P PICKUP
F10 - COMMON 5/8 COMMON 5/8 F28
F11 + CC5 50G BLOCK F29
O6 51/67P PICKUP
F12 + CC6 51G BLOCK F30
F13 + CC7 79 INITIATE I SENS F31
I

F14 + CC8 79 BLOCK F32 RECLOSE


O7
F15 + COIL 2 F33
V

52/a SUPERVISION
COIL 2

F16 - 52/a I SENS F34


I

F17 + COIL 2 F35 TRIP


52/b SUPERVISION O8
V

F18 - 52/b F36

Figure 2–3: INPUT/OUTPUT CONFIGURATIONS FOR BOARDS F1 AND F2 (189C4216H1)

2-36 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

3.1.1 INTRODUCTION

The EnerVista 650 Setup software provides a graphical user interface (GUI) as one of two human interfaces to a 650
device. The alternate human interface is implemented via the device faceplate keypad and display (see Human Machine
Interface section in this chapter).
The EnerVista 650 Setup software provides a single facility to configure, monitor, maintain, and trouble-shoot the operation
of relay functions, connected over local or wide area communication networks. It can be used while disconnected (i.e.
offline) or connected (i.e. on-line) to a 650 device. In off-line mode, settings files can be created for eventual downloading to
the device. In on-line mode, you can communicate with the device in real-time.
The EnerVista 650 Setup software, provided with every F650 relay, can be run from a computer supporting Microsoft
Windows XP, 7 and 8. This chapter provides a summary of the basic EnerVista 650 Setup software interface features. The
EnerVista 650 Setup Help File provides details for getting started and using the EnerVista 650 Setup software interface.

3.1.2 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE OVERVIEW

This software package uses ModBus protocol, and it is designed to communicate with a single relay at a time. GE offers
different communication software packages, such as GE-POWER, which can be used to communicate simultaneously with
several relays. 3
EnerVista 650 Setup software provides an easy way to configure, monitor and manage all F650 features.

3.1.2.1 CONNECTING TO A DEVICE


The EnerVista 650 Setup software may be used in on-line mode (relay connected) to directly communicate with a 650
device.

3.1.2.2 USING SETTINGS FILES


The EnerVista 650 Setup software interface supports three ways of handling changes to relay settings:
1. In off-line mode (relay disconnected) to create or edit relay settings files for later download to communicating relays.
2. While connected to a communicating relay to directly modify any relay settings via relay data view windows, and then
save the settings to the relay.
3. You can create/edit settings files and then write them to the relay while the interface is connected to the relay.
Settings files are organized on the basis of file names assigned by the user. A settings file contains data pertaining to the
following types of relay settings:
•Product Setup
•System Setup
•Protection Elements
•Control Elements
•Inputs/Outputs
•Quick Settings
•Relay Configuration
•Logic Configuration

3.1.2.3 VIEWING ACTUAL VALUES


You can view real-time relay data such as input/output status and measures.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-1


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.1.2.4 VIEWING TRIGGERED EVENTS


While the interface is in on-line mode, you can view and analyze data generated by triggered specified parameters, via one
of the following:
• Event Recorder facility: The event recorder captures contextual data associated with the last 479 events, listed in
chronological order from most recent to oldest. For firmware version 7.20 or higher, 511 events shall be available.
• Oscillography facility: The oscillography waveform traces and digital states are used to provide a visual display of
power system and relay operation data captured during specific triggered events.

3.1.2.5 FIRMWARE UPGRADES


The firmware of a F650 device can be upgraded, locally or remotely, via the EnerVista 650 Setup software.The
corresponding instructions are provided on the Chapter 9 on this instruction manual, “BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE
UPGRADE”.
Modbus addresses assigned to firmware modules, features, settings, and corresponding data items (i.e. default values,
minimum/maximum values, data type, and item size) may change slightly from version to version of firmware.
The addresses are rearranged when new features are added or existing features are enhanced or modified.

3 3.1.2.6 ONE LINE DIAGRAMS


You can configure an one line diagram (bay mimic) to be used in relays with graphical display.

3-2 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

3.1.3 MAIN SCREEN

The EnerVista 650 Setup software main window supports the following primary display components:
• Title bar
• Main menu bar
• Main icon bar
• Working area
• Status bar

Title

Working Area

Figure 3–1: ENERVISTA 650 SETUP MAIN SCREEN

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-3


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.1.4 COMMUNICATION MENU

To start communicating with the relay go to ‚"Communication>Computer>Computer settings" section in the main
EnerVista 650 Setup menu.
Safety instructions must be followed before connecting the computer to the relay. Safety instructions are detailed in section
1.1.3. Connect the relay ground terminal and the communicating computer to a good grounding. Otherwise, communication
may not be viable, or even, in worst cases, the relay and/or the computer could result damaged by overvoltages.
For on-line working, previously ensure that all relay communication parameters, such as baudrate, slave ModBus address,
etc., match the computer settings.

Figure 3–2: COMMUNICATION PARAMETERS MENU


The "Communication > computer" screen is divided in several subsections:
• Computer settings: Main communication parameters for serial communication and control type selection.
• Modbus/TCP Setup (if ModBus /TCP is selected as control type): Communication parameters for ModBus TCP
communication.
• Communication control: Device communication status (communicating or not communicating).
• Communication optimization: allows optimizing the communication time outs and failure establishing.

3-4 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

3.1.4.1 COMPUTER SETTINGS:


Shows the communication parameters necessary in order to establish communication with the unit. Such as slave address,
communication port, baud rate, parity, control type and startup mode.
Baud rate, parity, data bits, stop bits and ModBus slave address for com2 (RS232 front port and second serial port in the
rear communication board) are displayed in the default text logotype of relay main screen..
ModBus Slave Address: ModBus addresses used for serial and Ethernet communication.
Communication ports: port used in the computer for serial communication.
Baud Rate: Baud rate for serial communication (from 1200 up to 115200 bauds in EnerVista 650 Setup, from 300 to
115200 in relay).
Parity: parity for serial communication. None, odd or even can be selected.
Control Type: The available control modes are:
• No Control Type, this option selects the serial communication mode, for use with serial communication ports (front
port, RS485, or plastic or glass fiber optic).
• MODBUS/TCP, this option selects ModBus TCP/IP communication mode, for communication through the Ethernet
port. In this case, the top right window will show the typical parameters to be programmed; IP address, port address
and unit identifier in the MODBUS TCP SETUP section.
• MODEM, this option displays the parameter to set in case of using a modem for the communication, such as Phone 3
number, Time out (sec.), init. command, type of dialing (tones or pulses).

3.1.4.2 COMMUNICATION CONTROL:


Located at the bottom of the screen, it shows the status of the communication with the relay. With relay not communicating,
a message "650 Setup is not talking to an 650" will be shown and ON button will be enable. Pressing this button, 650 Setup
start communicating with the relay.
With relay communicating a message "650 Setup is now talking to an 650" will be shown and OFF will be enable. Pressing
this button, communications between relay and PC will be closed.

3.1.4.3 COMMUNICATION OPTIMIZATION:


The parameters shown on the bottom right window (Communication optimization) can improve communication, although it
is recommended to leave the default values indicated by the EnerVista 650 Setup. These parameters are the maximum
time to wait for a response in the relay (in ms) and the maximum attempts to perform before assuming communications
failure.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-5


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.1.5 FILE MANAGEMENT

File management with EnerVista 650 Setup software:

3.1.5.1 OFF LINE MODE


1

Run EnerVista 650 Setup

Open a *.650 file


(“File>Open” menu)

Modify Settings and relay


configuration

YES
3 Is it necessary to
program
additional logic?

Launch the Logic Configuration tool in EnerVista


650 Setup (“Setpoint>Logic Configuration”)

Create new or modify the existing logic:


(“File>Open Project”)
NO NO

Compile and save logic file (*.pep) and drawing


design (*.aut) in Logic Configuration tool

Exit PLC Graphic Editor and save the *.650 file


from the main application menu

Is the relay
completely
configured?

YES

Save *.650 settings & configuration file

Store in the computer the Logic configuration files (*.pep, *.aut, *.lib) as
well as the *.650 for further logic changes.

Figure 3–3: OFF-LINE MODE FILE MANAGEMENT

1.Note: “Relay and logic configuration” and “Protection and Control Settings” are required to be uploaded to the
F650 relay in order for the device to operate properly

3-6 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

Table 3.1: TYPES OF FILES GENERATED BY ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE OPERATION MODE OFF-LINE:

LOGIC CONFIGURATION FILES (*.PEP, *AUT, *.LIB)


SETTINGS & CONFIGURATION FILE *.650
*.PEP *.AUT *.LIB
Graphical edition
Header for Logic container. Logic User programmable
Description Settings and Configuration Section equations (Virtual
project logic objects
Outputs) in FDB
format.
Logic configuration Logic configuration Logic configuration
Created by EnerVista 650 Setup graphic editor (PLC graphic editor (PLC graphic editor (PLC
Editor) Editor) Editor)
PLC project file Library file to be
containing the PLC Project file
containing all the included as an
necessary object in a PLC
Relay configuration file containing all elements information relative drawings used by
project. Logic
Settings, input/output and LEDs configuration, graphic to the relay model, the logic, required by
Contents display configuration, etc. 650 relay based on packages that can
logic libraries be stored into
Equations corresponding to the logic created and included in the IEC 61131-3
libraries and be
compiled in the PLC Editor standard. Functional
project (*.lib), distributed in
block diagram
graphic file name different PLC
(*.aut), etc. (FDB).
projects.
PLC Editor: PLC Editor: PLC Editor:
EnerVista 650 Setup:
How to save "File>Save "File>Save "File>Save
"File>Save *"
Project"
PLC Editor:
Project"
PLC Editor:
Library"
PLC Editor:
3
How to open EnerVista 650 Setup: "File>Open "File>Open "File>Library>New
"File>Open *"
Project" Project" Library"

Connect with the relay ("Communications>Computer")


Connect with the relay Launch Logic equations Editor ("Setpoint>Logic
("Communications>Computer") Configuration")
How to Open the created file ("File>Open *") Open the created PLC project ("File>Open Project")
transfer to Send to relay from the menu: "File>Send info to relay" Compile the project ("Run>Compile")
relay Note that texts used in the configuration of inputs, Now the logic (virtual outputs) can be sent directly to relay
outputs, etc. are not sent to the relay. The only texts ("Run>Send Equations to Relay"). Texts of virtual outputs are
sent to relay are operations, events, and LEDs. not stored in the relay, only in the logic configuration files to be
edited.

In case of using element libraries (either existing ("File Library>Open Library") or created by the user ("File Library>New
Library"), the program will create and manage the corresponding files (*.lib) in a folder named FDB (Functional Block
Diagram). These files are used for the PLC project compilation. It is necessary to store them with the other logic
configuration files that built the PLC project (*.pep, *.aut, *.lib).
Besides sending basic information to the relay (Settings + configuration) in *.650 format, it is recommended to store *.650,
*.pep, *.aut and *.lib files inside the relay ("Communication>Upload info files to relay"), to ensure that logic configuration
files will be available in the future for further logic modifications; either if these files are not used by the relay, they are
required for connecting to a relay and analyzing its configuration. The program manages the logic configuration files
globally, so that when the user selects to save file *.pep in the relay, the associated *.aut and *.lib files are also stored.

File storage inside the relay


"Communication > Upload info files to relay" through Ethernet
(RECOMMENDED)
Retrieval of files stored in the relay
"Communication > Download info files from relay" through Ethernet
(RECOMMENDED)

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-7


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.1.5.2 ON LINE MODE

Run EnerVista 650 Setup

Connect to the relay


(“Communication>Computer>ON”)
NO
Modify and send to the
relay protection Settings
and relay configuration

YES
Is it necessary to
program
3 additional logic?

Launch the Logic Configuration tool in EnerVista


650 Setup (“Setpoint>Logic Configuration”)

Create new or modify the existing logic


(“File>Open Project”)

NO Compile (“Run>Compile”)
and save logic file (*.pep) and drawing design
(*.aut) in Logic Configuration tool (“File>Save
Project”)

Send logic to relay (“Run>Send Equations to


Relay”) and Exit PLC Graphic Editor

Is the relay
completely
configured?

YES

Save all settings & configuration (“File>Get info from relay”)

Store in the relay the Logic configuration files (*.pep, *.aut, *.lib) as well as the
*.650 for further logic changes. (“Communication>Upload info files to relay”)

Figure 3–4: ON LINE MODE FILE MANAGEMENT

3-8 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

Table 3.2: TYPES OF FILES GENERATED BY ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE OPERATION MODE ON-LINE

LOGIC CONFIGURATION FILES (*.PEP, *.AUT, *.LIB)


SETTINGS & CONFIGURATION FILE *.650
*.PEP *.AUT *.LIB
Graphical edition
Header for Logic container. Logic User programmable
Description Settings and Configuration Section equations (Virtual
project logic objects
Outputs) in FDB
format.
Logic configuration Logic configuration Logic configuration
Created by EnerVista 650 Setup graphic editor (PLC graphic editor (PLC graphic editor (PLC
Editor) Editor) Editor)
PLC project file
containing the PLC Project file
containing all the Library file to be
necessary included as an object
Relay configuration file containing all elements, settings, information relative drawings used by
in a PLC project.
input/output and LEDs configuration, graphic display to the relay model, the logic, required
Contents configuration, etc. by 650 relay based Logic packages that
logic libraries can be stored into
Equations corresponding to the logic created and included in the on IEC 61131-3
libraries and be
compiled in the PLC Editor standard.
project (*.lib), distributed in different
Functional block
graphic file name PLC projects.
(*.aut), etc. diagram (FDB).

Connect with the relay ("Communications>Computer") Connect with the relay ("Communications>Computer")
Launch 650 Logic equations editor ("Setpoint>Logic
Configuration") 3
Open the created PLC project ("File>Open Project")
Compile the project ("Run>Compile")

How to Send settings and configuration from file


transfer to
relay
Now the logic (virtual outputs) can be sent directly to relay
("Run>Send Equations to Relay"). Texts of virtual outputs are
not stored in the relay, only in the logic configuration files to be
edited.

Modify settings and configuration directly in the relay:

PLC Editor:
"File>Save Project" "File>Save Library"
The relay will not The relay will not The relay will not
EnerVista 650 Setup: provide this provide this provide this
How to save "File>Get info from relay". User definable texts information unless information unless information unless
retrieved are operations, events, and LEDs. the *.pep file is the *.pep file is the *.pep file is stored
stored in the relay stored in the relay. in the relay.
To store the logic configuration files in the relay use the
"Communication>Upload info files to relay" option
How to store "Communication>Upload info files to relay" through "Communication>Upload info files to relay" through
in the relay Ethernet Ethernet
How to "Communication/Download info files from relay"
"Communication/Download info files from relay" through
retrieve from through Ethernet
Ethernet
the relay

REMINDER:

Logic programming support files (*.pep, *.aut, *.lib) CANNOT be retrieved directly from the relay.

It is necessary
* Either to have stored these files in the PC
* Or to have uploaded previously the files into the relay ("Communication>Upload info files to relay")

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-9


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.1.6 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP MENU STRUCTURE

The EnerVista 650 Setup menus structure is shown in Table 3.3:.


Unless specified, options are available in both On-line and Off-line mode.
Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*)
Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**)
The "View > Language" submenu allows the user to change the default language for the
EnerVista 650 Setup program and it is only enabled when the relay is not communicating and no
file has been opened.

Table 3.3: ENERVISTA 650 SETUP MENUS STRUCTURE


IEC 61850
FILE SETPOINT ACTUAL OPERATIONS(*) COMMUNICATION CONFIGURAT SECURITY VIEW HELP
OR
Instruction
New (**) Product Setup Front Panel Fixed commands Computer Login user Traces
Manual
ModBus
Open (**) System Setup Status NA Modem (*) Change GE Multilin
Memory
Password on the web
3 Protection User
Map

Languages
About
Save (**) Elements Metering NA Troubleshooting (*) Management (**) EnerVista
650 Setup
Save As Control Inputs/
(**) Elements Outputs NA Calibration (*)

Inputs/
Close (**) Outputs Records (*) NA Upgrade Relay (*)
Quick Settings
Config File Relay
(* 650) Configuration NA
Converter
Compare
to settings
file
Properties Logic Upgrade 650 Web
(**) Configuration NA Server
Procome Update magnetic
Configuration module
IEC103
Configuration
Get info
from relay Upload info files to
Clock (*) NA relay
(*)
Send info Download info files
to relay (*) NA from relay
Print
Setup (**) NA

Print
Preview NA
(**)
Print (**) NA
Print to file
PLC
Checksum
calculation
(**)
PCL
Checksum
calculation
Setpoint
checksum
calculation
Order
code
Exit

3-10 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

3.1.7 FILE MENU OVERVIEW

Table 3.4: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF FILE MENU:


Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*). Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**)

FILE
Create a new settings and configuration file, with the default relay
New (**)
settings and no configuration
Open (**) Open a settings and configuration file for off-line working.
Save (**) Save *.650 settings and configuration file
Save As (**) Save as *.650 settings and configuration file.
Close (**) Close the opened *.650 file in EnerVista 650 Setup.
Config File (*.650) Converter Tool to convert the *.650 files from one version to another
Compare to settings file Compare online unit or opened settings file to another settings file
Properties (**) File properties for *.650.

Get info from relay (*) Retrieve the *.650 settings and relay configuration compiled equations
from the relay. 3
Send info to relay (*) Send and write the *.650 settings and configuration to the relay.
Print Setup (**) To configure printer settings.
Print Preview (**) Preview of settings and configuration file printing format.
Print (**) Launch the *.650 file to be printed.
Print to file (*.xls) (**) *.650 printed to file in excel format.
Calculate the CRC of PLC equations of the .650 file (When a .650 is
PLC Checksum Calculation uploaded to the relay, the calculate PLC CRC and the actual value of the
PLC CRC read from the relay must match).
Calculate the CRC of settings of the .650 file (When a .650 is uploaded to
Settings Checksum
Calculation the relay, the calculate Setting CRC and the actual value of the Setting
CRC read from the relay must match).
Option available for F650 with firmware version 7.00 or above. It allows
customers to get special functionality model (see model selection) with
Order code(*) password requirements. For detailed information go to section "9.6.3.3
ORDERING CODE UPGRADE PROCESS" in chapter 9.
Exit Quit the application closing all the open windows.

Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*). Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**)

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-11


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.1.7.1 NEW, OPEN, SAVE, SAVE AS AND CLOSE


In these options, the program opens a dialog box (with default path to Files>Config program folder) where the setting and
configuration files can be selected for their "off-line" edition. For enabling access to this menu, there must be no
communication between the PC program and the relay.

Figure 3–5: OPEN FILE MENU

Once the *.650 file with the appropriated relay model (FXGX) is selected, the program will enable the off-line options to fully
program the unit. The enabled menus in the EnerVista 650 Setup program are: File, Setpoint, Actual, Communication, View
and Help.
The off-line mode displays the File, Setpoint, Actual, Communication, Security, View and Help submenus to program the
unit.
The Actual values submenus are for structure purposes only Values are not refreshed while the relay is not communicating.
The "Save as" and "Close" submenus are used to save the *.650 file into the computer and to close the current file. To work
in off line mode for settings and configuration edition it is not necessary to use the "Close" option, a new *.650 can be
opened without closing the previous one. The "Close" option is used to clear all data in EnerVista 650 Setup program,
enabling "Language", "Upgrade firmware version" and "Upgrade Operating system" options.

3-12 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

3.1.7.2 CONFIG FILE (*650) CONVERTER

3
Figure 3–6: CONFIG FILE (*650) CONVERTER MENU
This tool provides automatic conversion of configuration files from a firmware version to a previous or later version.
Open the source *.650 file and select the version and model to be converted to.
It is possible to change the model type (FXGX) using the conversion tool. It must be taken into account that part of the logic
can be readjusted to fit the new input and output boards selection. Notice also that the external wiring of inputs and outputs
board are different for type 1, 2, 4 and 5.

3.1.7.3 PROPERTIES
When this option is selected, the program will show a screen including the relay model information, firmware version, etc. of
the file being edited, as shown on Figure 3–7:

Figure 3–7: FILE PROPERTIES MENU

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-13


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.1.7.4 PRINTING OPTIONS (PRINT SETUP/PRINT PREVIEW/PRINT/PRINT TO FILE)


The printing options are active only in off-line mode, in "File edition", and not in on-line mode, connected with the relay.
a) PRINT SETUP
Option to configure the printing options and settings for the printing device.

b) PRINT PREVIEW
Option to preview the whole settings and configuration file (*.650) in paper format to be printed as shown in Figure 3–8:

Figure 3–8: PRINT PREVIEW OF SETTINGS FILE

c) PRINT
In this option, the program will print the relay configuration using the PC default (active) printer on port COMx or LPT. This
option is active only in off-line mode, in file edition, and not in on-line mode, connected with the relay.

d) PRINT TO FILE (*XLS)


Possibility to export the configuration file to an Excel file using the "Print to file (*.xls)" option.

3-14 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

3.1.7.5 COMPARE TO SETTINGS FILE


This tool provides automatic comparison of two different configuration files, or online unit to one settings file.
Open the source *.650 file and select the version and model to be compared to.

Figure 3–9: COMPARE TO SETTINGS FILE

It will appear the Figure 3–9: with the differences.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-15


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.1.8 SETPOINT MENU OVERVIEW

Table 3.5: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF SETPOINT MENU IN ENERVISTA 650 SETUP:

SETPOINT
Communications settings for all protocols and physical mediums.
Product Setup ModBus user map definition, fault report, oscillography, data logger
demand settings and Time Settings.
General Settings, Flex Curves Definition, Breaker settings maintenance,
System Setup switchgear snapshot events management and Miscellaneous Settings.
Phase, Neutral, Ground, Sensitive Ground and Negative Sequence
Protection Elements Current Settings. Voltage Elements settings and Power Settings
management.
Setting groups, under and overfrequency settings, synchrocheck,
autoreclose, breaker failure, VT fuse failure, broken conductor, locked
Control Elements rotor settings management, Pulse Counters, Analog comparators,
Frequency Rate of Change, Load encroachment, max number of starts,
Digital Counters, Cold Load Pickup and PLC Timer Masks
Contact I/O settings for all boards available in device, Remote Comms
Inputs/Outputs
Force Outputs and Virtual inputs.
Menu that encompass the most important settings to configure the
Quick Settings device such as; Current and Voltage sensing or current protection
element.
3 Configuration of Outputs, LEDs, Operations, Protection Elements,
Oscillography, Control Events, Control Elements, Switchgear, Inputs,
Relay Configuration
Virtual Inputs, Operations and HMI. Whole relay configuration with
internal relay signals or user-definable ones as logic (virtual outputs).
Logic configuration graphic editor (PLC Editor). It is a PLC Project file
editor that contains all the internal drawings used to make the logic
Logic Configuration
(virtual outputs) based on IEC 61131-3 standard. Functional block
diagram (FDB).
Procome Configuration tool. Only available for Procome models (5)
Procome Configuration when communicating through Ethernet with EnerVista 650 Setup
IEC103 settings for available IEC103 models (3) when communicating
IEC103 Configuration
through Ethernet with Enervista 650 Setup
Relay synchronization to computer clock or to user-definable date and
Clock (*)
time. On-line mode only.

Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*). Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**)

3.1.8.1 PRODUCT SETUP

Table 3.6: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF PRODUCT SETUP MENU:


PRODUCT
SETUP
Serial Ports, Network (Ethernet), ModBus Protocol, DNP Slave, IEC 870-
Communication
5-104, SNTP settings and procome (if available on model selection),
Settings PTP1588 and Routing (for firmware version 7.00 and higher)
ModBus user map definition. The ModBus user map is formed by 256
ModBus User Map
records, selectable from the complete relay ModBus map.
Fault Report Fault report settings. Possibility to show fault reports on HMI screen.
Oscillography settings (trigger position, samples per cycle, etc.). The
Oscillography trigger and digital channels (up to 16) must be configured in
"Setpoint>Relay configuration".
Data Logger Data logger configuration
Demand settings. The demand trigger and demand reset signals must be
Demand
configured in "Setpoint>Relay configuration"
Time Settings Time settings.

Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*). Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**)

3-16 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

a) COMMUNICATION SETTINGS
This section details the settings related to communication parameters for the different protocols available in the F650.

Table 3.7: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF COMMUNICATION SETTINGS MENU:


COMMUNICATION
SETTINGS
Serial Ports Baud rate and parity for COM1 and COM2 serial communication ports.
Ethernet communication parameters for ETH_1/ETH2 or ETH_E/ETH_A/
ETH_B (Depending on model) (IP Address, Netmask, Gateway IP)

Network (Ethernet) NOTE: The ModBus Slave address used by Ethernet ports is the one set
for COM2.EnerVista 650 Setup software allows programming two
different Ethernet addresses, but the first IP has always to be set as the
second IP Address is an Alias.
ModBus Slave Addresses for serial and Ethernet communication and the
ModBus Protocol
ModBus port number used for ModBus TCP/IP
Physical port, Slave Address for DNP, IP Addresses for Masters, TCP/
DNP3 Slave UDP Port, Unsolicited Response parameters, Analog scale factors and
deadbands, message fragment size, Binary input block.Available for
standard and IEC61850 models.

IEC 870-5-104
TCP Port, Common Addr of ASDU, Cyclic Meter Period and,
Synchronization Event settings.Available for standard and IEC61850
3
models.
SNTP (*) Synchronization over Ethernet settings

PROCOME Comm port and slave number for procome protocol. Only available for
procome models (5).

PTP 1588 Precission Time Protocol 1588 settings. (Available on fw version 7.00 or
higher)
A default route and a maximum number of 6 static routes may be
configured. The default route is used as the last choice, if no other route
Routing
towards a given destination is found.This option is only available for
version 7.00 and higher.

Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*). Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**)

3.1.8.2 SYSTEM SETUP


This section shows the settings related to the system setup definition such as shown in the following table.
Table 3.8: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF SYSTEM SETUP MENU:
SYSTEM
SETUP
This screen describes and enables the settings of the power system
where the relay will operate. Some of these settings will be used only for
metering values presentation purposes; however, some of them apply
General Settings
directly to the sampling and analog-digital conversion process (rated
frequency setting). Therefore, these settings need to be adjusted so that
they fit the system settings.
Flex Curves – Programmable user curves: The relay incorporates 4
user curves called Flex Curve A, B, C and D. The points for these curves
Flex Curves are defined by the user in "Setpoint>System Setup>Flex Curves>Edit
Curve" menu in EnerVista 650 Setup. User defined flex curves can be
selected as an operation curve in all the time overcurrent functions in the
relay.
Breaker Breaker Configuration
Miscellaneous: Configuration of snapshot events for each switchgear (enable or disable)
This screen contains settings related with relay working mode. Out of
Miscellaneous Settings service setting, Local/Remote mode and Active language mode are
options listed below.

Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*). Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**)

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-17


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.1.8.3 BREAKER
This section shows the settings related to the Breaker definition such as shown in the following table

Breaker settings, maintenance and switchgear selection of the device


configured as breaker in the F650. The selected switchgear will be used
Breaker settings in recloser, breaker failure and synchronism functions. The settings are
Number of Switchgear, Maximum KI2t, KI2t Integ. Time, Maximum
Openings, Max.Openings 1 hour and Snapshot Events.
These settings correspond to the initialization of (KI)2t counters, and the
counting of number of openings and closings of the switchgear
configured as breaker. These Counters allow the breaker Maintenance.
Breaker maintenance They are used to cumulate the breaker ageing produced by a trip or a
breaker opening. In order to incorporate the breaker historic, in case of
existing breakers, the system allows assigning an initial value to
accumulated amperes, and to the number of opening and closing
operations.

3.1.8.4 PROTECTION ELEMENTS


This option shows all the protection-grouped elements available in the relay as shown in Table 3.9:. Each of these groups
3 includes the specific protection units of the same type. For example phase currents group includes TOC, IOC, directional
units, etc. There are three groups available, so there are three protection units of each function that can work in grouped
mode or ungrouped (altogether).

Table 3.9: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF PROTECTION ELEMENTS MENU:


PROTECTION
ELEMENTS
Phase Current All overcurrent grouped functions for phase current.

Neutral Current All overcurrent grouped functions for neutral current. (Calculated from
phases, not measured)

Ground Current All overcurrent grouped functions for ground current. (Measured from 4th
current input)
Sensitive Ground All overcurrent grouped functions for sensitive ground current.
Current (Measured from 5th current input)
Negative Sequence
Current All Negative sequence overcurrent grouped functions.
All voltage grouped functions for phases, neutral, ground and auxiliary
Voltage Elements
voltage

Power Forward power, directional power and wattmetric ground fault (High and
Low) grouped protection functions.

Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*). Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**)

Table 3.10: PROTECTION ELEMENTS INCLUDED


PHASE
CURRENT
Phase TOC High Phase time overcurrent, high level (51PH)
Phase TOC Low Phase time overcurrent, low level (51PL)
Phase IOC High Phase instantaneous overcurrent, high level (50PH)
Phase IOC Low Phase instantaneous overcurrent, low level (50PL)
Phase Directional Phase directional unit (67P). Quadrature Voltage for polarization
Thermal Model Thermal model or Thermal image unit for phases (49)

3-18 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

NEUTRAL
CURRENT
Neutral TOC Neutral time overcurrent (51N)
Neutral IOC Neutral instantaneous overcurrent (50N)
Neutral Directional Neutral directional unit (67N). Voltage, current and dual polarization.
GROUND
CURRENT
Ground TOC Ground time overcurrent (51G)
Ground IOC Ground instantaneous overcurrent (50G)
Ground Directional Ground directional unit (67G). Voltage, current and dual polarization.
SENSITIVE
GROUND
CURRENT
Sensitive Ground TOC Sensitive ground time overcurrent (51SG).
Sensitive Ground IOC Sensitive ground instantaneous overcurrent (50SG).
Isolated Ground IOC Isolated ground overcurrent (50IG)
Sensitive Ground
Sensitive ground directional unit (67SG)

NEGATIVE
Directional 3
SEQUENCE
CURRENT
Negative Sequence
TOC Negative sequence time overcurrent (46P)

VOLTAGE
ELEMENTS
Phase UV Phase undervoltage (27P)
Phase OV Phase overvoltage (59P)
Neutral OV High Neutral overvoltage, high level (59NH)
Neutral OV Low Neutral overvoltage, low level (59NL)
Negative Sequence
Negative sequence overvoltage (47)
OV
Auxiliary OV Auxiliary overvoltage (59X)
Auxiliary UV Auxiliary undervoltage (27X)

POWER
Forward Power Forward power (32FP), in primary values.
Directional Power Directional power (32), in primary values.
Watt Gnd Flt High Wattmetric ground fault high (32N High), in secondary values

Watt Gnd Flt Low Wattmetric ground fault low (32N Low), in secondary values

3.1.8.5 CONTROL ELEMENTS


This option shows all the control elements available in the relay as shown in Table 3.11:. Some of the elements are grouped
ones such as underfrequency, overfrequency and broken conductor.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-19


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

Table 3.11: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF CONTROL ELEMENTS MENU:


CONTROL
ELEMENTS
F650 units incorporate a flexible grouping capability for protection units.
This means that protection units can be used in either single setting
group (default mode-all units can operate simultaneously) or three
setting groups (in this mode, protection units are grouped in three
independent tables, with only one of them active at a given time).
Setting Group Protection element grouping involves only Protection elements together
with broken conductor detection and over and under frequency, which
are usually considered as control elements. The rest of control elements
such as recloser, fuse failure, breaker failure, synchronism, and breaker
settings are not involved in the tabled groups concept.
Underfrequency Underfrequency unit (81U). Grouped element
Overfrequency Overfrequency unit (81O). Grouped element
Synchrocheck Synchronism check unit (25). Not grouped, a single unit provided
Autoreclose Recloser (79). Not grouped, a single unit provided
Breaker Failure Breaker failure (50BF). Not grouped, a single unit provided.
VT Fuse Failure Fuse Failure (VTFF). Not grouped, a single unit provided.

3 Broken or fallen conductor detection function (I2/I1). Grouped element.


Ratio between the negative sequence current, I2, and the positive
Broken Conductor sequence current I1. In normal and balanced load situations, this ratio is
zero, while in severe load fault conditions, an unbalance is produced and
this ratio is increased.
Locked Rotor Locked rotor detection function (48). Grouped element.
Pulse Counters Pulse counters function. 8 counters provided.
Analog Comparators Analog comparator function. 20 analog comparators provided.
Frequency rate of
Frequency rate of change function (81R).Grouped element.
change
Load Encroachment Load Encroachment function. Grouped element.
Max. Number of Starts Maximum Number of Starts (66). Not grouped, a single unit provided.

Digital Counters Up to 8 Digital Counters


Cold Load Pickup Function. Not grouped, a single unit provided
Cold Load Pickup
(Available starting on firmware version 7.00).
PLC Timer Masks Configuration of masks that can be assigned to PLC timers

3.1.8.6 INPUT/OUTPUTS
Section that contains the settings for all input and output boards and the Force Outputs and Virtual inputs activation tools.
Table 3.12: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF “INPUTS/OUTPUTS” SETTINGS MENU.
INPUTS/
OUTPUTS
Inputs and outputs settings for all boards in F650. The I/O settings
Contact I/O configuration can only be performed through EnerVista 650 Setup, not
HMI available.
This menu allows activating each contact output in the relay, to facilitate
Force Outputs (*)
maintenance testing. On line mode only.
This menu allows operating virtual inputs. These variables are used as
inputs to logic schemes configured in the relay. Virtual inputs can be
Virtual Inputs (*)
operated in a latched mode (32 latched virtual inputs) or in Self-reset
mode (32 self reset virtual inputs).
This menu allows configuring remote inputs coming from other devices
Remote Comms. and allow enabling None, GSSE or GOOSE messages. Available for
IEC61850 (6) models only.

Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*). Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**)

This section shows the settings related to inputs and outputs for the different boards available in F650 (F, G, H, J).

3-20 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

Table 3.13: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF “INPUTS/OUTPUTS>CONTACT I/O” SETTINGS MENU.

CONTACT I/O
Board F Board located in first slot, always connected.
Board located in second slot, depends on model definition. If model is
Board G type G0 there is no board in second slot.
Board H Board located in first slot of CIO Module (external inputs/outputs module)
Board located in second slot of CIO Module (external inputs/outputs
Board J module)

3.1.8.7 QUICK SETTINGS


This menu allows a quick access to the main Setpoints of the relay.

Figure 3–10: QUICK SETTINGS

3.1.8.8 RELAY CONFIGURATION


This is the relay configuration section in which the relay can be configured using internal states or already compiled
equation on PLC Editor.

Table 3.14: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF RELAY CONFIGURATION MENU:

RELAY CONFIG

Outputs Configuration of contact output operate and reset signals for all boards.
15 LEDs fully configurable from any logical variable, contact or virtual
input. First 5 LEDs are latched by hardware, the rest are self-reset but
LEDs can be latched through PLC configuration. For firmware version 7.20 and
higher, all 15 LEDs could be latched by setting. From the LED
configuration screen, it is possible to print the vertical LED label for the
relay.
Configurable operations up to 24. Operation texts, interlocks, final states,
Operations
frontal keys, time outs and masters.
This tab allows assigning operands (logic signals) as inputs to different
Protection Elements protection elements. To block, reset, initiate the different protection
elements inputs.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-21


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

This tab allows assigning operands (logic signals) as inputs to different


Control Elements control elements.
Trigger and up to 16 digital channels to be included in oscillography
records, are programmable from any logical variable, contact or virtual
input. Text configuration is only for off-line mode.
Oscillography NOTE: This screen is used for the configuration of digital channels and
oscillography trigger. The rest of parameters, such as function enabling/
disabling, sampling rate, number of oscillography files, etc. must be set
on the Setpoint>Product Setup>Oscillography menu.
Up to 128 user programmable events from any logical variable, contact
or virtual input. Possibility to display the event as an alarm on the alarms
Control Events panel. Control events are also displayed in the snapshot events
recording. 1 ms time tagging.
A control event is a logic signal associated to an operand or combination
of operands, that allows following the status of that signal.
Up to 16 configurable switchgear elements. A switchgear element can be
a breaker, a line selector switch, a grounding selector switch, a busbar
selector switch, etc. This screen allows configuration of type of contacts,
Switchgear opening and closing time, contact assignation and text for events related
to switchgear. There are 64 pre-established events for switchgear, which
correspond to opening, closing, Error01 and Error11 of the 16
programmable switchgear elements.
Up to 32 DNA bits and 64 user St bits to be transmitted to remote devices
Remote outputs over CAN using GSSE messages
Text configuration for off-line mode file management for all the contact
3 Inputs
inputs available in device.
Text configuration for off-line mode file management. 32 latched and 32
Virtual Inputs
self reset virtual inputs.
Screen one line diagram configuration. This menu shows a canvas to
MMI (HMI-Human draw a simplified one-line diagram of a bay in a feeder, line, transformer,
Machine Interface) etc. The menu includes a library for power elements, metering elements,
text and drawings. See an example on the next page.

3-22 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

The following figures show an example of the default factory configuration for F650:

Figure 3–11: RELAY CONFIGURATION

Figure 3–12: HMI CONFIGURATION

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-23


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.1.8.9 LOGIC CONFIGURATION


This logic configuration allows creating more complex configurations, using the graphical PLC, than using the tables from
Relay Configuration. For file management detailed information go to section 3.1.5.
File description:
*.pep: Header for Logic project: PLC project file containing the necessary information relative to the relay model, logic
libraries included in the project (*.lib), graphic file name (*.aut), etc.
*.aut: PLC Project file containing all the drawings used by the logic, required by 650 relay based on IEC 61131-3
standard. Functional block diagram (FDB).
*.lib:User programmable logic objects: Library file to be included as an object in a PLC project. Logic packages that can be
stored into libraries and be distributed in different PLC projects.

3.1.8.10 IEC103 CONFIGURATION


This menu allows to update the IEC 103 configuration of the unit.

Figure 3–13: IEC103 CONFIGURATOR


See chapter 5.13

3.1.8.11 CLOCK
This menu allows to update the date and time of the relay, either synchronizing them with the PC clock, or entering the
information manually.

3-24 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

Figure 3–14: CLOCK

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-25


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.1.9 ACTUAL VALUES MENU OVERVIEW

The menu bar in the main screen of EnerVista 650 Setup software shows the ACTUAL menu option. This option
concentrates and displays all the status of protection, control elements, metering, counters information, oscillography,
events, fault locator, etc. This section shows only the structure of menus in EnerVista 650 Setup.

Table 3.15: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF ACTUAL VALUES MAIN MENU:


ACTUAL
Front Panel The relay front LEDs status is shown on this menu.
Protection and control status signals for all available protection functions
Status in device.
All metering values available in device. Primary and secondary values,
Metering frequency and phasor diagram provided.

Inputs/Outputs All input and output status provided. For contact inputs and contact
outputs as well as virtual input and virtual output signals.
Only enabled in on line mode, retrieval of all the available records in
Records device. Snapshot events, control events, oscillography and fault reports.

3.1.9.1 FRONT PANEL


The front panel menu shows only the LEDs submenu where all the front LEDs can be monitored.
3
3.1.9.2 STATUS
The following menu includes all the available protection status in the device.

Table 3.16: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF STATUS MENU:


STATUS
Up to 24 elements. OPERATION BIT XX is (0) when the configured time
Operation bits out for the operation XX expires or when success conditions are met.
And it is (1) if operation XX is executed and interlocks are fulfilled.
Breaker status (open, closed or undefined). The rest of the status signals
Breaker corresponding to the switchgear XX configured as breaker are in the
"Status>Switchgear Status>Switchgear XX" menu.
Protection Status of all the protection units in the device.
Control Elements Status of all the control units available in the device.
This screen shows a complete list of all protection and control elements
Protection Summary
in the relay, showing their status (enabled or not).
Snapshots events Summary of the snapshot events status (enabled or disabled) for
summary protection, control, inputs and outputs boards and switchgear.
Up to 256 elements. Value in SIGNED INT 16 BIT format of the reading
ModBus User Map for the selected address configured in "Setpoint>Product
Setup>ModBus User Map"
Up to 16 blocks of switchgear status signals for the 16 configurable
devices. Status signals such as inputs for A and B contacts, status for A
Switchgear Status and B, open and close status, error 00 and error 11, open init and close
init, fail to open and fail to close signals.
Internal states for calibration. Factory calibration and calibration error
Calibration
signals.
Flex curve status for A, B, C and D user curves. (0) if it is not configured,
Flex Curves (1) if it is configured. To configure a flex curve go to "Setpoint>System
Setup>Flex Curves" menu.
This screen can monitor the system parameters and the internal status of
System Info
the Relay operative system. Not enabled by default, password required
Information related to the different records stored in the Relay, such as:
Records Status Fault reports, control events, oscillography, data logger, demand, energy,
and breaker maintenance.
SNTP-IRIG_B & PTP
Information related to synchronization via IRIG_B, SNTP or PTP1588.
1588
Information related to the different firmware versions and hardware
Versions
revisions.

3-26 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

Information related to the status of the frames sent through PRP and
Redundancy HSR. Also information related to the status of RSTP port.

Table 3.17: ACTUAL VALUES INCLUDED IN THE PROTECTION MENU

PROTECTION
Protection Blocks This screen shows all the protection element blocks available. Protection
elements block signals can be configured at "Setpoint>Relay
Configuration > Protection Elements".
Phase Current Protection status signals (pickups and operations) for time overcurrent,
instantaneous overcurrent and directional protection functions for phase
current.
Neutral Current Protection status signals (pickups and operations) for time overcurrent,
instantaneous overcurrent and directional protection functions for neutral
current (calculated from phases).
Ground Current Protection status signals (pickups and operations) for time overcurrent,
instantaneous overcurrent and directional protection functions for ground
current (measured from 4th current input).
Sensitive Ground Protection status signals (pickups and operations) for time overcurrent,
Current instantaneous overcurrent, isolated and directional protection functions
for ground current (measured from 5th current input).
Negative Sequence
Current
Protection status signals (pickups and operations) for negative sequence
time overcurrent function.
3
Thermal Model Protection status signals for thermal model. Reset, alarm and operation
signals for phases and for unit, besides the thermal image values in
percentage for all phases and units.
Voltage Protection status signals (pickups and operations) for all voltage
functions, undervoltage, overvoltage, neutral overvoltage, negative
sequence overvoltage and auxiliary under and over voltage.
Power Protection status signals (pickups and operations) for forward, directional
and wattmetric ground fault (high and low) power units, and power factor
status. Power values for 32N High and Low functions (in watts).

Table 3.18: DIFFERENT CONTROL ACTUAL VALUES INCLUDED IN THE CONTROL ELEMENTS MENU
CONTROL
ELEMENTS
Frequency Status signals (pickups and operations) for under, overfrequency and
frequency rate of change units.
Synchrocheck Status signals for synchrocheck function (25).
Autoreclose Status signals for autoreclose function (79). Close signal, recloser status
(ready, lockout, etc.), block signals after each shot.
Breaker Failure Status signals for breaker failure function (50BF).
VT Fuse Failure Fuse failure detection signal.
Broken Conductor Status signals (pickups and operations) for broken conductor (I2/I1).
Setting Groups Status signals (activations and blocks) for the relay setting group change.
By default the "setting group" setting is disabled and all the grouped
elements can be enabled at the same time.
Locked Rotor Status signals (pickups and operations) for locked rotor units.
Pulse Counters Status signals for pulse counters units.
Analog Comparator Status signals for analog comparator units.
Load Encroachment Status signals (pickups and operations) for load encroachment units.
Max.Number of Starts Status signal for number of starts operations
Digital Counters Status signals for the Digital Counter units.

Cold Load Pickup Status signals for the Cold Load Pickup Function.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-27


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

Table 3.19: ACTUAL VALUES RELATED TO RECORDING FUNCTIONS IN THE RECORDS STATUS MENU:
RECORD
STATUS
Fault Reports This menu shows the fault report status signals, as fault report trigger,
fault date, fault type and location, besides the fault report number.
Control Events Status of the control events (if the signal configured to launch the control
event is active or not).
Oscillography Status of signals related to oscillography recording, such as status or
digital channels, oscillography trigger, number of records available, etc.
Data Logger Data logger information about oldest and newest sample time stamp,
and number of channels and days configured in data logger settings.
Demand Demand trigger and reset inputs status.
Energy Freeze, unfreeze and reset input signals for energy counters.
Breaker Maintenance All signals related to breaker maintenance, such as number of openings,
closings, (KI)2t counters, alarm signal for (KI)2t, etc.

3.1.9.3 METERING
The Metering menu includes all the measurements available in the device. Primary and secondary values, and also the
data related to the recording functions in the relay.
3 Table 3.20: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF METERING MENU:

METERING
Primary Values Primary values measurements for currents, voltages, power, energy and
demand
Secondary Values Secondary values measurements for currents, voltages and power.
Phasor Diagram Current, voltage and sequence components.
Frequency Line and Bus frequencies.

3.1.9.4 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
The Inputs/Outputs menu includes all the inputs and outputs signals available in the device. Contact and virtual type.

Table 3.21: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF INPUTS/OUTPUTS MENU:


INPUTS/
OUTPUTS
Contact Inputs Status of digital inputs in the Relay for each board according to the relay
model.
Contact Output Status Status of digital outputs in the Relay for each board according to the relay
model.
Contact Outputs Status (activated or not) of the variables used to operate a contact
Operates output. To configure these signals go to "Setpoint>Relay
Configuration>Outputs" menu.
Contact Outputs Status (activated or not) of the variables used to reset a contact output.
Resets To configure these signals go to "Setpoint>Relay Configuration>Outputs"
menu. This output reset Command will only be effective if the "latch"
option has been Selected for the "Output Type" setting on the I/O board,
thus when the contact output has been configured to emulate function 86
(latching relay).
IO Board Status Status of I/O boards. This status provides if the hardware it is OK (boards
matching relay model, correctly inserted in their tracks, in good state and
communicating through the internal CAN Bus).
Virtual Inputs Status of Virtual inputs latched (32) and self-reset (32).

Virtual Outputs Status of virtual outputs (configured in PLC Editor). Up to 512.


Remote Outputs States of remote outputs for IEC61850 models.
Remote Inputs Status of remote device and remote inputs for IEC61850 models.
Analog Inputs (*) Measurements coming from analog inputs (DCMA)

3-28 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

Virtual Output Latched Status of Virtual Output Latched (configured in PLC Editor). Up to 16.
Virtual output Status of Virtual OutputAnalogues configured in PLC Editor). Up to 49
Analogue float values and 49 integer values can be used.
Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*). Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**) records

The Records menu is only available in on line mode and includes the possibility to retrieve all the records available in the
device. By serial or Ethernet.

Table 3.22: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF RECORDS MENU:

RECORDS (*)
Event recorder (*) Retrieval and visualization of snapshot event (all and new), control
events and alarm panel. By serial or Ethernet (ModBus RTU or TCP/IP)
Waveform capture (*) Retrieval of oscillography files, by Ethernet.
Fault Report (*) Retrieval and visualization of fault report files, by Ethernet.
Data logger (*) Retrieval and visualization of data logger files. Only by Ethernet.

Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*). Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**)

3.1.10 OPERATIONS MENU OVERVIEW


3
Option only available in on line mode, showing all the operations previously configured in the relay with their corresponding
texts, which must be different from the default text (Op_X not configured).
Table 3.23: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF OPERATIONS MENU:

OPERATIONS
Operation 1 (*) Entry to first operation (with its corresponding text)
... ...
Operation 24 (*) Entry to 24th operation (with its corresponding text)

Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*). Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**)

3.1.11 COMMUNICATION MENU OVERVIEW

The communication menu includes the computer screen to start communicating with the relay, the different update
procedures available in device: firmware, operative system, web server and other file storing capabilities (upload and
download info files to/from relay).
For more detail information go to section 3.1.4 for communication menus description and to section 5 for flash memory
update procedures.

Table 3.24: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF COMMUNICATION MENU:

COMMUNICATION

Computer Menu to start communication with the relay.


Modem (**) Menu to set modem communication parameters (only available if control
type is set to modem in computer menu).
Troubleshooting (*) Menu that Lets the user to perform reading or writing in ModBus
addresses, for verifying communications and access to different
positions in the ModBus memory map.
Calibration (*) Retrieval and store calibration settings from/to relay.
Upgrade relay (**) Menu to update the relay firmware version through Ethernet
Upgrade 650 web Menu to update the web server application (if available)
server
Upload info files to Hard disk storage of settings and configuration files on the relay.Option
relay only performed through Ethernet, not available in C650 models.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-29


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

Download info files Retrieval of settings and configuration files that had been previously
from relay stored in the relay hard disk.Option only performed through Ethernet, not
available in C650 models.
Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*). Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**)

The rest of options available in the Communication menu in EnerVista 650 Setup are:
- Modem: Allows configuring the unit for remote communications via modem, using telephonic line. It is only available if
the relay is not communicating and if modem has been select on Communication>computer control type selection. Go
to "Communication>Modem"
- Troubleshooting (Serial or Ethernet connection): Lets the user to perform reading or writing in ModBus addresses, for
verifying communications and access to different positions in the ModBus memory map. Only available if the
communication has already been established. Go to "Communication>Troubleshooting". An example is provided in
Figure 3–15:

Figure 3–15: COMMUNICATION TROUBLESHOOTING SCREEN


• Calibration (Serial or Ethernet connection): Allows retrieving the unit calibration settings and storing them in a file (with
extension *.cal). For reading or storing the calibration settings in the relay go to "Communications>Calibration>Get
or Set calibration settings" and select the intended calibration file. The calibration retrieval process is necessary to
be performed before updating the unit operative system, when the operating system is updated all the data in the relay
is deleted, including the factory calibration settings. When only the firmware is updated (for versions higher than 1.50),
the calibration settings are automatically saved in the relay.
• Upgrade firmware version (Ethernet connection): Go to "Communications>Upgrade relay", this menu allows the
user to update the firmware version of the relay through Ethernet communication. Firmware is related to the relay
internal program, designed by GE Multilin, which performs the protection and control functions, and which is run by the
relay main microprocessor.

3-30 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE

IMPORTANT NOTE:

READ CAREFULLY THE FLASH MEMORY UPDATE PROCEDURE DESCRIBED IN


SECTION “BOOT CODE AND FIRMWARE" AND CLOSE ALL THE RUNNING
APPLICATIONS BEFORE PERFORMING FIRMWARE AND OPERATIVE SYSTEM
UPDATING PROCESS

For firmware versions lower than 7.00, before updating firmware check that the firmware
version that is going to be updated match the operative system version of the relay.
Otherwise it is necessary to update the operative system before proceeding to update
the firmware. Other combinations of firmware and operative system different from the
listed in section 5 will not be operative

For previous version than 7.00 the operative system version is available in the logotype
main screen in HMI; it is the number between brackets in the first line, e.g. F650 1.70
(2.35). The operative system version is 2.35

• Upgrade 650 web server (Ethernet connection):Go to "Communications> Upgrade 650 web server". The relay web
server application can be updated to further versions (if available) using this menu without modifying the relay
operative system.
• Upload info files to relay (Ethernet connection): Go to "Communications>Upload info files to relay". This functionality is
3
used to store setting files (*.650) inside the relay, as well as auxiliary files used by the programmable logic graphical
editor (*.pep, *.aut, *.lib).
• Download info files from relay (Ethernet connection): Go to "Communications>Download info files from relay". This
functionality is used for retrieving the files (*.650 and *.pep, *.aut, *.lib) that have been previously stored in the relay
flash memory.
Important Note:

*.650 files contain protection, control settings, relay configuration and compiled logic
equations. This file can be retrieved from the relay, using the "File>Get info from
relay" option in EnerVista 650 Setup (through serial or Ethernet communication).
"File>Send info to relay" option stores this *.650 file in the relay.

*.pep, *.aut and *.lib files contain the logic configuration projects necessary to modify the
logic (virtual outputs) in the relay. These files can be stored in the relay, using the
"Communication>Upload info files to relay" option in EnerVista 650 Setup (through
Ethernet communication). They can be retrieved using "Communication>Download
info files to relay" option in EnerVista 650 Setup program (Ethernet communication).
Take into account that the *.pep, *.aut and library files are necessary to modify the PLC
logic (virtual outputs). Without these files setting and configuration can be modified but
not logic equations (virtual outputs). It is advisable to use the
"Communication>Upload info files to relay" option to store these logic configuration
files into the relay.

It is important to distinguish between "Send / Get info to relay" and "Upload /


Download info files to/from relay". "File>Send/Get info to relay" sends/gets
settings and configuration and compiled logic equation to/from the relay (*.650 format),
and the relay automatically starts working with the new settings once they are stored.
"Communications>Upload/Download info files to relay", stores/retrieves in the
relay hard disk: settings, configuration and compiled logic equations (*.650) besides the
PLC files (*.pep, *.aut, *.lib). This is only a physical storage (file backup).

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-31


3.1 ENERVISTA 650 SETUP SOFTWARE INTERFACE 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.1.12 SECURITY MENU OVERVIEW

The security menu includes all the menus related to security control in EnerVista 650 Setup. EnerVista 650 Setup security
users and passwords are not related to passwords in HMI. Each security level has its own access for HMI management
and EnerVista 650 Setup management.

Table 3.25: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF SECURITY MENU:

SECURITY
Login User (*) Log on menu for EnerVista 650 Setup. Enabled after security control has
been enabled in user management menu.
Change Password (*) Menu to change passwords and establish password recovering
questions.
User Management (*) User management dialog box.

Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*). Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**)

3.1.13 VIEW MENU OVERVIEW

3 The view menu includes the computer screen to start communicating with the relay, the different update procedures
available in device: firmware, operative system, web server and other file storing capabilities (upload and download info
files to/from relay).
The ModBus memory map is detailed in the complete instruction manual (English only) and can be obtained from EnerVista
650 Setup program.

Table 3.26: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF VIEW MENU:

VIEW
Traces (*) To inspect ModBus communication traces between the EnerVista 650
Setup and the relay.
ModBus Memory map Complete ModBus memory map description.
Languages (**) Option to change the EnerVista 650 Setup default language. Only
available if the relay is not communicating and no file (*650) is open.

Options enabled only in On-line mode are marked as (*). Options enabled only in Off-line mode are marked as (**)

3.1.14 HELP MENU OVERVIEW

Complete instructions manual and data about EnerVista 650 Setup release.

Table 3.27: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF HELP MENU:

HELP
Instructions Manual Instructions manual in the language selected in "View>Languages"
menu.
GE Mulitlin on the Web GE Multilin web page link.
About EnerVista 650 Release version and date of EnerVista 650 Setup program.
Setup

3-32 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)T


The HMI interface consists of several functional panels. The faceplate can be unscrewed to allow easy access to the
removable modules. There is also a removable dust cover that fits over the display and other cover that protects the front
RS232 Communications port and the commands buttons that can be sealed. The following figure shows the HMI in F650

HMI Interface

DISPLAY & LEDS

Graphic 16x40 or text 4x20 LCD display


Fluorescent backlight to improve visibility
Multicolor programmable LEDs with label panel

KEYPAD & SHUTTLE

Ergonomic programmable keys


Shuttle control for easy navigation
ESC key, built-in ENTER function and audio feedback
Local / Remote / Off pushbutton with LEDs 3
FRONT PORT

Electrically isolated front RS232 communication port


Transparent cover can be sealed for security

Figure 3–16: HMI INTERFACE

Not available for firmware version higher than 7.00

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-33


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

Figure 3–17: ENHANCED HMI INTERFACE

3.2.1 DISPLAY

F650 units are available with two different options for the front display. The first option is an alphanumerical display of 4
lines with 20 characters each, and the second option is a graphical display of 16 lines with 40 characters each (128x240
pixels).
The boot code and firmware versions can be seen in the relay text main screen, this screen is the default screen in the text
menu for all models: After the text "F650", appears the relay firmware version (7.00 in the example), and between brackets
the boot program version (7.00 in the example), followed by "General Electric", the relay model and the default front port
(COM2) communication parameters.

Figure 3–18: TEXT MAIN SCREEN

3-34 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

3.2.2 FRONT LED INDICATORS

The relay provides 16 LED indicators, 15 user programmable plus one non-configurable LED (READY) that shows if the
relay is in service.
Programmable LEDs are divided into groups of 5 LEDs, each of the groups having a different color. The first group of LED
indicators is latched by hardware (red color ones), usually configured for trip signals. The second group (yellow color) and
third group (green color) of LED indicators are self-reset type and will be reset once the condition has been cleared, but can
be latched using logic through PLC configuration. For firmware version from 7.20 and higher, all 15 LEDs are latched
through relay setting.
The ESC key is used to reset any latched led indicator, once the condition has been cleared. Keep the ESC button pressed
for more than 3 seconds; all LEDs will light up, verifying their correct operation. When releasing the ESC key, all indicators
programmed with memory, such as tripping LEDs, will be reset. For models with enhanced display, there is a reset LEDs
button dedicated for this purpose.
The latched conditions can also be reset via communications using the LED reset input (to configure this signal go to
“Setpoint>Relay Configuration>Control elements>LED RESET INPUT”). By default this LED reset input signal is set to
LEDS RESET operation.

3
3.2.3 PUSHBUTTONS

The front panel provides:


Push buttons: keypad (5 user programmable plus ESC/ESCAPE non configurable), shuttle key or shuttle key for easy
navigation, command pushbutton to select operations mode.
RS232/USB port: intended for connection to a portable PC.

3.2.3.1 KEYPAD AND SHUTTLE KEY

I
This button can be used for closing the user programmable switchgear. It is fully
programmable by the user.
O
This button can be used for closing the user programmable switchgear. It is fully
programmable by the user.
*
User programmable.
F1 User programmable.

User programmable.
F2
(ESC) Escape key. When pressed during more than 3 seconds, it will test all LEDs and
reset the trip LEDs.
ESC
Rotary knob or Shuttle Key (it can be both rotated and pressed): Used for selecting
menus, submenus, settings and for confirmation. Press or rotate the shuttle key to enter
the text main menu from the text standby screen.

Figure 3–19: KEYPAD AND SHUTTLE KEY DESCRIPTION FOR NON-ENHANCED DISPLAY MODELS

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-35


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

This button can be used for closing the


user programmable switchgear. It is fully
programmable by the user.

This button can be used for closing the


user programmable switchgear. It is fully
programmable by the user

F1. User programmable.

F2. User programmable.

3
F3 / *. User programmable.

Up Key. Used for selecting menus,


submenus, settings
Down Key. Used for selecting menus,
submenus, and change values of settings

Enter Key. Press key to enter to submenus


or to change values.

Escape key. Press key to exit from menus

Reset key. When pressed it will test all


LEDs and reset the trip LEDs.

Figure 3–20: ENHANCED KEYPAD DESCRIPTION

3-36 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

3.2.3.2 COMMAND PUSH BUTTON


The unit incorporates a command pushbutton located at the bottom right side of the HMi interface and at the top left for
Enhanced interface, with three options: local, remote, and off. The first option (LOCAL) allows executing operations in local
mode (HMI, front port, and rear COM2 port). The second option (REMOTE) allows operation execution only through
remote communications (COM1 and ETH_1/ETH2 or ETH_E/ETH_A/ETH_B (Depending on model)). The third option
(OFF) blocks the execution of operations. Each position is identified with an LED indicator, as follows:

LOCAL operations (green)


REMOTE operations (green)
OFF (red)

Press the command button to switch from local to remote operations mode and vice versa. OFF status (operation inhibited
for maintenance and safety) can be reach pressing the commands pushbutton during several seconds (local-remote-off
sequence).
The local-remote-off sequence can be also available through communications (see chapter 5.8), with a configurable signal
that can be set in the "Setpoint>Relay Configuration>Control Elements” screen.

3.2.4 FRONT PORT AND COVER SEALING SYSTEM 3


Figure 3–21: shows the detail of the front RS232 communication port and local/remote button access cover sealing system.
The sealing system is similar to the one used in energy meters, using wire and plumb seal.
High quality plastic have been used in the design to withstand extreme environmental conditions, both mechanical and
electrical, sun radiation, humidity, etc. in order to guarantee a long life for the unit.

Cover sealing system

Screen contrast regulator

Electrically isolated RS232 port

Local/remote Operations access

Figure 3–21: DETAIL OF FRONT PORT AND COVER SEALING SYSTEM

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-37


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.2.5 TEXT MENUS

3.2.5.1 NAVIGATION IN TEXT MENU


Text menu is available for all models, this is the main menu for visualizing actual values, metering, changing settings, etc.
through the HMI. In models with graphical display besides this text main menu there are several screens providing more
performance for control purposes.
Press (or rotate left or right) the enter/shuttle key to enter the main menu, starting from the standby screen (default main
screen). The default main screen can be accessed pressing ESC key till it appears. In all the navigation press the enter/
shuttle key to select the desired header display (top-level menu). Each press of the enter/shuttle key advances through the
main heading pages as illustrated below. To return to previous menus press the ESC key. To move inside the top-level
menu without changing to other low levels, rotate the shuttle key left to move up and right to move down (or use up/down
keys).
When rotating the shuttle keys (or up/down keys) the selected menu is marked by a single scroll bar character. The mark
(>) in the right part of any menu means that contains more than one level.

Figure 3–22: Shows an example of main menu navigation:

Figure 3–22: NAVIGATION IN MAIN TEXT MENU

3-38 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

3.2.5.2 TEXT MENU HIERARCHY


The structure of HMI text menu is similar to the EnerVista 650 Setup in the actual values and settings (view and change)
menus.
The main menu shows the following options:
Table 3.28: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF MAIN TEXT MENU:
NAME DESCRIPTION NAVIGATION IN MENU
Actual Values Actual values of all the signals available in device. Press shuttle key or enter key to enter next level.
Status of protection and control elements, Press ESC to return to default main screen.
measurements, inputs and outputs, etc.
Snapshot events Visualization of all snapshot events in text mode (two Press shuttle key or enter key to visualize snapshot
screens for each snapshot event). In graphical displays events in text menu. Press ESC to return to default
there can be seen in a dedicated screen. main screen.
Fault Report Fault reports information available in HMI (two screens Press shuttle key or enter key to enter next level.
for each fault report) Move Up/Downto see all the available fault reports
in device. Press shuttle key or enter key to enter
particular information for fault report selected.
View Settings Visualization of all protection and control settings Press shuttle key or enter keyto enter next level.
available in device. Move Up/Down to select submenu. Press ESC to
return to previous level.
Change Settings Menu that allows changing all protection and control Press shuttle key or enter key to enter next level.
settings available in device. Inputs and outputs settings, Move Up/Down to select submenu. Press esc to
relay configuration and logic configuration are not return to previous level. 3
available in HMI, only via EnerVista 650 Setup
software.
Date & Time Date and time visualization and modification by user. First mode is visualization. Press again shuttle key
or enter key to start modification in date and time.
Press ESC to return to previous level.
Commands Operations execution in local mode. Move Up/Down to pre select operation. Press
shuttle key or enter key to select and confirm. Press
ESC to return to previous level.
Password Password menu for settings and commands Move Up/Down to select submenu. Press shuttle
key or enter key to enter next level. Press ESC to
return to previous level.
Select Main Screen Selection of default main screen in text menu. Move Up/Down to select the default main screen
type. Pressshuttle key or enter key to confirm.
Select Language Language selection. Between default language (see Move Up/Down to select the default language.
ordering code) and English. Press shuttle key or enter key to confirm selection.
Switch the relay off and on.
< - return Return to previous level Press shuttle key or enter key to return to previous
level.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-39


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.2.5.3 ACTUAL VALUES


The Actual Values menu option in HMI concentrates and displays all the status of protection, control elements, metering,
counters information, oscillography, events, fault locator, etc.
Table 3.29: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF ACTUAL VALUES MAIN MENU:
Front Panel >
LEDs
Status >
Operation Bits
Breaker
Protection >
Protection Blocks
Phase Current
Neutral Current
Ground Current
Sens. Ground Current
Neg. Seq. Current
Thermal Model

3 Voltage
Power
Control Elements >
Frequency
Synchrocheck
Autoreclose
Breaker Failure
VT Fuse Failure
Broken Conductor
Setting Groups
Locked Rotor
Pulse Counters
Analog Comparators
Load Encroachment
Max. Number of starts
Digital Counters
Cold Load Pickup
Switchgear Status >
Switchgear 1
Switchgear...
Switchgear 16
Calibration
Flex Curves
System Info
Records Status >
Fault Reports
Control Events
Oscillography
Data logger
Demand
Energy
Breaker Maintenan.
SNTP-IRIG_B-PTP
Versions
Redundancy

3-40 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

Metering >
Primary Values >
Current
Voltage
Power
Energy
Demand
Secondary Values >
Current
Voltage
Power
Frequency
Inputs/Outputs >
Contact Inputs >
Board F/ Board G/ Board H/ Board J
Cont. Output St. >
Board F/ Board G/ Board H/ Board J
Cont. Output Op. >

Cont. Output Rs. >


Board F/ Board G/ Board H/ Board J
3
Board F/ Board G/ Board H/ Board J
IO Board Status
Virtual Inputs >
Virtual Inp.Latched
Virtual Inp.SR
Virtual Outputs
Remote Outputs (for IEC61850 models
only) >
DNA
User St
GOOSE Dig Outputs
Remote Inputs for IEC61850 models
only)>
Remote Input
Remote Devices
GOOSE Dig Inputs
GOOSE Analog Inputs
Analog Inputs >
Board F/ Board G/ Board H/ Board J
Virtual out. Latched
Virtual out. Analogue

To enter this menu press the shuttle key or enter key when the option Actual Values is selected in main menu. A secondary
level will be displayed with different sublevels as shown on Table 3.29:. Pressing Up/down keys or rotating the shuttle key,
(left for moving up and right for moving down) select the next level to be displayed, press the enter/shuttle key again to
enter in next level and press ESC key to return to previous level if desired. This navigation will be performed the same for
all the menus in Actual Values. Once the last sublevel is reached, move up and down to visualize the actual values
selected.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-41


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

One example of data screen for actual values is shown in Figure 3–23:.
First Line: Header of last level in actual values (Phase Current in the example)
Second Line: Data identifier (in the example PH IOC1 HIGH A, is the pickup signal for the first instantaneous
overcurrent function level high for phase A).
Third line: Status of the displayed actual value.
Fourth Line: Relative position in the menu (it is the first value of 114)

Phase Current
PH IOC1 HIGH A PKP
OFF
(1/114)

Figure 3–23: ACTUAL VALUES SCREEN DATA


In the Actual Values menus are different types of data, each type of data will display its particular status type (on and off, 0
or 1, ok or fail, analog values, etc.)
3

3-42 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

3.2.5.4 SNAPSHOT EVENTS


To enter this menu press the enter/shuttle key when the option Snapshot events is selected in main menu (). In this menu
all the snapshot events stored can be displayed.
Snapshot events are changes in the relay internal status.
One snapshot event is displayed in two text screens:
The first screen display the status, date and time of the snapshot event: the snapshot event identifier, its status,
event number and the date and time of the occurrence. If the snapshot event identifier does not fit the first line, the
whole text will be shown using as well the second line alternating with the status and event number.
The second screen displays currents and voltages in primary values for that particular snapshot event. Ia, Ib, Ic
and Ig for currents and Vab, Vbc, Vca and V0 for voltages. To access the metering screen in snapshot events
menu, press shuttle key from the snapshot event first screen. To exit from the metering screen press ESC.
To select different snapshot events to be displayed, press the up-down keys or rotate the shuttle key to select the snapshot
event and then press the enter/shuttle key to enter the metering screen. Press esc to exit the metering screen and return to
snapshot events menu.
Figure 3–24: shows an example of snapshot events navigation:

Press enter/shuttle key from the default main screen and enter in the main text 3
menu.

Move the shuttle key or press up-down keys until a single scroll bar character
(o) appears in the left part of Snapshot event header.

Press enter/shuttle key to enter in the snapshot events menu)

Select the snapshot event to display using the up/down keys or shuttle key (left
and right to move up and down inside the recorded snapshot events).

Once selected the snapshot event, identifier, status, date and time will be
displayed.
In the second line St: is showing the status and the relative snapshot index from
the whole recorded number. Third and fourth lines are used to display the time
and date of the snapshot event.

Pressing the enter/shuttle key the metering screen for the snapshot event will
be displayed.
To exit from this screen press the ESC key and return to the snapshot events
menu.

Figure 3–24: SNAPSHOT EVENTS NAVIGATION IN HMI

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-43


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.2.5.5 FAULT REPORT


To enter this menu press the enter/shuttle key when the option Fault report is selected in main menu (). This menu displays
information about the last ten faults recorded in the relay.
The Relay HMI allows two types of visualization for the fault reports stored in the Relay:
1. Showing the fault warning messages in the text display when the fault is produced. This option has to be enabled
by setting. To change from the HMI go to the menu "Change Settings >Product Setup > Fault Report > Show
Fault On HMI" and enable it.
2.Only saving and allowing viewing the information from the last ten faults recorded in the relay.
In the first option, when a fault occurs a warning message is displayed, including information about the fault in two screens,
one with general fault information, and a second one with the measured values in the moment of the fault.
The fault-warning message must be acknowledged by the user; this means that the user must press the enter/shuttle key
for this screen to disappear, The HMI will not allow to perform any other operation until the screen is acknowledged. In the
event of several consecutive faults, the HMI will always show the most recent fault, and the user will need to acknowledge
all of them, up to a maximum of ten faults.
In the second option, viewing the fault reports in the menu available in the HMI, the Fault Report menu in the main text
screen must be accessed by pressing the enter/shuttle key. The display will show the information about the last ten faults
produced, and both the general information and the metering screens can be viewed for each fault. Displayed information
3 starts in the most recent fault, and the user can switch to another fault by rotating the shuttle key.
Displayed information is stored in the relay volatile memory, so if the relay is turned off this information will be lost, as well
as if a "Clear Fault Report" command is executed. However, fault reports stored in the relay non-volatile memory will remain
after the Fault reset, and they can be obtained from the relay using EnerVista 650 Setup software, at the
"Actual>Records>Fault report" menu.
If there is no fault report available through the display, the relay will show a "Fault report not available" message.

3-44 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

The format of the displayed screens is as follows:

Select the Fault report menu in text menu

If there is more than one fault record press the up-down keys or rotate the shuttle
key and select the desired record to be displayed.

First screen with general fault information: Fault report #number, fault type, distance
and date and time.

Second screen with metering data for that fault record. All this data is a summary
from the fault report file that can be retrieved via EnerVista 650 Setup software.

Figure 3–25: FAULT REPORT NAVIGATION IN HMI

Possible fault types are as follows:

GROUND Ground faults


AG phase A to ground
ABG phase AB to ground
BG phase BG to ground
BCG phase BCG to ground
CG phase CG to ground
CAG phase CAG to ground
PHASE Phase to phase faults
AB phase A to phase B
BC phase B to phase C
CA phase C to phase A
3PHASE Three-phase faults (shown on the display as 3PH)
NAF Fault type not calculated

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-45


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.2.5.6 VIEW SETTINGS


To enter this menu press the enter/shuttle key when the option "View Settings" is selected in main menu (o). A secondary
level will be displayed with different sublevels as shown on Table 3.30:. Pressing up-down keys or rotating the shuttle key,
(left for moving up and right for moving down) select the next level to be displayed (o), press the enter/shuttle key again to
enter in next level and press esc key to return to previous level if desired. This navigation will be performed the same for all
the menus in "View Settings". Once the last sublevel is reached, move up and down to visualize the settings selected.
Table 3.30: GENERAL OVERVIEW OF "VIEW/CHANGE SETTINGS" MAIN MENU
MAIN SETTINGS MENU FIRST LEVEL SECOND LEVEL THIRD LEVEL
Product Setup >
Communication >
Serial Ports
Ethernet >
Ethernet A
Ethernet B
Ethernet E
Redundancy
ModBus Protocol
DNP3 Slave (Available for
3 standard and IEC61850
models)>
DNP3 Slave 1
DNP3 Slave 2
DNP3 Slave 3
IEC 870-5-104(Available for
standard and IEC61850
models)>
SNTP
PROCOME (Available for
procome models only).
PTP 1588
Routing
Fault Report
Oscillography
Demand
Time Settings
System Setup >
General Settings
Breaker >
Breaker Settings
Breaker Maintenance
Misc. settings
Protection Element >
Phase Current >
Phase TOC High >
Phase TOC High 1
Phase TOC High 2
Phase TOC High 3
Phase TOC Low >
Phase TOC Low 1
Phase TOC Low 2
Phase TOC Low 3
Phase IOC High >
Phase IOC High 1
Phase IOC High 2

3-46 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

MAIN SETTINGS MENU FIRST LEVEL SECOND LEVEL THIRD LEVEL


Phase IOC High 3
Phase IOC Low >
Phase IOC Low 1
Phase IOC Low 2
Phase IOC Low 3
Phase Directional >
Phase Directional 1
Phase Directional 2
Phase Directional 3
Thermal Model >
Thermal Model 1
Thermal Model 2
Thermal Model 3
Neutral Current >
Neutral TOC >
Neutral TOC 1
Neutral TOC 2

Neutral IOC >


Neutral TOC 3 3
Neutral IOC 1
Neutral IOC 2
Neutral IOC 3
Neutral Dir >
Neutral Dir 1
Neutral Dir 2
Neutral Dir 3
Ground Current >
Ground TOC >
Ground TOC 1
Ground TOC 2
Ground TOC 3
Ground IOC >
Ground IOC 1
Ground IOC 2
Ground IOC 3
Ground Dir >
Ground Dir 1
Ground Dir 2
Ground Dir 3
Sens. Ground Curr >
Sens. Ground TOC. >
Sens. Ground TOC 1
Sens. Ground TOC 2
Sens. Ground TOC 3
Sens. Ground IOC >
Sens. Ground IOC 1
Sens. Ground IOC 2
Sens. Ground IOC 3
Isolated Gnd IOC >
Isolated Gnd IOC 1
Isolated Gnd IOC 2
Isolated Gnd IOC 3

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-47


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

MAIN SETTINGS MENU FIRST LEVEL SECOND LEVEL THIRD LEVEL


Sens. Ground Dir. >
Sens. Ground Dir. 1
Sens. Ground Dir. 2
Sens. Ground Dir. 3
Neg. Seq. Current >
Neg. Seq. TOC >
Neg. Seq. TOC 1
Neg. Seq. TOC 2
Neg. Seq. TOC 3
Voltage Elements >
Phase UV >
Phase UV 1
Phase UV 2
Phase UV 3
Phase OV >
Phase OV 1
Phase OV 2

3 Neutral OV High >


Phase OV 3

Neutral OV High 1
Neutral OV High 2
Neutral OV High 3
Neutral OV Low >
Neutral OV Low 1
Neutral OV Low 2
Neutral OV Low 3
Neg. Seq. OV >
Neg. Seq. OV 1
Neg. Seq. OV 2
Neg. Seq. OV 3
Auxiliary OV >
Auxiliary OV 1
Auxiliary OV 2
Auxiliary OV 3
Auxiliary UV >
Auxiliary UV 1
Auxiliary UV 2
Auxiliary UV 3
Power>
Forward Power >
Forward Power 1
Forward Power 2
Forward Power 3
Directional Power >
Directional Power 1
Directional Power 2
Directional Power 3
Watt Gnd Flt High >
Watt Gnd Flt High 1
Watt Gnd Flt High 2
Watt Gnd Flt High 3
Watt Gnd Flt Low >

3-48 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

MAIN SETTINGS MENU FIRST LEVEL SECOND LEVEL THIRD LEVEL


Watt Gnd Flt Low 1
Watt Gnd Flt Low 2
Watt Gnd Flt Low 3
Control Elements >

Setting Group
Underfrequency >
Underfrequency 1
Underfrequency 2
Underfrequency 3
Underfrequency 4
Underfrequency 5
Underfrequency 6
Overfrequency >
Overfrequency 1
Overfrequency 2
Overfrequency 3
3
Overfrequency 4
Overfrequency 5
Overfrequency 6
Synchrocheck
Autoreclose
Breaker Failure
VT Fuse Failure.
Broken Conductor >
Broken Conductor 1
Broken Conductor 2
Broken Conductor 3
Locked Rotor >
Locked Rotor 1
Locked Rotor 2
Locked Rotor 3
Fq Rate of Change
Fq Rate of Change 1
Fq Rate of Change 2
Fq Rate of Change 3
Load Encroachment
Load Encroachment 1
Load Encroachment 2
Load Encroachment 3
Max. Num of starts
Cold Load Pickup
PLC Timer Masks

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-49


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.2.5.7 CHANGE SETTINGS


To enter this menu press the enter/shuttle key when the option “Change Settings” is selected in main menu. A secondary
level will be displayed with different sublevels as shown on Table 3.30:. Press up-down key or rotating the shuttle key, (left
for moving up and right for moving down) select the next level to be displayed, press the enter/shuttle key again to enter in
next level and press ESC key to return to previous level if desired. This navigation will be performed the same for all the
menus in "Change Settings". Once the last sublevel is reached, move up and down to visualize the settings selected.
To change a particular setting, press the enter/shuttle key on the setting to be modified. After selecting the setting, the value
for that setting will appear between brackets. Choose the new value moving up and down . After selecting the appropriate
value press again the enter/shuttle key to fix that value. To save the new settings, go to the end of the menu pressing down
key or rotating the shuttle key right, and select the menu “Press Enter to save settings”. When pressing the shuttle key
inside this menu the new settings will be saved.

Select the menu Change settings and press the enter/shuttle key to enter in the next
sublevel.

3 If there is more than one sublevel, select the next sublevel by pressing the up-down
keys or rotating and pressing the enter/shuttle key till the last level is reached.

Press the enter/shuttle key in the function to be modified

-> Group of settings


-> Setting to be modified
-> Value
-> Range and step

Pressing the enter/shuttle key, value appears between brackets and can be modified
pressing the up-down keys or rotating the shuttle key. Pressing again the enter/
shuttle key, the new value will be accepted.

Once all settings inside the group have been modified, go to the last screen pressing
the down key or rotating the shuttle key and press Enter. At this moment of time, the
new settings will be active in the relay.

Figure 3–26: CHANGE SETTINGS PROCEDURE IN HMI

3-50 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

3.2.5.8 DATE & TIME


The "Date & Time" menu will show the relay date and time information in the following format:
DST: Daylight Saving Time information
Date:Day/Month/Year
Time:Hour:Minutes:Seconds
To modify date and time, press the enter/shuttle key. The relay will show the year between brackets at the top of the screen.
By pressing the up-down keys or rotating the shuttle key, reach the desired value for the year, and press the enter/shuttle
key to select and store that value. After the year, the relay will show the month. Proceed as in the case of the year. The date
& time modification sequence is as follows:
Press the up-down key or rotate the shuttle key to select the "Date and Time" menu
and press to enter in it
The date and time data will appear in the format related above.
Pressing the enter/shuttle key the year can be modified pressing up-down key or
rotating the shuttle key, after selecting the desired value, press again the enter/
shuttle key to store the value.
"Year"
Date: Day/Month/<Year> 3
Time: Hour:Minutes:Seconds
After storing the value for Year, Month will appear between brackets and can be
modified
"Month"
Date: Day/<Month>/Year
Time: Hour:Minutes:Seconds
After storing the value for Month, Day will appear between brackets and can be
modified
"Day"
Date: <Day>/Month/Year
Time: Hour:Minutes:Seconds
After storing the value for Day, Hour will appear between brackets and can be
modified
"Hour"
Date: Day/Month/Year
Time: <Hour>:Minutes:Seconds
After storing the value for Hour, Minutes will appear between brackets and can be
modified
"Minute"
Date: Day/Month/Year
Time: Hour:<Minute>:Seconds
After storing the value for Minutes, Seconds will appear between brackets and can
be modified
"Second"
Date: Day/Month/Year
Time: Hour: Minute:<Seconds>
Once this sequence is completed, these values will remain stored in the relay, and
the display will show again the date at the bottom of the text screen.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-51


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

Figure 3–27: CHANGE DATE AND TIME PROCEDURE IN HMI

3.2.5.9 COMMANDS
Commands are configured using EnerVista 650 Setup, and they can be executed using the pushbuttons on the relay front.
Using EnerVista 650 Setup software, the user can configure up to 24 commands with a descriptive text. When executing
the operation from the relay front, the operation description text will be displayed.
Example of commands (operations) executions via HMI

Press the enter/shuttle key in the menu commands when it is selected in the display
(o).

3
All the previously configured commands will be displayed. Press up-down keys or
rotate the shuttle key move through the available commands. Press ESC to return to
previous level.

Press enter/shuttle key to pre-select the operation to be executed

When the message "Push Enter for Confirmation" appears, press the enter/shuttle
key to confirm the commands that will be performed.

Once the commands has been performed or the time out has expired the
"Command completed" message will appear in the display.

Figure 3–28: COMMANDS IN HMI

3-52 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

3.2.5.10 PASSWORDS
F650 units incorporate independent passwords for protection and control, in order to prevent unauthorized keypad and
display access to the relay.
Settings Password:
This password allows restricting access to settings changes in the relay protection elements.
Commands Password:
This password is required for executing operation commands through the keypad and display.
If the Commands Password is activated, when the user tries to execute an operation, the relay will request this password,
and in case of using the single-line diagram for graphical display models, all objects will not be operational until this
password is entered, either logging in Login Pwd Commands, or entering the password in the Commands menu.
Relay settings view, measures, and other monitored information are not password-protected, and they can be accessed by
all users.
Access to the password menu is located at the Password option in the relay text menu. This menu includes the following
options:
"Login Pwd Settings"
"Logout Pwd Settings"
"Change Pwd Settings"
3
"Login Pwd Commands"
"Logout Pwd Commands"
"Change Pwd Commands"
"Forgot Password?"
Among the available options in this menu, there are three types of functionality:
Login: For entering the password, either for settings or commands, and enable access to settings
or commands. Once entering the password the relay is no longer password protected, and
access is enabled to settings modification or commands execution.
Logout: Once the necessary setting changes or operation commands have been executed, the
user can log out, so that the relay is password protected again.
Change: This menu allows setting or modifying the desired password.
Forgot Password: This menu provides the encrypted password, so that it can be recovered if the user loses or
forgets it.
Passwords are restricted for Settings change and Commands execution. To password-protect the relay, it is first necessary
to set the desired password, using the corresponding "Change Pwd..." menu. The default password is 0000. This password
provides access to the whole relay functionality.
Once a new password has been set, the user must log in to access the protected functionality; otherwise, the relay will
request the password when trying to change settings or execute commands. Once the password is entered the relay is
unprotected (as if the user had logged in), and the user must log out to protect again the relay.

a) PASSWORD RANGE
The valid range for F650 passwords is a number from 0000 to 9999.
The default password is 0000, which provides access to the whole relay functionality. This is the default option for enabling
relay use without using passwords.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-53


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

b) ENTERING THE PASSWORD (LOGIN PWD)


This operation is the same for both the settings and commands passwords. The only difference will be the access menu.
For entering the password, the user must access the Login menus inside the Password menu.
Login Pwd Settings or Login Pwd Commands:
The relay requests the password with the following message on the screen:
Setting passwd.
Login: < 1000 >
For entering the desired password, the user must press up-down key or rotate the shuttle key to the left (decrease) or to the
right (increase), and establish the desired number. Once entered, the selected password between brackets has been
entered, the relay will show the message "Processing passwd. Wait...". If the password is correct, the relay will allow
access to the settings change or command execution. It is not necessary to enter the password every time a change is to
be performed. The relay will request the password 15 minutes after the last keypad action has taken place. This period of
time is the same that takes the relay to turn off the display backlighting.

c) LOGGING OUT (LOGOUT PWD)


To disable access to settings and commands, the user must logout.

3 Logout Pwd Settings or Logout Pwd Commands:


For safety reasons, if the user does not log out, the relay will do it automatically 15 minutes after the last keypad
action.

d) CHANGING THE PASSWORD (CHANGE PWD COMMANDS)


To set a password in the relay, both for settings and commands, the corresponding menu must be accessed inside the
Password menu:
Change Pwd Settings or Change Pwd Commands:
To modify the password, the user must first introduce the existing password; if the relay has the default factory password,
this would be 0000.
For modifying the password, the relay requests the existing password with the following message:
(Setting or Command) passwd.
Login: < 0000 >
Once the entered password has been acknowledged, the new password must be entered:
(Setting o Command) passwd.
New passwd: < 1000 >
Once the new password has been entered, the relay returns to the general Passwords menu.

e) PASSWORD RECOVERY (FORGOT PASSWORD?)


If the relay passwords need to be recovered, the "Forgot Password?" menu must be accessed. This menu is the last
option inside the text Passwords menu.
This menu will show two passwords, which correspond to the encrypted protection settings, and commands passwords, as
shown in the following example:
Cod Settings: [35c0]
Cod Commands: [35c0]
<Push Enter>
In order to obtain the decoded password from the encrypted codes provided by the relay, it is necessary to contact GE
Multilin and provide these encrypted codes.

3-54 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

3.2.5.11 SELECT MAIN SCREEN


The relay display offers the possibility to select the default main screen. For this purpose, the user must access the "Select
Main Screen" menu through the HMI. This menu includes the following options:

Logotype

This option selects as main screen the relay logotype including the firmware and boot code versions, the relay model and
the communication parameters for local port COM2.

Figure 3–29: DEFAULT LOGOTYPE SCREEN


3
Metering
This option shows a Metering screen including the phase and ground currents as well as phase-to-phase voltage, and zero
sequence voltage values, all of them in primary values.

Ia 0.000 Vab 0.000


Ib 0.000 Vbc 0.000
Ic 0.000 Vca 0.000
Ig 0.000 V0 0.000

Figure 3–30: DEFAULT METERING SCREEN


All
This option alternates in time the two previous options.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-55


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.2.5.12 SELECT LANGUAGE


Option only available for versions 1.70 or higher than 5.20.

The relay display offers the possibility to select the default language for the relay. For this purpose, the user must access
the "Select language" menu located at the end of the main menu through the HMI. This menu allows the user to set the
default language of the relay between English (always available) and second language selected in the relay model.
For example one relay in French language (e.g. FC650MZDF2G1HIRF) can be displayed in French or in English only by
changing the language setting in HMI. It is necessary to switch off and on the relay to start working with the new language
configuration in the relay. In EnerVista 650 Setup it is possible to select the language for the software (View>Languages).
Example of language selection in HMI

Press the enter/shuttle key to enter the select language menu.


Depending on the relay model there will be available different kind of language
selections: English/French, English/ Russian, etc.

3
Press up-down keys or rotate the shuttle key to select the desired language and
press enter to store the selection in the relay

Once the new language has been selected it is necessary to reboot the relay in
order to start working with the new language in the device.

Figure 3–31: LANGUAGE SELECTION IN HMI

3-56 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

3.2.6 GRAPHIC DISPLAY

3.2.6.1 ONE-LINE DIAGRAM


In models with graphic display default main screen is the single-line diagram. This single-line diagram can be configured
using EnerVista 650 Setup software by choosing the HMI menu inside Relay Configuration (Setpoint>Relay
Configuration>HMI).

F650 DIGITAL BAY CONTROLLER

Ia = 0.000 kA Vab =0.000 kV

Ib = 0.000 kA Vbc =0.000 kV


3
Ic = 0.000 kA Vca =0.000 kV

Freq = 0.00 Hz

Esc: Menu. Enter:Next. :Select

Figure 3–32: ONE-LINE DIAGRAM

The bottom of the display shows a legend that indicates the possible selections that can be made from this screen.
Esc: Menu. Enter: Next. : Select.

The meaning of these options is as follows:


Esc: Menu.
Pressing the ESC key, the user will access the relay main menu, similar to the one displayed by the text-display model
(F650B).
Pressing again the ESC key; the menu selection screen (Actual Values, Snapshot events, etc.) will be displayed. This main
menu screen is identical to the one described for the text display. Its functionality is described in section 3.2.5 in this
manual.
Intro: Next.
Pressing the enter/shuttle key, the user access the next graphical screen, which in this case corresponds to the primary
metering values screen.
: Select
Once the different switchgear elements to be operated have been configured using EnerVista 650 Setup, the user will be
able to operate them from the graphic display.
If a single-line diagram has been previously configured in the EnerVista 650 Setup, in the HMI option inside the Relay
Configuration menu, the different switchgear elements configured for the display will be operative from the graphic
display. By pressing up-down key or rotating the shuttle key to the left and right, the cursor moves among the elements and
blinks on each of them. When an element is selected by pressing the enter/shuttle key, the relay will indicate the command
to be executed, and the user will need to confirm it by pressing again the enter/shuttle key.
The following sections describe only the operation of screens that are specific for the graphic display models.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-57


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.2.6.2 METERING SCREEN


The Metering screen displays relay analog measures in their primary values. Available metering values are as follows:

Metering Screen. Total metering 53


Phasor Ia Primary 0.000 KA
Phasor Ib Primary 0.000 KA
Phasor Ic Primary 0.000 KA
Phasor Ig Primary 0.000 KA
Phasor Isg Primary 0.000 KA
RMS Ia Primary 0.000 KA
RMS Ib Primary 0.000 KA
RMS Ic Primary 0.000 KA
RMS Ig Primary 0.000 KA
RMS Isg Primary 0.000 KA
I0 Primary 0.000 KA

Enter: Next. ESC: Prev :Scroll.

3 Figure 3–33: METERING SCREEN


As in the rest of graphical display screens, the bottom part shows a legend that indicates the possible options for the user.
In this case, the options are:
Enter: Next. Esc: Prev. : Scroll.
Intro: Next.
Pressing the enter shuttle key the user accesses the next screen, in this case the ALL EVENTS screen.
Esc: Prev.
Pressing the ESC key the user returns to the previous screen (One-line diagram)
: Scroll.
Pressing the up-down key or rotating the shuttle key to the left (L) or right (R) the user can access all the Metering values in
the screen.

METERING SCREEN ANALOG MEASURES IN PRIMARY VALUES


Phasor Ia Primary V0 Primary Phase A Real Pwr Line Frequency Primary
Phasor Ib Primary V1 Primary Phase B Reactive Pwr Bus Frequency Primary
Phasor Ic Primary V2 Primary Phase B Apparent Pwr Vx Primary
Phasor Ig Primary Vab Primary Phase B Real Pwr Pos MVarhour Freeze
Phasor Isg Primary Vbc Primary Phase C Reactive Pwr NegMVarhour Freeze
Phasor In Primary Vca Primary Phase C Apparent Pwr PosMWatthour Freeze
RMS Ia Primary Vn Primary Phase C Real Pwr Neg MWatthour Freeze
RMS Ib Primary Va Primary 3 Phase Reactive Pwr Positive MVarhour
RMS Ic Primary Vb Primary 3 Phase Apparent Pwr Negative MVarhour
RMS Ig Primary Vc Primary 3 Phase Real Pwr Positive MWatthour
RMS Isg Primary VL Primary Phase A Power Factor Negative MWatthour
I0 Primary VBB Primary Phase B Power Factor % of Load-to-trip
I1 Primary Phase A Reactive Pwr Phase C Power Factor
I2 Primary Phase A Apparent Pwr 3 Phase Power Factor

3-58 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

3.2.6.3 ALL EVENTS SCREEN


This screen shows all events that have been produced in the relay. The top of the screen shows its name (All Events), and
the relative and total number of events contained in the screen.

All Events (1/479) or (1/511 for Firmware version 7.20 or higher)

This legend means that there are a total of events stored in the relay, and that the cursor is located on event number 1. The
information shown on this screen for each event is as follows:
"Hour:Minute:Second:Millisecond" "Event text" "Event status (ON/OFF)"

All Events (1/479).


- [ Ready LED ON ] -
16:11:08.035 Ready LED ON ON
16:11:08.017 Breaker Closed ON ON
16:11:08.005 Isolated Gnd3 Block OFF OFF
16:11:08.005 Isolated Gnd2 Block OFF OFF
16:11:08.005 Isolated Gnd1 Block OFF OFF 3
16:11:08.005 Sens Gnd TOC3 Block OFF OFF
16:11:08.005 Sens Gnd TOC2 Block OFF OFF
16:11:08.005 Sens Gnd TOC1 Block OFF OFF
16:11:08.005 Ground TOC3 Block OFF OFF
16:11:08.005 Ground TOC2 Block OFF OFF
16:11:08.005 Ground TOC1 Block OFF OFF
Esc: Prev. Enter: Menu. : Scroll.

Figure 3–34: ALL EVENTS SCREEN


The screen legend options are:
Esc: Prev. Enter: Menu. : Scroll.

Esc: Prev.
Pressing the ESC key, the user returns to the previous screen (Metering screen)

Intro: Menu.
Pressing the enter/shuttle key, the user accesses the Events menu that offers the following options at the bottom of the
screen:
next prev reload details At

To access the different options in the snapshot events graphic menu the user must move the cursor from up to down or
from left to right. The selected option will be displayed in upper case and between brackets. To access the selected option,
the user must press again the enter/shuttle key.
<NEXT>
The user accesses the next available graphic screen (Events – New)
<PREV>
This option returns to the general events graphic menu (All Events)
<RELOAD>
This option updates all events stored in the relay and returns to the general events screen.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-59


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

<DETAILS>
The Details screen provides access to metering values, and date and time related with the event.
The top of the screen displays a legend with the event text, followed by the date and time, the event status (ON or
OFF), and the event index number related to the complete list of events in the relay, for example (1/479). The rest of
information provided by the Details screen corresponds to the relay measures in the moment of the event. Metering
values provided in the events are secondary, and voltage values correspond to phase-to-ground voltage.

Ready LED ON
Date: 07/Nov/2004 St:ON
Time: 16:11:08.035 (1/479)

Phasor Ia Primary 0.000


Phasor Ib Primary 0.000
Phasor Ic Primary 0.000
Line Frequency 0.000
Phasor Ig Primary 0.000
Phasor Isg Primary 0.000
I0 Primary 0.000
I1 Primary 0.000
3
Enter: Meters. ESC: Prev : Scroll.

Figure 3–35: SNAPSHOT EVENTS DETAIL SCREEN


To navigate this screen the user must follow the legend at the bottom of the screen:

Enter: Meters. ESC: Prev. : Scroll.

Intro: Meters.
To access the metering values in the moment of the event, the user must press the enter/shuttle key. A new metering
screen will be displayed, containing the primary metering values in the snapshot event, such as:

Phasor Ia Primary I2 Primary


Phasor Ib Primary Vab Primary
Phasor Ic Primary Vbc Primary
Line Frequency Primary Vca Primary
Phasor Ig Primary V1 Primary
Phasor Isg Primary V2 Primary
I0 Primary V0 Primary
I1 Primary 3 Phase Power Factor

Once inside the Metering screen, a new legend will be shown for each event (Intro or ESC: Prev. U-D (L-R: Scroll); this
legend indicates that by pressing ESC or the shuttle key, the system will return to the Event Detail screen, and
pressing the up-down key or rotating the shuttle key the user will access all the metering values contained in the
metering screen of the considered event.
ESC: Prev.
If the user presses the ESC key from the event detail screen, the system will return to the all events screen.

3-60 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

: Scroll.

Pressing the up-down key or rotating the shuttle key left (L) or right (R) moves among all the events contained in the all
events screen, allowing a preview of the details for each of them.
<AT>
When this option is selected, the system marks the event where the cursor is located. A relative time stamp is
performed, in such a way that the selected event, marked with an asterisk (*) between the time and the event name is
set with a relative time of 00:00:00:000 on the top line of the event screen, together with its relative index, and the rest
of events in the screen will show a date/time that relates to the marked event. This operation mode allows a quick
inspection of the relative time passed between several events, which is very useful for analyzing events in the field.
The corresponding legend to this relative event-marking screen is as follows:
Esc: Out At. Enter: Tag event.
Esc: Out At.
The relative event marking is eliminated and the system returns to the general events screen.
Enter: Tag event.
If the user places the cursor on a different event by pressing the up-down key or rotating the shuttle key left or 3
right, pressing the enter/shuttle key will change the relative mark to that new event.

3.2.6.4 NEW EVENTS SCREEN


This screen shows the new events that have been produced in the relay since the last time the New Events screen was
read. The top of the screen shows a "New Events" legend, and the relative and total number of events contained.
Navigation through the different menus in this New Events screen is similar to the one described in the previous section for
All Events. The main difference is that in the case of new events it is necessary to select the RELOAD submenu to update
the screen with new events that have been produced, while in the All Events screen, this refreshment is automatic.
After the new events have been read, if the user selects again the Reload menu, the system will show a <No new events
available.> message, indicating that there are no more new events available since the last reading.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-61


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.2.6.5 ALARMS PANEL


Alarms panel can be viewed in all F650 models using communication software EnerVista 650 Setup, however, only models
with graphic display allow access to the alarms panel from the HMI.

First line shows the relative and total number of alarms existing in that screen. The relative number refers to the alarm on
which the cursor is located, and the total number refers to the total amount of alarms available. The second line on this
screen shows an index that indicates the number of the configured control event that corresponds to the displayed alarm,
followed by the alarm text configured in the Control Events menu inside the Relay Configuration option
("Setpoint>Relay Configuration>Control Events").

Alarm Panel (1/3).


#1 OPERATIONS IN LOCAL MODE

7/11/04 16:54:16 OPERATIONS IN LO. ON


7/11/04 16:54:16 GENERAL PICKUP ON
7/11/04 16:54:16 GENERAL TRIP ON

Esc: Prev. Enter: Next

Figure 3–36: ALARMS PANEL IN HMI


The rest of the screen shows the different alarms produced in the relay with the date and time when the corresponding
event was produced, followed by the alarm identification text, and its status, active (ON) or inactive (OFF).
In the previous example, the produced alarm is the change to local of the execution of operations (OPERATIONS IN
LOCAL MODE), the date and time when this event has been produced, and its status (ON):
The bottom of the screen shows the legend that indicates how to navigate through the different options available in the
screen.
ESC: Prev. Enter: Next.
ESC: Prev.
Pressing the ESC key, the system returns to the previous New Events screen.
Enter: Next.
Pressing the enter/shuttle key, the user accessed the available alarms menu, which includes the following options.
next prev ack ack all
To access the different options provided by the alarms graphic menu, the user must press the up-down key or move the
shuttle key left to right. The selected option will be displayed in upper case and between brackets. To access the selected
option, the enter/shuttle key must be pressed.
<NEXT>
This option provides access to the next available graphic screen (I/O boards)
<PREV>
The system returns to the previous New Events screen.
<ACK>
This option acknowledges the alarm on which the cursor is located.

3-62 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

<ACK ALL>
This option acknowledges all alarms. Alarm acknowledgement through the graphic HMI is considered as through
communication port COM2, as it is considered to be Local in both cases.
When an alarm has been acknowledged, a selection mark will appear to the right of its status. Inactive alarms will
disappear from the screen once they are acknowledged.

3.2.6.6 INPUT/OUTPUT MONITORING SCREEN


This is the last screen available in the graphic display. This screen allows viewing the status of the relay inputs and outputs,
as well as emulate inputs (for verification of the logic, or related functions), and contact outputs (to verify wiring).
The format of this screen is shown on the figure below.
The first line shows the name of the screen "I/O Cards", followed by the type and description of the board where the cursor
is located, which will appear between selection marks > < and blinking.

IO Card.
Type: 2, Nº IN 8, Nº OUT 8
3
>F<
G
H
J

Esc: Prev. Enter: Menu. : Chg Card.

Figure 3–37: INPUTS/OUTPUTS GENERAL SCREEN


The navigation legend on this screen is as follows:

Esc: Prev. Enter: Menu. : Chg Card


Esc: Prev.
This option returns to the previous screen (Alarms Panel).
Enter: Menu.
This option provides access to the selected I/O board menu:
This menu includes the following options.
next view test input test output
As in previous screens, to access the different options provided by the inputs/outputs graphic menu, the user must press
the up-down key or move the shuttle key left to right. The selected option will be displayed in upper case and between
brackets. To access the selected option, the enter/shuttle key must be pressed.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-63


3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI) 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

IO Card F. Type: 2, # IN 8, # OUT 8

Input (ON OFF) Output

0 CC1 8 Va COIL1
1 CC2 9 Vb COIL1
2 CC3 10 Va COIL2
3 CC4 11 Vb COIL2
4 CC5 12 Isense1
5 CC6 13 Isense1
6 CC7 14 SUP21
7 CC8 15 SUP22

next >VIEW< test input test output

Figure 3–38: INPUT/OUTPUT VIEWING SCREEN

3 <NEXT>
This option brings the system back to the one-line diagram.
<VIEW>
This option shows the real status of all inputs and outputs in the selected board. Depending on the type of board, with
or without supervision, the screen will vary to get adapted to the characteristics of each board.
The first line of this screen shows the slot where the board is located, F, G, H or J, and the type of board. The view
menu differentiates inputs and outputs; the active status (ON) is represented by the lighting of the corresponding input
or output.
The legend at the bottom of the screen indicates how to navigate:
Esc: Prev. Enter: Menu. : Chg Card

Esc: Prev.
Returns to the general I/O screen
Enter: Menu.
Provides access to the I/O menu (next, view, test input, test output).
: Chg Card
Pressing the up-down key or Moving the shuttle key to the left or right provides access to the status of inputs/
outputs for the different boards available in the relay.

<TEST INPUT>
This option allows testing the input activation (in emulation mode). The displayed screen is similar to the viewing
screen, but in this case the user can operate the different relay inputs.
This screen shows the Input name lit up, showing that this is an Input emulation mode.
The first relay input will appear blinking and between brackets; the user can select a different input by pressing up-
down key or rotating the enter/shuttle key. When the shuttle key is pressed, the selected input will be activated.
Navigation through this screen is indicated by the following legend:
Esc: Exit Text. Enter: Chg Input.

3-64 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.2 HUMAN MACHINE INTERFACE (HMI)

Esc: Exit Text.


The ESC option returns to the general I/O board menu.
Enter: Chg Input.
Pressing the enter/shuttle key on the blinking input, this input will be activated in emulation mode.
Note: input emulation can only be executed through the TEST INPUT tool on the graphic display.

<TEST OUTPUT>
This option allows testing the output activation in emulation mode. The displayed screen is similar to the viewing
screen, but in this case the user can operate the different relay contact outputs to test the wiring.
This screen shows the Output name lit up, showing that this is an output emulation mode.
The first relay output will appear blinking and between brackets; the user can select a different output by pressing the
up-down key or rotating the shuttle key. When the enter/shuttle key is pressed, the selected output will be activated.
Navigation through this screen is indicated by the following legend:
Esc: Exit Text. Enter: Chg Output.
Esc: Exit Text.
The ESC option returns to the general I/O board menu. 3
Enter: Chg Output.
Pressing the enter/shuttle key on the blinking output, this output will be activated in emulation mode.
Note: Output emulation can be executed through the TEST OUTPUT tool on the graphic display, and also
through communications using EnerVista 650 Setup software for all F650 models.
: Chg Card
Pressing the up-down key or rotating the shuttle key allows to change the selected I/O board in the main I/O screen.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-65


3.3 WEB SERVER 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.3 WEB SERVER 3.3.1 HOME

The web server in the F650 can be accessed running the Windows explorer, and typing http://xxx.xxx.xx.xxx, being
xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx the relay IP address, which must be configured in Setpoint > Product Setup > Communication Settings
> Ethernet.
The main screen of the F650 web server shows the different monitoring possibilities for snapshot events, events, alarms,
oscillography, fault reports, data logger and metering values provided by the relay through the web.
In order to access the different functions provided by the web server, the user must simply click on the list name on the left
side of the screen.
The web server (for version 1.70 and higher ones) allows the user to visualize the different web server screen languages:
English, French, Spanish, Russian and Chinese by pressing the language button on the top right corner of the main
window. Take into account that this selection only changes the language in the web server screen, all the relay texts, such
as snapshot events, control events, etc. will be the in the language selected in the relay (see section 3.2.5.12 in this
manual).

Figure 3–39: WEB SERVER MAIN SCREEN

3-66 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.3 WEB SERVER

3.3.2 SNAPSHOT EVENTS

The Snapshot events screen shows all Snapshot events produced in the relay. This screen is refreshed automatically every
minute.
The information provided in this screen includes: first, the relative event index, the lowest index corresponding to the most
recent event; next, the event text that shows the reason for the event, its status, active (ON) or inactive (OFF), and finally
the date and time when the event was produced.
The bottom of the screen shows a Metering screen; clicking on one of the events, the associated metering values will be
shown on that screen.

Figure 3–40: SNAPSHOT EVENTS SCREEN

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-67


3.3 WEB SERVER 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.3.3 CONTROL EVENTS

The control events screen provides access to all events that have been configured in the Control Events screen inside the
Relay Configuration menu of EnerVista 650 Setup.

Figure 3–41: CONTROL EVENTS SCREEN

Unlike the case of Snapshot events, in this screen the highest index corresponds to the most recent event. The information
provided is the control event index, the text that has been associated to such event when configured, its status, active (ON)
or inactive (OFF), and its date and time.

3-68 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.3 WEB SERVER

3.3.4 ALARMS

The alarms screen provides access to alarms configured in the relay. As in the case of snapshot events and control events,
this screen allows only to view the alarms, but not to acknowledge them.

Figure 3–42: ALARMS SCREEN

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-69


3.3 WEB SERVER 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.3.5 OSCILLOGRAPHY

The oscillography screen allows obtaining from the relay available oscillography records in that moment.
This screen includes two windows. The first window shows oscillography records available in the relay, identified by an
index, being the highest index the most recent record (oscillography record No 6 in the example below).

Figure 3–43: OSCILLOGRAPHY SCREEN


If the user clicks on the oscillo record he wants to retrieve, the window on the right will show a description of the record
header, indicating its date, time, and the most relevant parameters of the record. Once a record is selected, it is required to
press the Download button. The system will then open a window to allow saving the files in Comtrade format in the PC
hard drive. Once the records have been saved, the system will ask if the user wants to open GE-OSC tool (Comtrade
record viewer) to view the downloaded files.

Figure 3–44: GE-OSC LAUNCH SCREEN

Clicking on the Home option, the system will return to the web server main screen.

3-70 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES 3.3 WEB SERVER

3.3.6 FAULT REPORT

The fault report screen provides access to the last 10 fault reports obtained by the relay. These records are stored
according to an index that marks their position among all records produced in the relay, with a range from 1 to 999,
returning to 1 in case of exceeding the limit of 999. As in the case of oscillography records, the highest index corresponds
to the most recent record.
In the fault report, oscillography and data logger screens, the system will request acceptance of a safety-warning message.

Figure 3–45: FAULT REPORT SCREEN


The information provided in this screen includes the date and time when the fault was registered, fault calculations such as
distance to the fault, type of fault, date and time, and the line parameters, as well as the recloser and breaker status during
the fault.
This screen shows also prefault and fault voltage and current primary values. At the top of the screen, associated to the
trigger event number there is a button labeled as INFO. This button displays at the bottom of the screen the events
produced before and after the fault report trigger, so that the user has very useful information about the moment when the
fault was produced.
To obtain a text file with all the fault report information, press the Download option and save the file in the computer.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 3-71


3.3 WEB SERVER 3 HUMAN INTERFACES. SETTINGS & ACTUAL VALUES

3.3.7 DATA LOGGER

The data logger screen allows viewing the data logger first and last value retrieval date and allows downloading the data
record files in Comtrade format, by pressing the Download option. Stored files can be viewed later using any Comtrade
format viewer.

Figure 3–46: DATA LOGGER SCREEN

3-72 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


4 SECURITY 4.1 ADDING USERS

4 SECURITY 4.1 ADDING USERS


New users can only be added by users that have Administrator Access (or Admin Rights). The Enable Security check
box located in the Security->User Management window must be enabled.
Remember: (In order to add new users and assign user rights )
• must be logged in with Administrator Permission
• and Enable Security checkbox must be enabled

4.1.1 USER RIGHTS

NOTE: Only Administrators have access to the User Management dialog box.
Following is a list of all of the User Rights Options available to be granted to users, and their functions.

Table 4–1: USER RIGHTS AND FUNCTIONS


RIGHT FUNCTION
If this box is checked when the Administrator exits the User Management dialog box, the program will ask you to
Delete Entry confirm the delete and if the Administrator chooses "yes", then the user whose "Delete Entry" box was checked
will be permanently deleted from the list.
WARNING: When this box is checked, the user will become an EnerVista 650 Setup Administrator, therefore
Admin.
receiving all of the Administrative rights.

Actual Values When this box is checked, the user will have the ability to view Actual Values and all records excluding event
recorder.

Settings When this box is checked, the user will have access to view and modify Settings (Protection, control, inputs/
outputs and calibration).
Commands When this box is checked, the user will be able to use Commands.
Event Recorder When this box is checked, the user will have access to use Event Recorder.
Force IO When this box is checked, the user will be able to use Force IO application.
When this box is checked, the user will have the ability to view and modify Relay Configuration and Logic
Logic Configuration Configuration.

Upgrade When this box is checked, the user will have the ability to upgrade firmware, bootware and to upload and
download info files to/from relay.

By default, Administrator and Service users are created with "password" as default password.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 4-1


4.2 CHANGING PASSWORDS 4 SECURITY

4.2CHANGING PASSWORDS
Users will be prompted to change their password after the first successful log in or through clicking Security from the
toolbar, and choose Change Password.

Figure 4–1: CHANGE SECURITY


When the operator enters a new password for the first time, he/she should also enter a personal question that only they
could answer. There is a limit of 50 characters available to enter the personal question. One example, as in the above
diagram, would be "What is my mother's maiden name?". This question will be posed to the user if the user forgets their
password and would like to know what their password was.

4-2 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


4 SECURITY 4.3 ENABLING SECURITY

4.3ENABLING SECURITY
EnerVista 650 Setup Security Control is disabled by default. Users don't have to log in through user name and password
after installation and are granted access as Administrator.
Security Control can be enabled through Security from the tool bar when logged on as an Administrator. Click on User
Management and a dialog box will show up.

Figure 4–2: SECURITY ENABLING


Security Control is enabled by checking the ENABLE SECURITY check box. The first time the enable security option is
selected is necessary to close and open EnerVista 650 Setup to start working under security management.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 4-3


4.4 LOGING INTO ENERVISTA 650 SETUP 4 SECURITY

4.4LOGING INTO ENERVISTA 650 SETUP


Users have to log on in order to use EnerVista 650 Setup program after Security Control has been enabled. After the start
up of EnerVista 650 Setup, a dialog will pop up asking for user name and password.

Figure 4–3: LOGIN USER


The user name field will display the last log in user name as default, in this example, TestUser. For the first log in session of
any user name, the default password will be "password". User will be prompt to change the password to something else
after the first successfully log in.
Log on can also be done by clicking Security from the toolbar and choose Login New User. User will be prompted with the
same log in dialog box for a different user name and password combination.
In case a user has forgotten about the log in password, the Forgot Password function can be used to retrieve the
password.

Figure 4–4: FORGOT YOUR PASSWORD?


A question, which is pre-set by the user, will be asked. The password will be retrieved for entering the right answer.

4-4 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00.

5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.1UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00.

This section explains how to upgrade the F650 boot code and firmware for version below 7.00.

BEFORE PERFORMING THE UPGRADE PROCEDURE CHECK THAT BOOT AND FIRMWARE VERSION MATCH

The boot code and firmware versions can be seen in the relay main screen: The relay firmware version appears after the
text “F650“(5.70 in Figure 5–1:) with the boot program version (6.00 in Figure 5–1:) followed by “GENERAL ELECTRIC”,
the relay model and the default front RS232/USB port communication parameters.

Figure 5–1: MAIN SCREEN

BOOT CODE RELEASE NOTES


It is mandatory to maintain version compatibility between firmware and boot code in the upgrade procedure, otherwise the
relay will not start after upgrading.

FIRMWARE BOOTWARE AND 650 PC PROGRAM VERSIONS COMPATIBILITY


FIRMWARE CODE BOOT CODE ENERVISTA 650 PC
5.72 6.00 7.20
5.70 6.00 7.20
5.68 6.00 7.20
5.64 5.60 7.20
5.40 5.44-5.40 7.20
5.00 5.44-5.40 7.20
4.00 5.44-5.40-5.00-4.10 7.20
3.71 5.44-5.40-5.00-4.10 7.20
3.70 5.44-5.40-5.00-4.10 7.20
2.20 5.40-5.00, 4.10, 4.00 7.20

NOTE

A STEP LIST SUMMARY that will allow the user to control the upgrading process is included at the end of this section.
It is necessary to read paragraphs 1 to 4 of chapter 9 of manual GEK-106310 before accomplishing the F650
UPGRADE PROCEDURE.
5
Be aware that boot program and firmware upgrades will erase all the data contained in the relay, thus it is advisable to
save all the data, oscillography, events, settings and configuration files previously.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-1


5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00. 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

RELAYS WITH FIBER OPTIC ETHERNET


The upgrade of the boot program (BOOTCODE) must be performed by crossed Ethernet copper cable connected to the
PC. It is not necessary to change the internal switch from fiber to RJ45, because the upgrade is made at 10Mb/s.
This does not apply to the firmware upgrade, which can be done either via Ethernet Fiber connection, or through the
RJ45 cable connection.

For upgrading firmware versions lower than 3.20 or upgrading bootware, be aware to calibrate the unit offset, after
upgrading it, on Communication --> Calibration --> Offset Calibration . No analog currents nor analog voltages must be
injected in the unit during this process.

5.1.1 COMMUNICATION PARAMETERS

1. Ethernet Connection/Type - Both boot code and firmware upgrade processes require Ethernet communications. It is
strongly recommended to use a direct connection between the PC and the relay using a Cross-Over RJ45 Ethernet
cable, instead a direct connection through a hub or switch. Upgrading through Local Area Network (LAN) must be
avoided.
Serial RS232 Communication - Serial communication is necessary only to perform the bootware upgrade for versions
previous to 7.00.

2. Relay IP Address - And IP address must be assigned to the relay in the Ethernet parameters via HMI at PRODUCT
SETUP>COMMUNICATION>ETHERNET>ETHERNET1 menu or via Enervista 650 Setup at SETPOINT>PRODUCT
SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS>NETWORK (Ethernet) 1 as shown in the table below:

Table 5–1: ETHERNET PARAMETERS


PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >NETWORK (ETHERNET) 1
NAME VALUE UNITS RANGE
IP Address Oct1 192 [0 : 255]
IP Address Oct2 168 [0 : 255]
IP Address Oct3 37 [0 : 255]
IP Address Oct4 177 [0 : 255]
Netmask Oct1 255 [0 : 255]
Netmask Oct2 255 [0 : 255]
Netmask Oct3 255 [0 : 255]
Netmask Oct4 0 [0 : 255]
Gateway IP Oct1 192 [0 : 255]
Gateway IP Oct2 168 [0 : 255]
Gateway IP Oct3 37 [0 : 255]
Gateway IP Oct4 10 [0 : 255]

3. PC IP Address - In case the boot code has been previously updated to the relay (section 9.2), the IP address and other
parameters already assigned in the process will be:
5
IP Address:192.168.37.177
Netmask:255.255.255.0
Gateway:192.168.37.10

Then the PC settings should be the same pattern as follows:

5-2 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00.

IP Address:192.168.37.xxx
Netmask:255.255.255.0
Gateway:192.168.37.10 (if desired)

Where XXX is a number between 0 and 255 that is not assigned to any other device to avoid collisions.

4. Other Network, Communications and Data Flow checks

• According to the model number of the relay, to enable the 10/100 BASE TX-CABLE option in the relay communication
board, a specific jumper in this board must be changed. See detailed instructions in paragraph 3.4.3 of Instruction
Manual GEK-113000AD.
• IP address, netmask, gateway are correct and match the parameters used in the computer to perform the procedure.
See table 9.1 (on this chapter) of Manual GEK-113000AD COMMUNICATION PARAMETERS.

5.1.2 BOOTWARE VERSION UPGRADE

5.1.2.1 INTRODUCTION
Boot code upgrade is performed using EnerVista 650 Setup. Please use Enervista 650 Setup last version. It is required that
no active communication be established between the program and the relay, and that no configuration file open.
During the boot code upgrading process, all the data stored in the relay will be lost, so it is required to save all calibration,
settings, oscillography, etc. from the relay before the upgrade.

5.1.2.2 BOOTWARE UPGRADE


1. Windows XP, Windows 7 and Windows 8 Operating Systems must be used for installation and the reliable operation of
Enervista 650 Setup program and bootware/firmware relay upgrade.
2. To upgrade the boot code, it is required to connect an RS232 cable to the front of the relay, and an Ethernet cable to
the rear port (ETH_1/ETH_2 or ETH_E/ETH_A/ETH_B).
3. If it is being used a USB-to-Serial RS232 Cable Converter, it must be a RS-232C standard compliant, powered by the
User computer's USB bus and with DB9 male connector. To ensure the correct state of communication between the
computer and the relay along the whole upgrading process, all other USB devices must be unplugged. Due to the
extended variety of USB-to-Serial Cable Converters existing nowadays in the market, with different characteristics,
even different charge imposed to the USB bus of the PC, it is strongly recommended to use the GE USB-to-Serial
RS232 Cable Converter, part number GE0100-0001.
4. When using USB-to-Serial RS232 cable it is necessary first to determine the COM Port number the Laptop will use
through the USB device. Depending in the actual F650 upgrade task under operation, the procedure is as follows:
4.1 Firmware upgrade: It is not necessary the use of serial cable
4.2 Bootware and firmware upgrade being the relay fully operative with the actual F/W version: The COM port
number must be determined by using the 650 Setup program. With USB device disconnected from the Laptop and
from the relay, start the 650 Setup program. At the top menu bar choose
COMMUNICATION>COMPUTER>COMMUNICATION PORT menu and check the allowable serial ports
displayed.Return to the main 650 Setup screen and connect the USB device to PC and select again at the top
menu bar COMMUNICATION>COMPUTER>COMMUNICATION PORT menu the allowable serial ports now
displayed. The new one port number shown is the USB port number to be used for the upgrade process. 5
4.3 Bootware and firmware upgrade being the relay blocked at startup (no preliminary communication PC-Relay
allowable): Repeat the process described above in 4.2 to determine the COM PORT number and continue with
upgrade process.
5. Once determined the COM PORT number, set it at COMMUNICATION>COMPUTER menu together with and the
BAUD RATE and PARITY parameters. Click Store key.
6. Start Enervista F650 Setup program and at the top menu bar choose "COMMUNICATION>UPGRADE RELAY".

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-3


5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00. 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

Figure 5–2: UPGRADE DEVICE


7. Select "Device Boot Upgrade. FW version<7.00" option and click on […] button. The next new window will require the
bootware file retrieved from www.gedigitalenergy.com and previously stored someplace in the PC

Figure 5–3: BOOT CODE FILE SELECTION


8. Choose the bootware file and click Open button. The next screen will pop up:

Figure 5–4: UPGRADE SELECTED BOOT FILE

5-4 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00.

9. A warning messages will appear by clicking "UPGRADE FILE"

Figure 5–5: WARNING MESSAGE BEFORE BOOT CODE UPGRADE

If calibration files were saved click Yes, otherwise click No to cancel the upgrade process and save first the calibration files
according to manual section 4.1.11.

Figure 5–6: WARNING MESSAGE TO SAVE SETTING AND CONFIGURE FILES

10. Parameters already set in step 5 will be operative during serial communications. If they have not been previously set a
pop up window will come up, asking for serial COM port to be used during upgrading.

Figure 5–7: SET RELAY IP ADDRESS

11. .During the upgrade, the system will show the following message indicating the procedure to be followed.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-5


5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00. 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

Figure 5–8: ETHERNET AND SERIAL CONNECTIONS MESSAGE


If click Yes, the next window will allow you to choose the Network adapter for your Ethernet connection to the relay. Select
the correct one in case you have more than one

Figure 5–9: NETWORK ADAPTER

12. After selecting the Network adapter, a window to choose a temporary IP address will be shown. It is advisable to set
the same IP address that is going to be used lately in the relay for Ethernet connection.

5 Figure 5–10: SETTING ADDRESS

13. After entering the temporary IP Address, the next new window will require the bootware file retrieved from
www.gedigitalenergy.com and previously stored someplace in the PC.

5-6 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00.

Figure 5–11: BOOT CODE FILE SELECTION

14. Choose the bootware file and click Open button. The next screen will pop up:
:

Figure 5–12: LOADING BOOT CODE FILE

15. Then the program shows a message requiring switch OFF and ON the relay while the progress bar is in course, to start
the upgrading process.

Figure 5–13: RELAY SWITCH OFF-ON MESSAGE

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-7


5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00. 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

16. It is important to switch the Relay OFF and ON again during the time shown by the progress bar; in case this time
expires, the program will offer the option to continue with the process or to postpone, verify the correct RS232
connections and try again later. Notice that the serial COM PORT used in the boot upgrade procedure is the one
selected in step 4 above.

Figure 5–14: LOADING UPDATE FILE ERROR MESSAGE

If the relay gets stuck during the upgrading process after switching OFF and ON the relay, giving error message shown, it is
due to no serial communication via the front RS232 port. Please check serial cable and serial settings connection. At this
point the relay will not be upgraded.
After switching it OFF and ON it will continue working with the former firmware and bootware versions.

17. After switching the relay OFF and ON, if the serial communication between EnerVista 650 Setup and the relay is
correct the program shows the following message (Figure 5–13:):

Figure 5–15: CONFIGURATION PROCESS IN PROGRESS

Then it requires the confirmation to proceed to upgrade:

5-8 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00.

Figure 5–16: UPDATE CONFIRM

18. If click “YES” ("Sí" in the figure) the process will start, beginning with the relay flash memory deletion, so at this point
all the information stored in the relay will be lost. Until now, no important change has been made to the relay, the boot
memory upgrading process has just been prepared.
The process of flash memory erasing and boot code downloading can take some minutes, during which a progress bar
is displayed.

Figure 5–17: FLASH MEMORY ERASE PROGRESS BAR

19. If the process is successful, continue with step 20 hereafter. If not and the relay gets stuck during at “Sending file
imagen_kernel…” (see figure below)

5
Figure 5–18: DOWNLOAD PROCESS ADVISORY

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-9


5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00. 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

It may be due there is no communication via Ethernet port. At this moment, serial communications works properly, the relay
flash memory has been erased and the upgrade procedure must be completed to start working with the unit. If the
procedure is not completed, the HMI will show the message "Os Loading..." and the relay will not start up.
Then please check statements of point 4 above

If all the above points are correct but the problem persists:
-Disable and Enable the Ethernet connection while the files are being sent (during the “Sending file...” message -
previous figure). To do this, in Windows OS go to STARTUP>CONTROL PANEL>NETWORK
CONNECTION>LOCAL NETWORK>Right mouse key>Disable. Now the Local Network status Icon will be shown as
Disabled. In the same screen with Right mouse key over LOCAL NETWORK click Enable and wait until Enabled
status is shown.
20. Once the memory has been erased and the files upgraded in the relay, the parameters for the Ethernet
communications must be set. The requested values are the IP address and the gateway.

Figure 5–19: IP ADDRESS SETPOINT WINDOW

These values should match the LAN structure where the relay will be connected.
The relay IP address should have the first three octets corresponding with the gateway and the last octet must be a
free IP address reserved to the relay to avoid possible collisions with other devices.
The gateway must be the one used in the LAN structure connecting the relay

21. After assigned the Ethernet parameters, the upgrade of the boot code will be completed successfully (figure below).

22. New momentarily window will display: "Setting Default IP address”, and then it follows with:

Figure 5–20: BOOTWARE UPGRADE SUCCESSFUL PROCESS

After boot code upgrade, the equipment firmware must also be upgraded (hereafter).

5-10 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00.

5.1.3 FIRMWARE VERSION UPGRADE

5.1.3.1 INTRODUCTION
1. The relay settings and configuration will be lost, so it is advisable to save them to a file.
2. 2. For firmware revisions lower than 1.50, it is required to save calibration settings in a file before upgrading the F650
to a new firmware version.
3. 3. For firmware revision higher than 1.50 and only if just firmware upgrading (not bootware upgrade), it is not
necessary to save the calibration files since they will not be modified.
4. 4. Special care when boot code has been previously upgraded: all the data (including calibration settings) is lost.
5. 5. In case of error during the firmware upgrading process, the user could repeat the whole process as many times as
necessary, this is possible thanks to an independent boot memory (bootcode).
6. 6. Pure firmware upgrading process should be done using the EnerVista 650 Setup software and Ethernet connection
(Port ETH_1 or ETH2) via Cross-Over RJ45 Ethernet cable.

Note: Please take into account that downgrading firmware version could cause error in measurements.

5.1.3.2 FIRMWARE UPGRADE


1. Once the communication with the relay through Ethernet connection has been verified, enter the EnerVista 650 Setup
program, select Communication and the Upgrade Relay option on the top menu bar.

Figure 5–21: UPGRADE DEVICE 5

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-11


5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00. 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

2. Select "Device FW Upgrade. FW version <7.00" option an click on [...]. A pop up window will come up to allow users to
select the file

Figure 5–22: SELECT FIRWARE FILE

3. Click the “Upgrade File” button to continue.

5 Figure 5–23: UPGRADE FIRMWARE SELECTED FILE

5-12 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00.

4. Fill the upgrade parameters in next pop-up windows

Figure 5–24: RELAY SERIAL NUMBER

• In firmware version previous to 1.70 the Enervista 650 Setup program requires the IP address of the relay under
upgraded and its serial number.
• In versions 1.70 and higher it is also necessary to enter the ordering code for the relay. See figure below.

5. If the relay is not an enhanced model or control functionality then click the Upgrade Firmware button to continue the
process (figure below).

Figure 5–25: FIRMWARE UPGRADE ACCEPTANCE WINDOW

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-13


5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00. 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

At this point, proceeding with the upgrade will erase all the data stored in the equipment, including the calibration settings in
firmware version previous to 1.50. Therefore, it is necessary to save all settings to a file before following with the process
(figure below).

Figure 5–26: FIRMWARE UPGRADE STARTUP

If when click Yes button (figure above) an advise message is given (figure below), local network
reboot is necessary. Then please proceed as follows:

• Go to STARTUP>CONTROL PANEL>NETWORK CONNECTION>LOCAL NETWORK> Right mouse


key>Disable. Now the Local Network status will be shown as Disabled.In the same screen with Right mouse key
over LOCAL NETWORK click Enable and wait until Enabled status is shown. Then press Upgrade Firmware button
to continue the process (figure below).

5-14 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00.

Figure 5–27: ADVISORY FOR LOCAL NETWORK REBOOT

6. When upgrading models with Enhanced protection or control functionality (see model selection), the program will
request a password to continue (figure below)

Figure 5–28: RELAY REBOOT STEP

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-15


5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00. 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

In case special functionality model with password requirement please contact GE Multilin.

The following parameters must be clearly indicated in the order:


• Unit serial number
• Current model option (before memory upgrade)
• Desired model option (after memory upgrade)
• Unit MAC address (available in the identification label)

7. Once the upgrade parameters have been entered, press the "Aceptar" button. When communication has been
established, the program will show a message requesting to turn OFF and back ON the relay to continue with the
upgrade process.(figure below).

Figure 5–29: RELAY REBOOT STEP

8. Once the relay has been turned off and on, a new screen (figure below) will require the firmware upgrade files
("upgrade.txt"). Wherever from this Upgrade.txt file would be obtained (www.gedigitalenergy.com or from TS Dept. at
any GE Multilin facility), then it must be saved in some directory in the root drive or in the desktop of the PC.

5
Figure 5–30: FIRMWARE FILE ACCEPTANCE

If the files are downloaded from the web, they are compressed in a zip file. Proceed to extract all files and save them in the
directory just created

5-16 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00.

Selection of Upgrade.txt is shown in figure below. Select the desired "Upgrade.txt" file and click Open (Abrir) button.

Figure 5–31: FIRMWARE FILE SELECTION


9. Now a voltage range selection window will appear (figure below). This voltage range is closely related to the serial
number of the relay. For relays that have been manufactured with firmware version 5.70 or higher (From 2015 May),
the EnerVista 650 Setup program automatically pre-selects the appropriate voltage range for the unit based on the
serial number, showing the selection with a step line square over the proper option. Click OK button.
In case non-correct option is selected, metering errors may arise during normal operation mode (current and voltage
values incorrectly displayed). In order to correct this behavior, firmware upgrade process must be repeated and right
option must be selected.

Figure 5–32: AC VOLTAGE RANGE SELECTION-EXTENDED V RANGE (VERSION 2)


5

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-17


5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00. 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

10. Press Yes (Si) button.


11. Now the new window will show the Upgrade Firmware button ready to be enabled (figure below). Press it to start
upgrade.

Figure 5–33: UPGRADE INITIATION

During the process, the program displays the files that are being upgraded.

5-18 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00.

Figure 5–34: FIRMWARE FILE SELECTION

12. When the files transfer is finished, a message appears informing that it is necessary to wait sometime before resetting
the unit, in order to start working with the new firmware version in the relay (figure below).

13. When the whole process has finished a message will be displayed asking to switch the F650 on and off (figure below).

Figure 5–35: FIRMWARE FILE SELECTION

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-19


5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00. 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

14. Click Ok (Aceptar). At this point, the firmware upgrade procedure is finished and the relay is ready to be powered OFF
and ON to check that the firmware has been upgraded properly.

15. User settings and logic files downloading

When upgrading the firmware the entire settings and relay configuration are reset to factory default values. Then
the User is committed to download the settings, configuration and logic files to the relay in order to get it fully
operative.
Calibration settings and configuration must be reloaded to the relay the relay.
To recover and download the different files to the relay go to Enervista 650 Setup and at the top menu bar choose:
• COMMUNCATION>CALIBRATION>SET CALIBRATION FILES: to restore in the relay the calibration settings if
necessary.
• FILE>CONFIG FILE (*.650) Converter: to convert the setting and configuration file *.650 for the relay (if it was in a
previous version format).
• FILE>SEND INFO TO RELAY: to send the new settings and configuration file to the unit.

5.1.4 SUMMARY OF MAIN STEPS

5.1.4.1 BOOT CODE UPGRADE (*)


1. INSTALL THE PROPER VERSION OF THE ENERVISTA 650 SETUP PROGRAM.
2. CONNECT ONE RS-232CABLE IN THE FRONT PORT OF THE RELAY AND ONE ETHERNET CABLE AT THE
REAR ETHERNET PORT (CROSSOVER CABLE FOR BACK-TO-BACK CONNECTION AND STRAIGHT-THROUGH
ETHERNET CABLE FOR HUB OR SWITCH) .
3. GET CALIBRATION SETTINGS (AND SAVE IT TO A FILE).
4. SAVE ALL THE DATA FROM THE RELAY (SETTINGS, OSCILLOGRAPHY, EVENTS).
5. FROM THE ENERVISTA 650 SETUP PROGRAM SELECT “Communication > Upgrade Relay”.
6. FOLLOW THE INDICATIONS OF THE PROGRAM AND SELECT THE BOOT PROGRAM BIN FILE.
7. WHEN REQUIRED BY THE PROGRAM SWITCH OFF AND BACK ON THE RELAY.
8. CONTINUE WITH THE PROCESS AND SET THE IP ADDRESS AND GATEWAY WHEN REQUIRED.

5.1.4.2 FIRMWARE UPGRADE (*)


1. INSTALL THE PROPER VERSION OF THE ENERVISTA 650 SETUP PROGRAM.
2. CONNECT ONE ETHERNET CABLE AT THE REAR ETHERNET PORT (CROSSOVER CABLE FOR BACK-TO-
BACK CONNECTION AND STRAIGHT-THROUGH ETHERNET CABLE FOR HUB OR SWITCH).
3. SET THE APPROPRIATE IP ADDRESS IN THE RELAY.

5 4.
5.
SET THE APPROPRIATE IP ADDRESS IN THE PC.
FROM THE ENERVISTA 650 SETUP PROGRAM SELECT “Communications > Upgrade Relay”.
6. ENTER THE IP ADDRESS, SERIAL NUMBER AND ORDERING CODE OF THE RELAY TO UPGRADE.
7. WHEN REQUIRED BY THE PROGRAM SWITCH OFF AND BACK ON THE RELAY.
8. LOCATE THE UPGRADE.TXT FILE ACCORDING TO THE MODEL OF THE RELAY.
9. PRESS UPGRADE FIRMWARE AND INITIATE THE UPGRADE PROCESS.

5-20 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.1 UPGRADE FROM VERSION BELOW V7.00.

10. TO COMPLETE THE PROCEDURE, SWITCH OFF AND BACK ON THE RELAY WHEN REQUIRED BY THE
PROGRAM.
11. SET CALIBRATION SETTINGS (FROM THE PC TO THE RELAY) (for versions lower than 1.50).
12. THE SETTINGS AND CONFIGURATION ARE NOW SET TO FACTORY DEFAULT.
13. SEND THE NEW SETTINGS AND CONFIGURATION FILES TO THE RELAY IF NECESSARY.

(*) The boot code upgrade must be performed using a crossed copper cable (RJ45) connected to the PC. It is not
necessary to modify the internal fiber/cable switch, as the upgrade is carried out at 10 Mb/s, and thus there is not cable/
fiber conflict.This fact does not apply to the firmware upgrade, which can be performed either with the Ethernet fiber
connection, or with the cable connection.
Note: Please see chapter 13 F650 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE if there is any problem during the upgrading
process.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-21


5.2 FIRMWARE UPGRADE VERSION V7.00 OR HIGHER 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

5.2FIRMWARE UPGRADE VERSION V7.00 OR HIGHER

5.2.1 INTRODUCTION

This section explains how to upgrade the F650 firmware code for version V7.00 or higher.

BOOT CODE RELEASE NOTES

It is mandatory to maintain version compatibility between firmware and boot code in the upgrade procedure, otherwise the
relay will not start after upgrading.

BEFORE PERFORMING THE UPGRADE PROCEDURE CHECK THAT BOOT AND FIRMWARE VERSION MATCH.

Firmware Bootware Enervista


7.12 7.12 7.20
7.20 7.12 7.20

5.2.2 COMMUNICATION PARAMETERS

1. Ethernet Connection/Type - Firmware upgrade processes require Ethernet communications. It is strongly recommended
to use a direct connection between the PC and the relay using a Cross-Over RJ45 Ethernet cable, instead a direct
connection through a hub or switch.

2. Relay IP Address - It must be assigned a IP address to the relay in the Ethernet parameters via HMI at PRODUCT
SETUP>COMMUNICATION>ETHERNET>ETHERNET E, A or B menu or via Enervista 650 Setup at
SETPOINT>PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS>NETWORK (Ethernet) E, A or B as shown in the Table
below.

Table 5–2: ETHERNET PARAMETERS

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >NETWORK (ETHERNET)


NAME EVALUE UNITS RANGE
IP Address Oct1 192 [0 : 255]
IP Address Oct2 168 [0 : 255]
IP Address Oct3 37 [0 : 255]
IP Address Oct4 177 [0 : 255]
Netmask Oct1 255 [0 : 255]
Netmask Oct2 255 [0 : 255]
Netmask Oct3 255 [0 : 255]
Netmask Oct4 0 [0 : 255]
PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >ROUTING
NAME EVALUE UNITS RANGE
Default RT GWY Oct1 192 [0 : 255]
Default RT GWY Oct2 168 [0 : 255]
Default RT GWY Oct3 37 [0 : 255]
Default RT GWY Oct4 10 [0 : 255]

3. Example of IP Address Configuration:

5 The IP address and other parameters already assigned in the process will be:
IP Address:192.168.37.177
Netmask:255.255.255.0
Gateway:192.168.37.10

Note: To assure that the configuration is correctly setup it is possible to perform a ping command from the PC.

5-22 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.2 FIRMWARE UPGRADE VERSION V7.00 OR HIGHER

Then the PC settings should be the same pattern as follows:

IP Address:192.168.37.xxx

Netmask:255.255.255.0

Gateway:192.168.37.10 (if desired)

Where XXX is a number between 0 and 255 that is not assigned to any other device to avoid collisions.

5.2.3 FIRMWARE VERSION UPGRADE

5.2.3.1 INTRODUCTION

1. The relay settings and configuration will be lost, so it is advisable to save them to a file.
2. 2. In case of error during the firmware upgrading process, the user could repeat the whole process as many times as
necessary.
3. 3. Firmware upgrading process should be done using the EnerVista 650 Setup software and Ethernet connection (Port
ETH_E, A or B) via Cross-Over RJ45 Ethernet cable.

5.2.3.2 FIRMWARE UPGRADE

1. Once the communication with the relay through Ethernet connection has been verified, enter the EnerVista 650 Setup
program, select Communication and the Upgrade Relay option on the top menu bar.

Figure 5–36: FIRMWARE UPGRADE STARTUP

2. Select "Device Upgrade. FW&Boot>=7.00" option and click on […] button for selecting the file. The file *.SFD would be
obtained from, www.gedigitalenergy.com or from TS Dept. at any GE Multilin facility. Then it must be saved in some 5
directory in the root drive or in the desktop of the PC.Choose the corresponding firmware file for upgrading the device.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-23


5.2 FIRMWARE UPGRADE VERSION V7.00 OR HIGHER 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

3. Enter communication parameters of the relay that is going to be upgraded and click on "Upgrade" button

Figure 5–37: RELAY COMMUNICATION PARAMETERS

If the IP address is not the correct one, then the following message will appear:

Figure 5–38: UNABLE TO CONNECT TO IP

4. If the IP address is correctly set, then the message "*.SFD Sending file" will be displayed in the main screen. Sending
file status bar will show the progress.

5
Figure 5–39: UPGRADE INITIALIZATION

5-24 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.2 FIRMWARE UPGRADE VERSION V7.00 OR HIGHER

5. If the file has not been successfully sent, the following message box is displayed.

Figure 5–40: ERROR SENDING FILE

6. After sending file, upgrading process starts

Figure 5–41: UPGRADE IN PROGRESS

7. When the flashing process has finished, a message appears informing that it is necessary reboot the unit in order to
start working with the new firmware version in the relay.

Figure 5–42: REBOOT MESSAGE

8. User settings and logic files downloading

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-25


5.2 FIRMWARE UPGRADE VERSION V7.00 OR HIGHER 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

When upgrading the firmware the entire settings and relay configuration are reset to factory default values. Then the User
is committed to download the settings, configuration and logic files to the relay in order to get it fully operative.

Calibration settings and configuration must be loaded to the relay once the upgrade process has finished.

To recover and download the different files to the relay use Enervista 650 Setup and at the top menu bar choose:
• COMMUNCATION>CALIBRATION>SET CALIBRATION FILES: to restore in the relay the calibration settings if
necessary.
• FILE>CONFIG FILE (*.650) Converter: to convert the setting and configuration file *.650 for the relay (if it was in a
previous version format).
• FILE>SEND INFO TO RELAY: to send the new settings and configuration file to the unit.

5.2.3.3 ORDERING CODE UPGRADE PROCESS


In case special functionality model (or a new order codes required by customer) with password requirement (see model
selection), the program will request a password to continue.

1- With the purpose of reaching the window where the password is requested, the user must be communicating to
the relay (ONLINE MODE). On the menu “File” the following submenu will be available (for firmware versions
>=700):

5
Figure 5–43: ORDER CODE SUBMENU

5-26 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.2 FIRMWARE UPGRADE VERSION V7.00 OR HIGHER

2- After clicking on the menu the following window appear:

Figure 5–44: SET ORDER CODE

3- This window only allows changing the last digit, which refers to supported communications protocols options. Click
on send:

Figure 5–45: PASSWORD REQUIREMENT (SPECIAL MODELS)


5
4- The users must contact GE Multilin and provide the following parameters in their order:

• Unit serial number


• Current model option (before memory upgrade)
• Desired model option (after memory upgrade)
• Unit MAC address (available in the identification label)

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-27


5.2 FIRMWARE UPGRADE VERSION V7.00 OR HIGHER 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

5- Once the password is obtained enter in the above window and the following messages will appear if the password
is correct.

Figure 5–46: EXECUTED SUCCESFULLY

6- After the successful operation, the “SEND” button will be disabled. It is not allowed to make another change from
here, so it can be seen what changes have been made. The new order code will appear on the status bar.

Figure 5–47: NEW ORDER CODE

5-28 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE 5.2 FIRMWARE UPGRADE VERSION V7.00 OR HIGHER

5.2.4 SUMMARY OF FIRMWARE UPGRADE MAIN STEPS (*)

1. INSTALL THE PROPER VERSION OF THE ENERVISTA 650 SETUP PROGRAM.

2. CONNECT ONE ETHERNET CABLE AT THE REAR ETHERNET PORT (CROSSOVER CABLE FOR BACK-
TOBACK CONNECTION AND STRAIGHT-THROUGH ETHERNET CABLE FOR HUB OR SWITCH).

3. SET THE APPROPRIATE IP ADDRESS IN THE RELAY.

4. SET THE APPROPRIATE IP ADDRESS IN THE PC.

5. FROM THE ENERVISTA 650 SETUP PROGRAM SELECT “Communications > Upgrade Relay”.

6. SELECT THE NECESSARY FILE (DCL000CAXXX.SDF) FOR DEVICE UPGRADING.

7. ENTER THE IP ADDRESS, PORT and UNIT IDENTIFIER OF THE RELAY.

8. PRESS UPGRADE FILE AND INITIATE THE UPGRADE PROCESS.

9. TO COMPLETE THE PROCEDURE, SWITCH OFF AND BACK ON THE RELAY WHEN REQUIRED BY THE

PROGRAM.

10. THE SETTINGS AND CONFIGURATION ARE NOW SET TO FACTORY DEFAULT.

11. SEND THE NEW SETTINGS AND CONFIGURATION FILES TO THE RELAY IF NECESSARY.

Note: Please see chapter 13 F650 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE if there is any problem during the upgrading
process.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 5-29


5.2 FIRMWARE UPGRADE VERSION V7.00 OR HIGHER 5 BOOTCODE AND FIRMWARE UPGRADE

5-30 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


6 COMMISSIONING 6.1 VISUAL INSPECTION

6 COMMISSIONING 6.1VISUAL INSPECTION


Verify that the relay has not suffered any damage during transportation, and that all screws are correctly fixed, and all relay
terminal boards are in good condition.
Verify that the information shown on the relay front plate corresponds to the data shown on the display, and to the
requested relay model.

Display information:

Firmware version

F650 X.XX(K.KK) Kernel version

GENERAL ELECTRIC
F650XXXXXXXXX Model

19200N81 MODBUS:254

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 6-1


6.2 OUT OF SERVICE SETTING 6 COMMISSIONING

6.2OUT OF SERVICE SETTING


The unit has the Relay Out Of Service setting only configured at the general settings element. The unit has also an Out
Of service Status that it is only configured at Relay configuration > Protection elements tab. These states act stopping
all the changes on PLC equations and functions, even stopping all the changes in the input/output boards, so if there is a
change in any of the input or output the unit will not show this change until the unit has been set again in ready mode. For
example if an output is closed and the unit goes to out of service state, the output will be kept closed even though the state,
that makes it to close, change to open the output. When the unit goes out of the out of service state the output will be
opened if it was a change.
When the Out of Service status goes to ON, or the setting has been changed to Enabled, the ready led will also change to
red color. Be careful if ready led is linked to an output, because the output will not change its state. To set outputs to ready
state see factory default Logic & Configuration in the detailed manual. Take notice that, in the default configuration, the
general setting out of service is set to enable so it is necessary to change to disabled to start working with the unit
The following figure shows the flow chart of these states

6-2 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


6 COMMISSIONING 6.3 GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS ON THE POWER SUPPLY NETWORK

6.3GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS ON THE POWER SUPPLY NETWORK


All devices running on AC current are affected by frequency. As a non-sine wave is the result of a fundamental wave plus a
series of harmonics from this fundamental wave, we can infer that devices running on AC current are influenced by the
applied waveform.
For a correct testing of relays running on AC current, it is fundamental to use a current and/or voltage senoidal waveform.
The pureness of a senoidal wave (lack of harmonics) cannot be expressed specifically for a specific relay. However, any
relay incorporating sintonized circuits, R-L and R-C circuits, will be affected by non-senoidal waveforms, as in the case of
F650.
These relays respond to the voltage waveform in a different way to the majority of AC current voltmeters. If the power
supply network used for the testing contains wide harmonics, the voltmeter and relay responses will be different.
Relays have been calibrated in factory using a Network of 50 or 60 Hz with a minimum harmonic content. When the relay is
tested, a power supply network with no harmonics in its waveform must be used.
The ammeters and chronometers used for testing the pickup current and relay operation time must be calibrated and their
accuracy must be better than the relay’s. The power supply used in the tests must remain stable, mainly in the levels near
the operation thresholds.
It is important to point out that the accuracy with which the test is performed depends on the network and on the
instruments used. Functional tests performed with unsuitable power supply network and instruments are useful to check
that the relay operates properly and therefore its operating characteristics are verified in an approximate manner. However,
if the relay would be calibrated in these conditions, its operational characteristics would be outside the tolerance range
values.
The following sections detail the list of tests for verifying the complete relay functionality.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 6-3


6.4 ISOLATION TESTS 6 COMMISSIONING

6.4ISOLATION TESTS
During all tests, the screw located on the rear of the relay must be grounded.
For verifying isolation, independent groups will be created, and voltage will be applied as follows:
2200 RMS volts will be applied progressively among all terminals in a group, short-circuited between them and the
case, during one second.
2200 RMS volts will be applied progressively between groups, during one second.
WARNING: No communication circuit shall be tested for isolation.
Groups to be created will depend on the type of modules included in F650, selectable according to the model.
The following table shows the different groups depending on the module type:

G1: H10, H18


SOURCE 1:
G2: H13, H14, H15
G1: H1, H9
SOURCE 2:
G2: H4, H5, H6
G1: A5..A12
MAGNETIC MODULE.
G2: B1..B12
G1 (Inp. 1): F1..9
I/O F1 (MIXED) G2 (Inp. 2): F10..18
G3 (Out.): F19..36
G1 (Spv 1): F1..4
G2 (Inp. 1): F5..9
G3 (Inp. 2): F10..14
I/O F2 (SUPERVISION)
G4 (Spv 2): F15..18
G5 (Out.): F19..30
G6 (Out.): F31.36
G1 (Inp. 1): G1..9
I/O G1 (MIXED) G2 (Inp. 2): G10..18
G3 (Out.): G19..36
G1 (Inp. 1): G1..9
G2 (Inp. 2): G10..18
I/O G4 (32DI)
G3 (Inp. 3): G19..28
G4 (Inp. 3): G29..36
G1 (Inp. 1): G1..9
I/O G5 (ANALOG)
G2 (Inp. 2): G10..18

6-4 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


6 COMMISSIONING 6.5 INDICATORS

6.5INDICATORS
Feed the relay and verify that when commanding a LED reset operation, all LED indicators light up and they are turned off
when pressing the ESC key for more than 3 seconds.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 6-5


6.6 POWER SUPPLY TESTING 6 COMMISSIONING

6.6POWER SUPPLY TESTING


Feed the relay with the minimum and maximum voltage. For each voltage value, verify that the alarm relay is activated
when there is voltage, and it is deactivated when there is no feed. If the power supply source incorporates AC feed, this test
will be performed also for VAC.
If the relay incorporates a redundant power supply, these tests shall be performed on both power supplies.
Voltage values to be applied will be the ones indicated below according to the relay model:

SUPPLY V MIN. V MAX.

HI/HIR
110-250 Vdc 88 Vdc 300 Vdc
120-230 Vac 96 Vac 250 Vac
LO/LOR
24-48 Vdc 19.2 Vdc 57.6 Vdc

NOTE: Codes HIR and LOR correspond to a redundant power supply

6-6 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


6 COMMISSIONING 6.7 COMMUNICATIONS

6.7COMMUNICATIONS
Verify that available communication ports allow communication with the relay.
Ports to be checked are as follows:
Front:RS232
Rear:2 x RS485, 2 x Fiber Optic - Serial, 2 x Fiber Optic - Ethernet, 1 x RJ45 - Ethernet .
A computer with EnerVista 650 Setup software and an appropriate connector must be used.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 6-7


6.8 VERIFICATION OF MEASUREMENT 6 COMMISSIONING

6.8VERIFICATION OF MEASUREMENT
Set the relay as follows
GENERAL SETTINGS
NAME VALUE UNITS RANGE
PHASE CT RATIO 1.0 0.1 1.0-6000.0
GROUND CT RATIO 1.0 0.1 1.0-6000.0
STV GROUND CT RATIO 1.0 0.1 1.0-6000.0
PHASE VT RATIO 1.0 0.1 1.0-6000.0
PHASE VT CONNECTION WYE N/A WYE – DELTA
NOMINAL VOLTAGE 100 V 0.1 1-2250 V
NOMINAL FREQUENCY 50 Hz 1 Hz 50-60 Hz
PHASE ROTATION ABC N/A ABC – ACB
FREQUENCY REFERENCE VI N/A VI-VII-VIII
AUXILIARY VOLTAGE VX N/A VX – VN

NOTE:
ALL ANGLES INDICATED ARE LAGGING ANGLES
ALL VALUES OBTAINED IN THIS TEST MUST BE THE ONES CORRESPONDING TO THE PHASOR ONES

6.8.1 VOLTAGES

Apply the following voltage and frequency values to the relay:

CHANNEL ANGLE FREQUENCY


50 Hz 60 Hz 50 Hz 60 Hz 50 Hz 60 Hz
VI 0º 0 5 50 100 150 200
VII 120º 0 5 50 100 150 200
VIII 240º 0 5 50 100 150 200
VX 0º 0 5 50 100 150 200

Verify that the relay measures the values with an error of ±1 % of the applied value from 10V to 208V.

6.8.2 PHASE CURRENTS

Apply the following current and frequency values to the relay:


CHANNEL ANGLE FREQUENCY
50 Hz 60 Hz 50 Hz 60 Hz 50 Hz 60 Hz
Ia (A) 45º 0 15 10 5 1 0.1
Ib (A) 165º 0 15 10 5 1 0.1
Ic (A) 285º 0 15 10 5 1 0.1
IG (A) 0º 0 15 10 5 1 0.1

ISG (A) 0º 0 5 1 0.1 0.01 0.005

Verify that the relay measures the values with an error lower than ±0.5% of the test value or ± 10 mA, whichever is greater,
for phases and ground.
Verify that the relay measures the values with an error lower than ±1.5% of the test value or ± 1 mA, whichever is greater,
for sensitive ground (SG).

6-8 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


6 COMMISSIONING 6.8 VERIFICATION OF MEASUREMENT

Percent of Load-to-Trip
The relevant actual values displays are shown below:
ACUAL -> METERING -> PRIMARY VALUES -> CURRENT -> % OF LOAD-TO-TRIP
Note Percent of load-to-trip is calculated from the phase with the highest current reading. It is
the ratio of this current to the lowest pickup setting among the phase time and instantaneous overcurrent protection
features. If all of these features are disabled, the
value displayed will be “0”.
- Inject current of various values into Phase A.
- Verify that percent load-to-trip is calculated as the correct
percentage of the most sensitive operational Phase Overcurrent
element and displayed.
- Repeat for phases B and C.

6.8.3 ACTIVE, REACTIVE POWER, AND COSJ METERING

Equations to be applied for powers in a wye connection are as follows:

POWER PER PHASE THREE-PHASE POWER


P=V*I*Cosϕ P=Pa+Pb+Pc
Q=V*I*Senϕ Q=Qa+Qb+Qc

Apply the following current and voltage values:

APPLIED VOLTAGE AND CURRENT VALUES PER PHASE


PHASE A PHASE B PHASE C V-I ANGLES
VI = 50 V, 0º VII = 50 V , 120º VIII = 50V, 240º ϕ=45º
Ia = 10∠45º Ib= 10∠165º Ic = 10∠285º Cosϕ= 0.707

With the indicated voltage and current values, verify that the power measure corresponds to expected values indicated in
the following table:

EXPECTED POWER VALUES


PHASE A PHASE B PHASE C THREE-PHASE
Pa = 353.55 MW Pb = 353.55 MW Pc = 353.55 MW P = 1060.66 MW
Qa = 353.55 MVAr Qb = 353.55 MVAr Qc = 353.55 MVAr Q = 1060.66 MVAr

Maximum admissible error is ± 1% of the test value for P and Q, and 0.02 for cosj.

6.8.4 FREQUENCY

Frequency measure on channel VII (terminals A7-A8):


Apply 50 Vac at 50 Hz on channel VII. Maximum admissible error:± 10 mHz.
Apply 50 Vac at 60 Hz on channel VII. Maximum admissible error: ± 12 mHz.

6
Frequency measure on channel Vx (terminals A11-A12):

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 6-9


6.8 VERIFICATION OF MEASUREMENT 6 COMMISSIONING

Apply 50 Vac at 50 Hz on channel Vx. Maximum admissible error:± 10 mHz.


Apply 50 Vac at 60 Hz on channel Vx. Maximum admissible error: ± 12 mHz.

Results:

CHANNEL VOLTAGE (V) SET FREQUENCY (HZ) MEASURED FREQUENCY (HZ)


VII 50 50 Hz
60 Hz
VX 50 50 Hz
60 Hz

6-10 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


6 COMMISSIONING 6.9 INPUTS AND OUTPUTS

6.9INPUTS AND OUTPUTS


During all tests, the screw on the rear of the relay must be grounded.

6.9.1 DIGITAL INPUTS

During this test, the user will determine the activation/deactivation points for every input in the relay for the set voltage value
of 30 Volts.
Verify that the error does not exceed ± 10% (+10% on activation, -10% on deactivation).
Default board settings for the input test can be modified in EnerVista 650 Setup software in:
Setpoint>Inputs/Outputs>Contact I/O>Board X
X, will be substituted by the corresponding board:
F for board in first slot
G for board in second slot
H for board in first slot of CIO module
J for board in second slot of CIO module

Test settings for mixed board (type 1:16 inputs and 8 outputs):

I/O BOARD TYPE 1 (MIXED)


Voltage Threshold A_X 30 V
Voltage Threshold B_X 40 V
Debounce Time A_X 5 ms
Debounce Time B_X 5 ms
Input Type_X_CC1 (CC1) POSITIVE
... ...
Input Type_X_CC16 (CC16) POSITIVE

The inputs test is completed by groups of 8 inputs, as this type of board has 2 groups of 8 inputs with the same common.
For the first 8 inputs, the voltage threshold setting is determined by Voltage Threshold A. For the next 8 inputs, the setting
is Voltage Threshold B. Inputs (or contact converters, CC1 – CC16) must also be set to POSITIVE.
Test settings for mixed board (type 2: 8 digital inputs, 4 blocks for supervision and 8 outputs):

I/O BOARD TYPE 2 (SUPERVISION)


Voltage Threshold A_X 30 V
Voltage Threshold B_X 40 V
Debounce Time A_X 5 ms
Debounce Time B_X 5 ms
Input Type_X_CC1 (CC1) POSITIVE
... ...
Input Type_X_CC8 (CC8) POSITIVE

The inputs test is completed by groups of 4 inputs, as this type of board has 2 groups of 4 inputs with the same common.
For the first 4 inputs, the voltage threshold setting is determined by Voltage Threshold A. For the next 4 inputs, the setting
is Voltage Threshold B. Inputs (or contact converters, CC1 – CC8) must also be set to POSITIVE.
If the relay incorporates more input modules, these tests must also be applied to them.
6

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 6-11


6.9 INPUTS AND OUTPUTS 6 COMMISSIONING

6.9.2 CONTACT OUTPUTS

The correct activation of every output will be verified.


For every output, activation command of a single contact must be given, and then verify that only that contact is activated.
Go to EnerVista 650 Setup Software (Setpoint>Inputs/Outputs>Force Outputs).
For switched contacts, the change of state of both contacts shall be verified.

6.9.3 CIRCUIT CONTINUITY SUPERVISION INPUTS

Supervision inputs will be tested as normal inputs, revising the voltage level that will be 19 Volts.
Coil 1:
Apply 19 Vdc to both 52/a (terminals F1-F2) and 52/b (terminals F3-F4)”Coil 1” circuit supervision inputs and verify that
they are activated.
Apply -19 Vdc to both 52/a (terminals F1-F2) and 52/b (terminals F3-F4)”Coil 1” circuit supervision inputs and verify
that they are activated.
Remove voltage from both inputs and verify that it takes them 500 ms to change state (deactivate).

Coil 2:
Apply 19 Vdc to both 52/a (terminals F15-F16) and 52/b (terminals F17-F18)”Coil 2” circuit supervision inputs and
verify that they are activated.
Apply -19 Vdc to both 52/a (terminals F15-F16) and 52/b (terminals F17-F18)”Coil 2” circuit supervision inputs and
verify that they are activated.
Remove voltage from both inputs and verify that it takes them 500 ms to change state (deactivate).

6.9.4 LATCHING CIRCUITS

Send a closing command to the latched contact (F31-F33).

Make circulate a current of 500 mA through the contact in series with the sensing terminal.
Send an opening command and verify that the contact does not open.
Interrupt current and check that the contact is released.

500
I

Repeat the test for the other latched contact (F34-F36).

6-12 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


6 COMMISSIONING 6.10 CONNECTIONS FOR TESTING PROTECTION ELEMENTS

6.10CONNECTIONS FOR TESTING PROTECTION ELEMENTS


Connect current sources to the relay according to the wiring diagram. Current and voltage input terminals are as follows:

PHASE CONNECTIONS
Current
IA B1-B2
IB B3-B4
IC B5-B6
IG B9-B10
ISG B11-B12
Voltage
VI A5-A6
VII A7-A8
VIII A9-A10
VX A11-A12

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 6-13


6.11 INSTANTANEOUS OVERCURRENT (50PH, 50PL, 50N, 50G Y 50SG) 6 COMMISSIONING

6.11INSTANTANEOUS OVERCURRENT (50PH, 50PL, 50N, 50G Y 50SG)


Set the relay to trip for the protection element being tested. Configure any of the outputs to be enabled only by the
protection element being tested.
Apply 0.9 times the Pickup current and check that the relay does not trip.
Gradually increase the current value and verify that the relay operates between 1 and 1.1 times the set pickup current. The
relay must trip by instantaneous in a time frame of 10 to 55 ms. All the relay trip contacts must operate, as well as the
contact set as 50.
Remove current and apply it again suddenly to a value of 4 times the pickup current. The relay should trip instantaneously
in a time frame of 10 to 45 ms.
Test one point for each phase and group of the protection element.

50 ELEMENTS TEST PARAMETERS


Element Settings (50PH, 50PL, 50G y 50SG)
Setting Value Units
Function Enabled
Input RMS NA
Pickup Level 3 A
Delay time 0 Seconds
Test Execution
Configure one output for 50 Trip
Apply times I pickup Element Trip Tripping times (ms)
0.9 x Pickup NO NA
1.1 x Pickup YES 10-55
4 x Pickup YES 10-45
Elements Phase Group
50PH and 50PL IA 0
IB 0
IC 0
50G IG 0
50SG (*) ISG 0

Note (*): Only available for Enhanced models

6-14 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


6 COMMISSIONING 6.12 TIME OVERCURRENT (51PH, 51PL, 51N, 51G AND 46)

6.12 TIME OVERCURRENT (51PH, 51PL, 51N, 51G AND 46)


Set the relay to trip for the protection element being tested. Configure any of the outputs to be activated only by the
protection element being tested.
Apply 0.9 times the Pickup current and check that the relay does not trip.
Apply 1.5 times the Pickup current. The relay should trip according to the time corresponding to its set curve.
Apply 5 times the Pickup current. The relay should trip according to the time corresponding to its set curve.

PROTECTION ELEMENT SETTINGS (51PH, 51PL, 51N, 51G AND 46)


SETTING VALUE UNIT
FUNCTION ENABLED
INPUT PHASOR (DFT)
PICKUP LEVEL 1 A
CURVE MODIFY FOR EACH TEST
TD MULTIPLIER MODIFY FOR EACH TEST
VOLTAGE RESTRAINT DISABLED
ELEMENT PHASE CURVE TYPE DIAL TIMES TRIPPING TIMES (SEC)
IPICKUP EXPECTED ADMISSIBLE
51PH IA IEEE Ext Inv 0.5 0.9 NA
1.5 11.34 [11.00 – 11.90]
5 0.648 [0.600 – 0.710]
IB IEC Curve A 0.05 0.9 NA
1.5 0.860 [0.750 – 0.950]
5 0.214 [0.200 – 0.300]
51PL IC IEEE Ext Inv 0.5 0.9 NA
1.5 11.34 [11.00 – 11.60]
5 0.648 [0.600 – 0.710]
IB IEC Curve A 0.05 0.9 NA
1.5 0.860 [0.750 – 0.950]
5 0.214 [0.200 – 0.300]
51N IC IEEE Ext Inv 0.5 0.9 NA
1.5 11.34 [11.00 – 11.60]
5 0.648 [0.600 – 0.710]
51G IG Definite Time 2 0.9 NA
5 2.000 [1.900 – 2.100]
46 I2 IEC Curve A 0.05 0.9 NA
1.5 0.860 [0.750 – 0.950]
5 0.214 [0.200 – 0.300]

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 6-15


6.13 DIRECTIONAL ELEMENTS (67P, 67N, 67G, 67SG) 6 COMMISSIONING

6.13DIRECTIONAL ELEMENTS (67P, 67N, 67G, 67SG)


In order to test directional units in the relay, instantaneous trips will be commanded.
Two points will be tested, per phase, test element.
In order to test the directional units, configure (in the "Setpoint > Relay Configuration > Protection Elements" screen of
the EnerVista 650 Setup program), some overcurrent element to be supervised by a directional unit. This way, if the
directional element is enabled and detects the fault in the block direction, then the overcurrent unit will not operate. If the
directional element is not enabled or if it is enabled and it detects a fault in a trip direction, then the overcurrent unit will
operate if the set current level is exceeded.

6.13.1 67P ELEMENT

Activate only protection elements 50PH and 67P and set the relay as follows:

67P SETTINGS 50PH SETTINGS


Function ENABLED Function ENABLED
MTA 45 Deg Input PHASOR (DFT)
Direction FORWARD Pickup Level 0.50 A
Block Logic PERMISSION Trip Delay 0.30
Pol V Threshold 30 V Reset Delay 0.00

Configure one of the outputs to be activated only by unit 50PH.


Apply the following tests:

ELEMENTS PHASE UNDER TEST POLARIZATION PHASE ELEMENT TRIP


CHANNEL MAGNITUDE CHANNEL MAGNITUDE
MOD ARG MOD ARG
50PH/67P IA 2A 0º VIII 60 V 0º NO
60 V 180º YES

IB 2A 0º VI 60 V 0º NO
60 V 180º YES

IC 2A 0º VII 60 V 0º NO

60 V 180º YES

6.13.2 67N ELEMENT

Activate only protection elements 50N and 67N and set the relay as follows:
67N SETTINGS 50N SETTINGS
Function ENABLED Function ENABLED
MTA -45 Deg Input PHASOR (DFT)
Direction FORWARD Pickup Level 0.50 A
Polarization VO Trip Delay 0.30
Block Logic PERMISSION Reset Delay 0.00
Pol V Threshold 10 V

6 Configure one of the outputs to be activated only by unit 50G.

6-16 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


6 COMMISSIONING 6.13 DIRECTIONAL ELEMENTS (67P, 67N, 67G, 67SG)

Apply the following tests:

ELEMENTS PHASE UNDER TEST POLARIZATION PHASE ELEMENT TRIP


CHANNEL MAGNITUDE CHANNEL MAGNITUDE
MOD ARG MOD ARG
50N/67N IA 2A 0º VI 60 V 0º NO
60 V 180º YES

IB 0A 0º VII 0V 0º

IC 0A 0º VIII 0V 0º

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 6-17


6.13 DIRECTIONAL ELEMENTS (67P, 67N, 67G, 67SG) 6 COMMISSIONING

6.13.3 67G ELEMENT

Activate only protection elements 50G and 67G and set the relay as follows:

67G SETTINGS 50G SETTINGS


Function ENABLED Function ENABLED
MTA -45 Deg Input PHASOR (DFT)
Direction FORWARD Pickup Level 0.50 A
Polarization VO Trip Delay 0.30
Block Logic PERMISSION Reset Delay 0.00
Pol V Threshold 10 V

Configure one of the outputs to be activated only by unit 50G.


Apply the following tests:

ELEMENTS PHASE UNDER TEST POLARIZATION PHASE ELEMENT TRIP


CHANNE MAGNITUDE CHANNEL MAGNITUDE
L
MOD ARG MOD ARG
50G/67G IG 2A 0º VI 60V 0º NO
60V 180º YES
VII 0º

VIII 0º

6-18 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


6 COMMISSIONING 6.13 DIRECTIONAL ELEMENTS (67P, 67N, 67G, 67SG)

6.13.4 67SG ELEMENT

Activate only protection elements 50SG and 67SG and set the relay as follows:

67SG SETTINGS 50SG SETTINGS


Function ENABLED Function ENABLED
MTA -45 Deg Input PHASOR (DFT)
Direction FORWARD Pickup Level 0.50 A
Polarization VO Trip Delay 0.30
Block Logic PERMISSION Reset Delay 0.00
Pol V Threshold 10 V

Configure one of the outputs to be activated only by unit 50SG.


Apply the following tests:

ELEMENTS PHASE UNDER TEST POLARIZATION PHASE ELEMENT TRIP


CHANNEL MAGNITUDE CHANNEL MAGNITUDE
MOD ARG MOD ARG
50SG/67SG ISG 2A 0º VI 60 V 0º NO
60 V 180º YES
VII 0V 0º

VIII 0V 0º

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 6-19


6.14 UNDERVOLTAGE ELEMENTS (27P, 27X) 6 COMMISSIONING

6.14UNDERVOLTAGE ELEMENTS (27P, 27X) 6.14.1 27P ELEMENT

Set the relay to trip for the protection element being tested. Configure any of the outputs to be activated only by the
protection element being tested.
Set the relay as follows:

PHASE UV (27P)
Function ENABLED
Mode PHASE-GROUND
Pickup Level 50 V
Curve DEFINITE TIME
Delay 2.00 sec
Minimum Voltage 30 V
Logic ANY PHASE
Supervised by 52 DISABLED

Apply voltage as indicated on the table over the undervoltage setting level and verify that the relay does not trip.
Decrease voltage level gradually and verify that the relay trips for the set voltage (with an admissible error of 5%).

ELEMENT PHASE CURVE PICKUP DELAY APPLIED TRIPPING TIMES (S)


LEVEL VOLTAGE EXPECTED ADMISSIBLE
27P VI DEFINITE 50 V 2 55 V NO TRIP NA
TIME 45 V 2.000 sec [2.000 – 2.100]

6.14.2 27X ELEMENT

Set the relay to trip for the protection element being tested. Configure any of the outputs to be activated only by the
protection element being tested.
Set the relay as follows

GENERAL SETTINGS
Auxiliary Voltage VX

AUXILIARY UV (27X)
Function ENABLED
Pickup Level 50 V
Curve DEFINITE TIME
Delay 2.00 sec

Apply voltage as indicated on the table over the undervoltage setting level and verify that the relay does not trip.
Decrease voltage level gradually and verify that the relay trips for the set voltage (with an admissible error of 5%).

ELEMENT INPUT CURVE PICKUP DELAY APPLIED TRIPPING TIME (S)


LEVEL VOLTAGE
EXPECTED ADMISSIBLE
6 27X VX DEFINITE
TIME
50 V 2 55 V NO TRIP NA
45 V 2.000 sec [2.000 – 2.100]

6-20 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


6 COMMISSIONING 6.15 OVERVOLTAGE ELEMENTS (59P, 59X, 59NH, 59NL, 47)

6.15OVERVOLTAGE ELEMENTS (59P, 59X, 59NH, 59NL, 47) 6.15.1 59P ELEMENT

Set the relay to trip for the protection element being tested. Configure any of the outputs to be activated only by the
protection element being tested.
Set the relay as follows:
PHSE OV (59P)
Function ENABLED
Pickup Level 120 V
Trip Delay 2.00
Reset Delay 0.00
Logic ANY PHASE

Apply voltage as indicated on the table under the overvoltage setting level and verify that the relay does not trip.
Verify that the relay trips for the set voltage (with an admissible error of 5%).

ELEMENT PHASE PICKUP LEVEL TRIP DELAY APPLIED TRIPPING TIME (S)
(VOLTS) (SECONDS) VOLTAGE (V)
EXPECTED ADMISSIBLE
59P VII 120 2 114 NO TRIP NA
132 2 [1.9–2.1 ]
132 2 [1.9 – 2.1]

6.15.2 59X ELEMENT

Set the relay as follows:

GENERAL SETTINGS
Auxiliary Voltage VX

AUXILIARY OV (59P)
Function ENABLED
Pickup Level 120 V
Trip Delay 2.00
Reset Delay 0.00
Logic ANY PHASE

Apply voltage as indicated on the table under the overvoltage setting level and verify that the relay does not trip.
Verify that the relay trips for the set voltage (with an admissible error of 5%).

ELEMENT INPUT PICKUP LEVEL TRIP DELAY APPLIED TRIPPING TIME (S)
(VOLTS) (SECONDS) VOLTAGE (V)
EXPECTED ADMISSIBLE
59X VX 120 2 114 NO TRIP NA
132 2 [1.9–2.1]
132 2 [1.9 – 2.1]

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 6-21


6.15 OVERVOLTAGE ELEMENTS (59P, 59X, 59NH, 59NL, 47) 6 COMMISSIONING

6.15.3 59NH AND 59NL ELEMENTS

Set the relay as follows

GENERAL SETTINGS
Auxiliary Voltage VN

NEUTRAL OV HIGH/LOW (59NH/59NL)


Function ENABLED
Pickup Level 120 V
Trip Delay 2.00
Reset Delay 0.00

Apply voltage as indicated on the table under the overvoltage setting level and verify that the relay does not trip.
Verify that the relay trips for the set voltage (with an admissible error of 5%).

ELEMENTS INPUT PICKUP LEVEL TRIP DELAY APPLIED TRIPPING TIME (S)
(VOLTS) (SECONDS) VOLTAGE (V) EXPECTED ADMISSIBLE
59NH/59NL VX 120 2 114 NO TRIP NA
132 2 [1.9–2.1 ]
132 2 [1.9 – 2.1]

This element can also be tested by applying only phase voltages. For this purpose, it is necessary to set Auxiliary Voltage =
VX. In this condition, Vn voltage is calculated as a sum of the phase voltages.

6-22 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


6 COMMISSIONING 6.15 OVERVOLTAGE ELEMENTS (59P, 59X, 59NH, 59NL, 47)

6.15.4 47 ELEMENT - NEG SEQ OV

Set the relay as follows:

NEG SEQ OV (47)


Function ENABLED
Pickup Level 50 V
Trip Delay 2.00
Reset Delay 0.00

Apply voltage as indicated on the table under the overvoltage setting level and verify that the relay does not trip.
Verify that the relay trips for the set voltage (with an admissible error of 5%).

CHANNEL APPLIED VOLTAGE (V) ANGLE TRIPPING TIME (S)


EXPECTED ADMISSIBLE
VI 65 0º NO TRIP NA
VII 65 120º
VIII 65 240º
VI 55 0º 2 [1.9–2.1]
VII 55 240º
VIII 55 120º
VI 45 0º NO TRIP NA
VII 45 240º
VIII 45 120º

NOTE: All angles mentioned on the tables are delay angles, where a balanced ABC system would be composed by:

CHANNEL APPLIED VOLTAGE (V) ANGLE

VI 65 0º
VII 65 120º
VIII 65 240º

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 6-23


6.16 FREQUENCY ELEMENTS (81O/81U) 6 COMMISSIONING

6.16 FREQUENCY ELEMENTS (81O/81U)


Set the relay to trip for the protection element being tested. Configure any of the outputs to be activated only by the
protection element being tested.
Set the relay as follows:

GENERAL SETTINGS
Nominal Frequency 50 Hz

ELEMENT SETTINGS
FREQUENCY (81) 81U 81O
Function ENABLED ENABLED
Pickup Level 47.50 Hz 52.50 Hz
Trip Delay 2.00 sec 2.00 sec
Reset Delay 0.00 sec 0.00 sec
Minimum Voltage 30 V 30 V

Apply voltage as indicated on the table, modifying frequency from the maximum threshold (48 Hz) to the minimum (46 Hz)
for 81U, and from the minimum (52 Hz) to the maximum (54 Hz) for 81O, in steps of 10 mHz.
Verify that the relay trips at the set frequency in the corresponding element with an error of 3% ó ±50 mHz.
Apply a voltage that is lower than the “Minimum Voltage” setting, with a frequency under (81U) or over (81O) the setting,
and verify that the relay does not trip.

ELEMENTS PHASE PICKUP LEVEL TRIP DELAY APPLIED FREQUENCY TRIPPING TIME (S)
(HZ) (SECONDS) VOLTAGE (V) THRESHOLDS EXPECTED ADMISSIBLE
81U VII 47.5 2 80 48 Hz No trip NA
46 Hz 2 [1.9 -2.1]
25 46 Hz No trip NA
81 O VII 52.5 2 80 52 Hz No trip NA
54 Hz 2 [1.9 –2.1]
25 54 Hz No trip NA

6-24 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


6 COMMISSIONING 6.17 RECLOSER (79)

6.17 RECLOSER (79)


Set protection element 79 as follows:

RECLOSER
Function ENABLED
Max Number Shots 4
Dead Time 1 2.10 sec
Dead Time 2 4.10 sec
Dead Time 3 6.10 sec
Dead Time 4 8.10 sec
Reclaim Time 3.00 sec
Cond. Permission ENABLED
Hold Time 7.00 sec
Reset Time 5.00 sec

Set the relay to trip by 50PH, and configure the signals necessary to test the 79 element:
Configure one output as AR RECLOSE
Configure the AR INITIATE signal with the 50PH trip
Configure the AR LEVEL BLOCK signal with a digital input
Configure the AR CONDS INPUT with the digital signal desired

50PH SETTINGS
Function ENABLED
Input RMS
Pickup Level 3A
Trip Delay 0.00 s
Reset Delay 0.00 s

6.17.1 RECLOSING CYCLE

Connect a latching relay simulating the breaker managed by the F650 unit.
Once the relay is set, close the breaker and wait for 5 seconds.
After this time, the recloser is ready to initiate the reclosing cycle.
Command a 50PH trip and verify that the breaker opens and the relay recloses in 2.1 seconds.
Command a 50PH trip and verify that the breaker opens and the relay recloses in 4.1 seconds.
Command a 50PH trip and verify that the breaker opens and the relay recloses in 6.1 seconds.
Command a 50PH trip and verify that the breaker opens and the relay recloses in 8.1 seconds.
Command a 50PH trip and verify that the breaker opens and the recloser passes to Lockout.
Verify the correct operation of programmed outputs
Tripping times must be within the following values:

RECLOSING CYCLE
Nº shot Expected time Admissible time
1 2.1 sec [1.8 – 2.3]
2 4.1 sec [3.8 – 4.3]
3 6.1 sec [5.8 – 6.3]
4 8.1 sec [7.8 – 8.3]
6

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 6-25


6.17 RECLOSER (79) 6 COMMISSIONING

6.17.2 RECLOSER STATUS

BLOCK
Activate the block input and verify that the recloser is in BLOCK status.
Close the breaker and wait for 5 seconds.
Command a trip and verify that the breaker opens but there is no reclose.

INHIBITION BY RECLOSING CONDITIONS


Close the breaker and wait for 5 seconds.
Command a trip, verify that the breaker opens and wait for the first shot.
Activate the inhibition input and command a new trip.
Verify that the breaker opens, wait for 8 seconds and verify that the relay does not reclose.

6.17.3 EXTERNAL RECLOSE INITIATION

Close the breaker and wait for 5 seconds.


Activate the reclose initiation input and open the breaker, verify that the relay executes the first shot

6-26 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


6 COMMISSIONING 6.18 THERMAL IMAGE ELEMENT (49)

6.18 THERMAL IMAGE ELEMENT (49)


Disable all protection elements except for Thermal Model (49).
Set the pickup level to 2 A.
Set the time constant t1 to 3 minutes and t2 to one time t1.
Apply currents of 2, 5, and 10 times the tap and ensure that the operation times are within the range described on the
following table:

RATED CURRENT (A) APPLIED CURRENT (A) TIMES DE SET TAP OPERATION TIME (S)
4.0 2 48.5 - 53.6
5 10.0 5 7.06 - 7.80
20.0 10 1.77 - 1.95

After each measuring, the thermal element must be reset to zero in order to start the next test at a zero thermal status
condition.

Repeat the test selecting a time constant t1 of 60 minutes. Verify that the operation time is within the range described on
the following table:

RATED CURRENT (A) APPLIED CURRENT (A) TIMES DE SET TAP OPERATION TIME (S)
4.0 2 960 - 1072
5 10.0 5 141 - 156
20.0 10 35.4 - 39

After each measuring, the thermal element must be reset to zero in order to start the next test at a zero thermal status
condition.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 6-27


6.18 THERMAL IMAGE ELEMENT (49) 6 COMMISSIONING

6-28 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


7 FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS 7.1 COMMUNICATIONS

7 FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS 7.1COMMUNICATIONS


Q1. Does the F650 support DNP and ModBus over the Ethernet port?
A1. F650 units support both protocols over both the asynchronous serial ports and the Ethernet LAN synchronous port
using TCP/IP and UDP/IP layers over the Ethernet.

Q2. Does this equipment support dual IP access?


A2. Yes, it supports two independent IP addresses in aliasing mode. Those address go in the communications settings 7
Network0 and Network1.

Q3. Is the protocol IEC 870-103 supported by the F650?


A3. Yes, IEC 870-103 is supported by the F650 in firmware version 5.00 and higher.

Q4. Can the F650 be used as a DNP master station?


A4. Not at this moment. It works as a slave IED station for all protocols.

Q5. How many communication ports are included in the F650?


A5. The equipment has 2 different boards, one for asynchronous serial ports and another for a high-speed synchronous
Ethernet port. The first board has 2 comm ports, COM1 and COM2. COM2 is multiplexed with the front serial RS232
port, whereas the COM1 port is completely independent from COM2.
The synchronous LAN port is ETH_1/ETH2 or ETH_E/ETH_A/ETH_B (Depending on model.

Q6. Are there one or two Ethernet ports?


A6. The equipment has only 1 Ethernet port. For redundant fiber optic versions, redundancy is done at the physical level
(fiber optic) but there is just one port.

Q7. How many different communication Ethernet sessions can be opened through the LAN port?
A7. ModBus TCP/IP:4 sockets
DNP TCP/IP:3 sessions (from version 1.72 on)

Q8. May I use the cooper 10/100 BaseTX connection included in the basic model with all protocols?
A8. Yes, it may be used with all protocols. In noisy substation environments and/or long distances, it is recommended to
use fiber optic options due to much better EMC performance and immunity. For fiber optic models, it is necessary to
adjust an internal jumper to use the copper port.
Q9. Remote I/O CAN bus. Does it support DeviceNet protocol?
A9. No it does not support DeviceNet.

Q10. Which functions are available in the relay web server?


A10. Currently, it includes several functions for viewing measures and retrieving information.

Q11. Q11 May I use URPC to program the relay?


A11. Only oscillography records may be viewed with URPC once downloaded to a file using the ENERVISTA 650 Setup
software.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 7-1


7.1 COMMUNICATIONS 7 FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS

Q12. May I connect URs and F650s to the same Ethernet?


A12. Yes, either in cable as in fiber, or even mix them.

Q13. How do I connect with fiber 10-BASE-FL UR relays with 100-BASE-FX F650 relays?
A13. Take into account that an UR is never connected directly to a F650 (neither two UR nor two F650 with each other)
but they are always connected through a hub or switch. The hub or switch where the URs are connected must be
7 10-BASE-FL and the hub or switch for the F650 must be 100-BASE-FX.

Q14. How do I connect with cable 10_BASE-T UR relays with 10/100-BASE-TX F650 relays?
A14. The answer to this question is as described before but also in this case there is an advantage added, because the
hub 10-BASE-TX port is able to understand a 10-BASE-T port. This means that a hub 10-BASE-T port may be
connected to an UR or a F650, and a hub 10/100-BASE-TX port may be connected either to an UR or F650.

Q15. What happens with fiber optic connectors compatibility, because the hub that I have has a different
connector to the one of the F650, although both are 100-BASE-FX?
A15. Just buy fiber cables with the appropriate male connectors. For the UR and F650 side we need the same
connectors, ST type, for the hub side, the correspondent ones. And in what concerns to the fiber type, it is used the
same for 10 as for 100, it is the 50/125 or 62.5/125 multimode, this last one allows longer distances.

Q16. What is the difference between a hub and a switch?


A16. In a repeater type hub (shared hub), one unit talks and the rest listen. If all the units are talking at the same time
there may be collisions in the messages, what may produce certain communication delays.
The switch (switched hub) has very powerful processors and a lot of memory and it is much more expensive than
the hub. It directs messages to the proper destination avoiding collisions and allowing a much more efficient
communication.

Q17. Why do we have 10/100 compatibility for cable but not for fiber?
A17. The cable has some advantages that the fiber does not have, and it is that the signal attenuation in short and
medium distances, is worthless and this is truth for low and high frequency signals. By the contrary, the light in one
fiber optic is highly attenuated, being much worse in case of high frequencies than in the low ones. The 10-BASE-FL
fiber transmission is performed in a wavelength of 850nm, what allows a less expensive electronic than the 1300 nm
used in 100-BASE-FX fiber transmission. Using, in both cases, the same glass multimode fiber type, the attenuation
to 1300 nm is lower than the 850 nm ones, this way the greater attenuation of the 100 Mbits is compensated. There
is another fiber standard, the 100-BASE-SX, which uses 850 nm to 100 Mbits, being compatible with the 10-BASE-
FL one, although it sacrifices the maximum distance to 300 m. Nowadays, this standard has not had success among
Ethernet equipment manufacturers and suppliers.

7-2 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


7 FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS 7.2 PROTECTION

7.2PROTECTION
Q1. Does the F650 support IRIG-B signals? Which type and accuracy? How many units may be connected to the
same source?
A1. Yes, the F650 includes an IRIG-B input for all models, including the basic ones.
It uses DC level format B. Formats used are B0000, B0002 and B0003.
Actual accuracy is 1 millisecond. Internal sampling rate allows true 1 ms accuracy time tagging.
The input burden is very low. The maximum number of units that may be connected to a generator depends on its 7
output driving capability. Up to 60 units have been successfully connected with equipments commonly used in the
market.

Q2. Does the equipment work with dry inputs in both AC and DC?
A2. The equipment works only with DC inputs.
Inputs should be driven with externally generated DC current. No special 48 Vdc or other outputs are included in the
equipment to drive these inputs; therefore, contacts connected to the equipment should be connected to a DC
source.
Q3. Is it oscillography programmable?
A3. Yes, the sampling rate is programmable (4, 8, 16, 32 or 64 samples per input). The depth will depend on the
sampling rate.

Q4. Do I have to select a different model for 1 or 5 A?


A4. No. The same model is able to work with either /1 A or /5 A rated secondary currents. There are high accuracy
sensing transformers that allow the use of any current input through the same terminals to reduce the spares and
simplify wiring.

Q5. In my installation, several digital inputs become active when I energize the transformer. How can I reduce
sensitivity?
A5. By selecting debounce time and/or voltage threshold, the relay may adapt its sensitivity to different applications.
Please select the maximum voltage threshold and debounce time (recommended 15 ms) to minimize AC coupling
effects.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 7-3


7.3 CONTROL AND HMI 7 FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS

7.3CONTROL AND HMI


Q1. What is the difference between Get/Send info from/to relay and Upload/Download info files to/from relay?
A1. Get/Send are used for settings and configuration storage that although both are in a unique file, are sent separately
in two times. Upload/Download are used for project or PLC files group storage. These files are the
setting_configuration file source. To operate, the F650 does not need the source files; the Upload/Download tool is
destined to serve as historic file.

7 Q2. Could I program interlocks?


A2. Yes, via ENERVISTA 650 Setup interlocks may be programmed from very simple to advanced schemes.

Q3. Can we rotate the display 90 degrees to show feeders vertically?


A3. No. The product has been designed to view it in horizontal mode (landscape) due to the following reasons:
It is easier to read the LCD display because it has been designed for horizontal positions.
Compatibility between text display (4x20 characters) and LCD display (16x40 characters or 128x240 pixels).
Refresh speed is better in horizontal than vertical format.

Q4. Do I need a laptop or handheld to program the unit?


A4. No, all main operations can easily be performed with just the incorporated HMI. Handheld or laptops may be
required to download large quantities of information (such as oscillograms, etc.) but they are not mandatory for a
conventional user that just needs to change settings, view measurements, states, etc.

Q5. Is there password security for protection and control?


A5. Yes, there are two passwords. An independent password for protection changes and control operations is available
since version 1.44

Q6. Is it possible to have a remote HMI installed in the front of the panel with the rest of the relay in the rear
side?
A6. Not in the present version.

Q7. Is it possible to program a default screen for the HMI?


A7. In graphic display versions the user may program a custom screen with the single-line diagram, measurements, etc.
In text display models, there is a choice of logo, measurements, or scrolling both screens.

Q8. May I force inputs and outputs to ease commissioning and testing?
A8. Yes.

Q9. How can I disable the rotary knob buzzer?


A9. Press ESC key for more than 3 seconds and then press the knob during a short pulse.

Q10. Why do appear strange texts on the display when switching on the relay?
A10. You will have pressed any button and the HMI has entered in a test mode.
The display messages are updated after a few minutes, once the relay has completed the starting sequence.

7-4 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


7 FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS 7.4 RELAY CONFIGURATION

7.4RELAY CONFIGURATION
Q1. Does the "Service" contact on the Power Supply board cover all possible failures or do I have to create an
output on the I/O board that includes all the internal errors I can access in the logic?
A1. The power supply ready contact only monitor hardware failures in the power supply, to monitor the internal error of
the unit it is necessary to configure a virtual output to and the assign it to the device desired (contact output, LED,
etc.).

Q2. I set an output contact as "Latched". If I do not set a "reset" condition, will it reset from the "ESC" key?
7
A2. No, you have to configure the contact output reset signal (in Setpoint>Relay Configuration>Outputs).
The ESC key only reset the LED indicators.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 7-5


7.4 RELAY CONFIGURATION 7 FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS

7-6 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


8 F650 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE 8.1 SYMPTOMS AND RECOMMENDED ACTIONS

8 F650 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE 8.1SYMPTOMS AND RECOMMENDED ACTIONS


F650 units have been designed and verified using the most advanced and reliable equipment. Mounting and
testing automation ensure a high consistency of the final product. Before sending a unit back to the factory, we
strongly recommend you follow the recommendations below. Even if it will not always solve the problem, at least
they will help define it better for a quicker repair.
If you need to send a unit back to the factory for repair, please use the appropriate RETURN MATERIAL AUTHORIZATION
process, and follow the shipping instructions provided by our Service Department, especially in the case of international
shipments. This will lead to a faster and efficient solution of your problem.
CATEGORY SYMPTOM POSSIBLE CAUSE RECOMMENDED ACTION
Protection The relay does not trip -Function not permitted -Set the function permission to
ENABLED

- Function blocked -Check Protection units block screen

- Output not assigned


-Program the output to the desired
function using ENERVISTA 650 Setup
8
logic configuration

- The unit is not set to ready - Verify that the general setting is set to
disable and the out of service state is
not active
General When feeding the unit, -Insufficient power supply -Verify the voltage level using a
no indicator is lit up multimeter in the power supply
terminals, and check that it is within
the model range

- Wrong versions -Check relay and ENERVISTA 650


Setup versions are the same

-Fuse failure -Remove power supply, dismount the


power supply module and replace the
fuse

- Loose fuse -Same as above with same fuse

-Incorrect wiring -Make sure that terminals labeled +


and – are connected to the 9-pin
connector corresponding to the power
source
Communication The relay does not -Incorrect cable -Make sure you are using a straight
communicate via the cable
front RS232 port
-Damaged cable -Replace the cable

-Relay or PC not grounded -Ensure ground connection

-Incorrect baudrate, port, address, etc. -Test other ports, other baudrates, etc.
Make sure that the communication
parameters in the computer match the
ones in the relay.

General After Updating the Check that the bootware version -If there is an incompatibility between
firmware the relay match with the firmware version boot and firmware version, update to
does not start up and the corresponding boot and after that
always shows the update the firmware version
message “Os
Loading…”. -If the boot and firmware versions are
correct, perform the firmware update
procedure again.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 8-1


8.1 SYMPTOMS AND RECOMMENDED ACTIONS 8 F650 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE

CATEGORY SYMPTOM POSSIBLE CAUSE RECOMMENDED ACTION


Communications Cannot see properly 1.- Disabled Java options in Advanced 1.1- Go to Advanced in Internet
the web server in F650 Internet Explorer properties or high options
with Windows XP. level of security for Internet explorer and select the
three selections in Microsoft VM (Java
Some windows are in 2.- Nor Java Virtual Machine installed. Virtual Machine) and deselect any
grey with a red cross other virtual machine not Microsoft, for
mark. example SUN.
In case Microsoft VM is not installed in
the computer, the user must install it
using the Microsoft VM installation
program msjavx86.exe
For internet explorer 6.0 or higher it is
not included by default.

1.2.- Try to set a lower level of security


in
internet explorer options.
8 1.3.-Delete temporary internet files in
"General" screen in internet explorer
options.
Communication Enervista 650 Setup
does not retrieve osc,
fault reports and Data
Logger files
Bad communication in TFTP using
Windows 2000
Disable and Enable the Ethernet
connection on Control Panel inside
Windows 2000. Try again

2.1- Install either Microsoft or Sun Java


Virtual Machine

Communication Enervista 650 Setup Bad communication in TFTP using Disable and Enable the Ethernet
does not retrieve osc, Windows 2000 connection on Control Panel inside
fault reports and Data Windows 2000. Try again to retrieve
Logger files files from relay
Firmware and bootware upgrade
Bootware The relay gets stuck - The relay does not communicate via To perform the bootware upgrading
during the upgrading the front RS232 port process it is necessary to connect the
process after switching unit thought the front RS232 port.
off and on the relay, check:
giving the following • Serial cable correct(straightthrouhg)
error message: and undamaged.
“ERROR Setting relay • Settings selection in Enervista 650
in configuration mode. Setup Communication>Computer
Retry? Settings”:
o Com port selected must be the
one that is being used to perform
this procedure
o Parity set to NONE
o Baudrate set to 19200
o Control type: No control type
o Modbus slave number: any
Note: if the bootware upgrading
procedure got stuck at this point
the relay will not be upgraded. After
switching it off and on will continue
working with the former firmware
and bootware versions.

8-2 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


8 F650 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE 8.1 SYMPTOMS AND RECOMMENDED ACTIONS

CATEGORY SYMPTOM POSSIBLE CAUSE RECOMMENDED ACTION


Bootware The relay gets stuck at -The Ethernet connection does not Serial communications work properly
“Sending file work properly. and the flash memory has been
imagen_kernel...” erased but ethernet communication
does not work properly, check:
• RJ45 cable used (crossover cable
for back-to-back connection and
straightthrough Ethernet cable for hub
or switch)
• IP address, netmask, gateway are
correct and corresponding to the ones
used in the computer used to perform
the procedure. See chapter 5.2.1
COMMUNICATION SETTINGS in
instruction manual GEK-106310AD
• Ethernet board parameters selection,
check that:
o 802.1p QOS is Enabled
o Flow control is Auto
o Speed & Duplex is Auto (or 8
10 Mb Full)
• If all the above points are correct but
the problem persists:
o Force the Speed & Duplex to
10 Mb Full
o Disable and enable the
Ethernet connection while the
files are being sent (during the
“sending file...” message
Note: if the bootware upgrading
procedure got stuck at this point,
the relay flash memory has been
erased and the upgrade procedure
must be completed to start working
with the unit. If the procedure is not
completed, the HMI will show the
message “Os Loading...” and the
relay will not start up.
Firmware The procedure can not -The Ethernet connection does not • Check the same as in the point
start due to ethernet work properly. above for bootware.
problems Note: if the firmware upgrading
procedure got stuck at this point the
relay will not be upgraded. After
switching it off and on will continue
working with the former firmware and
bootware versions.
Firmware Program messages - File path is too long • Check the path length, copy the files
“file” do not exist in - File has no file attributes in a shorter path and start again the
local drive upgrade procedure.
• Check the unzip process to see if the
file properties are properly set to “File”.
• Note: if the firmware upgrading
procedure got stuck after having
been started, the former firmware
has been erased and the upgrade
procedure must be completed to
start working with the unit. If the
procedure is not completed, the HMI
will show the message “Os
Loading...” and the relay will not
start up.
Firmware It is not possible to to - IEC 61850 upgrade from standard • If the customer wants to upgrade
upgrade models models is password protected. from a standard model to a 6 one, ask
without IEC 61850 to the factory for a Upgrade package,
models with IEC depending on the former hardware the
61850 automatically unit has, if hardware 00 they will need
hardware and firmware change
(passwored protected), if hardware 01
or above they will need only firmware
change (passwored protected).

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller 8-3


8.1 SYMPTOMS AND RECOMMENDED ACTIONS 8 F650 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE

Firmware During the upgrading - Communication problems during the • EnerVista 650 Setup program do not
procces for models upgrade procecure. ask for a password if the relay model is
with IEC 61850 -The procedure has been not IEC61850 and the procedure is
sometimes it ask for performed in a continuous way. completed.
password and • If during the process there is any
sometimes not. problem and has to be started again,
this second time the program will ask
to confirm the IEC password.
• If the EnerVista 650 Setup program
is closed and started again during the
bootware and firmware upgrade
process, the program will ask to
confirm the IEC password.
Firmware Password for - Model change • The password is tied to the model,
IEC61850 incorrect - Incorrect mac or serial number MAC Address and serial number, any
change in any of the following will need
a password change.
• If the model has been modified to
8 add or replace any boards or
communication protocol, the IEC
61850 passwords will need to be
updated (contact the factory).
EnerVista 650 Setup InstallShield Setup A previous installation of any product Delete (or rename) the 0701 folder
Initialization Error using InstallShield for installation may located in "C:\Program Files\Common
6001 have corrupted some of the Files\InstallShield\Professional\RunTi
InstallShield files used in the EnerVista me\" and retry installation
650 Setup installation

8-4 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

APPENDIX A LOGIC OPERANDSA.1LOGIC OPERANDS


OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX
INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS A
AUTOCHECK INTERNAL STATES (CRITICAL)
DSP Communication Error: (0) Rignt communications
DSP COMM ERROR between DSP and main processor; (1) Communication
Error between DSP and main processor
Magnetic Module Error: (0) Right Communication
MAGNETIC MODULE between DSP and magnetic module processor; (1)
DSP Internal States (Critical to metering and ERROR Communication Error between DSP and magnetic
protection)
module processor
Calibration Error: (0) Right calibration values stored; (1)
CALIBRATION ERROR The calibration values stored are out of the calibration
limits.
Flash Internal States (Critical to Relay configuration E2prom status :(0) Not configured or problems during
and stored data) E2PROM STATUS
writing process ; (1) Configured and OK
Board F status: (0) Inactive - There is no communication
BOARD F STATUS with the board (1) Active - There is communication with
the board.

BOARD G STATUS Board G status: (0) Inactive - There is no communication


with the board (1) Active - There is communication with
IO Board States (Critical to operation and the board.
protection)
Board H status: (0) Inactive - There is no communication
BOARD H STATUS with the board (1) Active - There is communication with
the board.
Board J status: (0) Inactive - There is no communication
BOARD J STATUS with the board (1) Active - There is communication with
the board.
IEC61850 INTERNAL STATES (NON CRITICAL)
UNKNOWN: when the relay has not the IEC61850 proto-
col in the relay model the ICD status is unknow to the
unit
ICD ERROR: There is an error in the ICD file and the
relay ICD is not operative. To solve this issue it is neces-
sary to send a correct ICD to the relay using the
IEC61850 configurator tool. When the ICD error is raised
the IEC 61850 will not be operative (the IEC 61850 cli-
ent, reports and gooses will not work). It is advisable to
include the ICD ERROR in the main error signal config-
ured by the customers in their applications.
IEC61850 Internal States ICD STATUS
MODIFIED: The settings have been changed in the icd
but they are still not wrtten in the icd file in the relay
IN PROGRESS: The icd setting are being written to the
file in the relay
OK WITHOUT DAIS: The relay has not got the "Use DOI
&DAI" setting enabled (true) and it is working properly
with the ICD file.
OK: The relay has got the "Use DOI &DAI" setting
enabled (true) and it is working properly with the ICD file.
When that setting is set to true the icd setting will prevail
over the relay settings.
OTHER INTERNAL STATES (NON CRITICAL)

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-1


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

USER MAP STATUS User map status: (0) Not configured ; (1) Configured
FACTORY
A CALIBRATION Calibration status (0) Relay calibrated; (1) Not calibrated

FLEXCURVE A STATUS User curve A: (0) Not configured (1) Configured


FLEXCURVE B STATUS User curve B: (0) Not configured (1) Configured
FLEXCURVE C STATUS User curve C: (0) Not configured (1) Configured
Other internal states
FLEXCURVE D STATUS User curve D: (0) Not configured (1) Configured
Green Zone Memory internal status
Yellow Zone Memory internal status
Orange Zone Memory internal status
Red Zone Memory internal status
UpTime System Time
TIMER STATUS Real time clock autocheck (not available)

Autocheck Internal States (Not available)


GRAPHIC STATUS Graphic display status (not available)
ALARM TEXT ARRAY Text display status (not available)

Note: It is advisable to use the critical alarms to raise an event or to light a warning led for maintenance purposes. See the
example below, the Board X Status depends on the relay model.

Figure A–1: PROTECTION ALARM SIGNAL

A-2 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

VIRTUAL OUTPUT 000 Configurable logic output 000


VIRTUAL OUTPUT 001 Configurable logic output 001
Configurable Logic Outputs (512 elements)
... ...
A
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 511 Configurable logic output 511

Operation bit 001: (0) the configured time expires or


OPERATION BIT 1 when success conditions are met;(1) operation 1 is
executed and interlocks are fulfilled.

Operation bit 002: (0) the configured time expires or


OPERATION BIT 2 when success conditions are met;(1) operation 2 is
Operation Bits (24 elements) executed and interlocks are fulfilled.

... ...

Operation bit 024: (0) the configured time expires or


OPERATION BIT 24 when success conditions are met;(1) operation 24 is
executed and interlocks are fulfilled.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-3


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)


CONTROL EVENT 1 Control Event 1 Activation Bit
CONTROL EVENT 2 Control Event 2 Activation Bit
Control Event Bits (128 elements)
... ...
CONTROL EVENT 128 Control Event 128 Activation Bit
LATCHED VIRT IP 1 Latched virtual input 1
LATCHED VIRT IP 2 Latched virtual input 2
Latched Virtual Inputs (32 elements)
... ...
LATCHED VIRT IP 32 Latched virtual input 32
SELF-RST VIRT IP 1 Self reset virtual input 1
SELF-RST VIRT IP 2 Self reset virtual input 2
Self Reset Virtual Inputs (32 elements)
... ...
SELF-RST VIRT IP 32 Self reset virtual input 32
CONT IP_X_CC1 Input 1 (CC1) in Board X
CONT IP_X_CC2 Input 2 (CC2) in Board X
Contact Inputs Type 1Board
... ...
CONT IP_X_CC16 Input 16 (CC16) in Board X

CONT IP_X_CC1 Input 1 (CC1) in Board X

CONT IP_X_CC2 Input 2 (CC2) in Board X

... ...

CONT IP_X_CC8 Input 8 (CC8) in Board X

CONT IP_X_CC9 Contact Input 09 (Va_COIL1) for slot X. Input voltage


(Va_COIL1) (Va) detected, Circuit 1. Complete circuit supervised

CONT IP_X_CC10 Contact Input 10 (Vb_COIL1) for slot X. Input voltage


(Vb_COIL1) (Vb) detected, Circuit 1. Complete circuit supervised
Contact Inputs Type 2 Board
CONT IP_X_CC11 Contact Input 11 (Va_COIL2) for slot X. Input voltage
(Va_COIL2) (Va) detected, Circuit 1. Complete circuit supervised

CONT IP_X_CC12 Contact Input 12 (Vb_COIL2) for slot X. Input voltage


(Vb_COIL2) (Vb) detected, Circuit 2. Complete circuit supervised

CONT IP_X_CC13 Contact Input 13 (07_SEAL) for slot X. Current detected.


Contact output associated with current flow > 100 mA
(O7_SEAL)
latched
Contact Input 14 (08_SEAL) for slot X. Current detected.
CONT IP_X_CC14
Contact output associated with current flow > 100 mA
(O8_SEAL)
latched
CONT IP_X_CC15 Contact Input 15 (SUP_COIL1) for slot X. Output for
(SUP_COIL1) circuit 1 supervision element

CONT IP_X_CC16 Contact Input 16 (SUP_COIL2) for slot X. Output for


(SUP_COIL2) circuit 2 supervision element

A-4 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)
CONT IP_X_CC1 Input 1 (CC1) in Board X
A
CONT IP_X_CC2 Input 2 (CC2) in Board X
Contact Inputs Type 4 Board
... ...
CONT IP_X_CC32 Input 32 (CC32) in Board X
CONT IP_X_CC1 Input 1 (CC1) in Board X
CONT IP_X_CC2 Input 2 (CC2) in Board X
Contact Inputs Type 5 Board (Digital Values)
... ...
CONT IP_X_CC16 Input 16 (CC16) in Board X
ANALOG_INP_X_01 Analog Input 01 in Board X
ANALOG_INP_X_02 Analog Input 02 in Board X
Contact Inputs Type 5 Board (Analog Values) ANALOG_INP_X_03 Analog Input 03 in Board X
... ...
ANALOG_INP_X_08 Analog Input 08 in Board X
CONT OP OPER_X_01 Logic signal for Output 1 activation. Board X
Contact Outputs Type 1 & 2 Board Activation CONT OP OPER_X_02 Logic signal for Output 2 activation. Board X
signals ... ...
CONT OP OPER_X_08 Logic signal for Output 8 activation. Board X
CONT RESET_X_01 board X, 01 latched output reset
Contact Outputs Type 1 & 2 Board Reset signals CONT RESET_X_02 board X, 02 latched output reset
... ...
CONT RESET_X_08 board X, 08 latched output reset
CONT OP_X_01 Contact output 1 Board X operation
CONT OP_X_02 Contact output 2 Board X operation
Contact Outputs Type 1 & 2 Board Status
... ...
CONT OP_X_8 Contact output 8 Board X operation
Board X status: (0) Inactive - There is no communication
Board Status BOARD X STATUS with the board (1) Active - There is communication with
the board
SWITCH 1 A INPUT Contact input type A to switchgear Function 1
SWITCH 1 B INPUT Contact input type B to switchgear Function 1
SWITCH 2 A INPUT Contact input type A to switchgear Function 2
Switchgear status (16 elements) SWITCH 2 B INPUT Contact input type B to switchgear Function 2
... ...
SWITCH 16 A INPUT Contact input type A to switchgear Function 16
SWITCH 16 B INPUT Contact input type B to switchgear Function 16

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-5


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)


SWITCH 1 A STATUS Contact logic output type A from switchgear Function 1
SWITCH 1 B STATUS Contact logic output type B from switchgear Function 1
SWITCH 2 A STATUS Contact logic output type A from switchgear Function 2
Switchgear outputs (16 elements) SWITCH 2 B STATUS Contact logic output type B from switchgear Function 2
... ...
SWITCH 16 A STATUS Contact logic output type A from switchgear Function 16
SWITCH 16 B STATUS Contact logic output type B from switchgear Function 16
SWITCH 1 OPEN switchgear 1 open
SWITCH 1 CLOSED switchgear 1 closed
SWITCH 1 00_ERROR Error 00 switchgear 1 (contact A = 0, contact B = 0)
SWITCH 1 11_ERROR Error 11 switchgear 1 (contact A = 1, contact B = 1)
SWITCH 2 OPEN Switchgear 2 open
SWITCH 2 CLOSED Switchgear 2 closed
Switchgear states (16 elements) SWITCH 2 00_ERROR Error 00 switchgear 2 (contact A = 0, contact B = 0)
SWITCH 2 11_ERROR Error 11 switchgear 2 (contact A = 1, contact B = 1)
... ...
SWITCH 16 OPEN Switchgear 16 open
SWITCH 16 CLOSED Switchgear 16 closed
SWITCH 16 00_ERROR Error 00 switchgear 16 (contact A = 0, contact B = 0)
SWITCH 16 11_ERROR Error 11 switchgear 16 (contact A = 1, contact B = 1)
SWITCH 1 OPEN INIT Switchgear 1 opening initiation
SWITCH 1 CLOSE INIT Switchgear 1 closing initiation
SWITCH 2 OPEN INIT Switchgear 2 opening initiation
Switchgear Open-Close Initializing States SWITCH 2 CLOSE INIT Switchgear 2 closing initiation
... ...
SWITCH 16 OPEN INIT Switchgear 16 opening initiation
SWITCH 16 CLOSE INIT Switchgear 16 closing initiation
SWGR 1 FAIL TO OPEN Failure to open Switchgear 1
SWGR 2 FAIL TO OPEN Failure to open Switchgear 2
... ...
SWGR 16 FAIL TO
Failure to open Switchgear 16
OPEN
Switchgear Fail States SWGR 1 FAIL TO
Failure to close Switchgear 1
CLOSE
SWGR 2 FAIL TO
Failure to close Switchgear 2
CLOSE
... ...
SWGR 16 FAIL TO
Failure to close Switchgear 16
CLOSE

A-6 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)
Ready LED: (0-Red) Relay out of service, protection
A
READY LED OUT OF ORDER (1-Green) Relay in service; protection
READY
Programmable LED 1 status: Red colour. Latched by
LED 1 hardware. Reset by hardware (ESC) and programmable
(LED RESET INPUT)
Programmable LED 2 status: Red colour. Latched by
LED 2 hardware. Reset by hardware (ESC) and programmable
(LED RESET INPUT)
Programmable LED 3 status: Red colour. Latched by
LED 3 hardware. Reset by hardware (ESC) and programmable
(LED RESET INPUT)
Programmable LED 4 status: Red colour. Latched by
LED 4 hardware. Reset by hardware (ESC) and programmable
(LED RESET INPUT)
Programmable LED 5 status: Red colour. Latched by
LED 5 hardware. Reset by hardware (ESC) and programmable
(LED RESET INPUT)

Programmable LED 6 status: Orange colour. Not


LED 6 latched. Latching possibility via PLC. Reset by hardware
(ESC) and programmable (LED RESET INPUT)

Programmable LED 7 status: Orange colour. Not


LED 7 latched. Latching possibility via PLC. Reset by hardware
(ESC) and programmable (LED RESET INPUT)

Programmable LED 8 status: Orange colour. Not


LED 8 latched. Latching possibility via PLC. Reset by hardware
LEDS HMI (16 Elements) (ESC) and programmable (LED RESET INPUT)

Programmable LED 9 status: Orange colour. Not


LED 9 latched. Latching possibility via PLC. Reset by hardware
(ESC) and programmable (LED RESET INPUT)

Programmable LED 10 status: Orange colour. Not


LED 10 latched. Latching possibility via PLC. Reset by hardware
(ESC) and programmable (LED RESET INPUT)

Programmable LED 11 status: Green colour. Not


LED 11 latched. Latching possibility via PLC. Reset by hardware
(ESC) and programmable (LED RESET INPUT)

Programmable LED 12 status: Green colour. Not


LED 12 latched. Latching possibility via PLC. Reset by hardware
(ESC) and programmable (LED RESET INPUT)

Programmable LED 13 status: Green colour. Not


LED 13 latched. Latching possibility via PLC. Reset by hardware
(ESC) and programmable (LED RESET INPUT)

Programmable LED 14 status: Green colour. Not


LED 14 latched. Latching possibility via PLC. Reset by hardware
(ESC) and programmable (LED RESET INPUT)

Programmable LED 15 status: Green colour. Not


LED 15 latched. Latching possibility via PLC. Reset by hardware
(ESC) and programmable (LED RESET INPUT)

LEDs reset input (programmable) LED RESET INPUT Programmable input for remote LED reset

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-7


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)


I Key I key operation (Programmable signal via PLC)
O Key O key operation (Programmable signal via PLC)
Programmable Keypad Status (HMI) */F3 Key */F3 key operation (Programmable signal via PLC)
F1 Key F1 key operation (Programmable signal via PLC)
F2 Key F2 key operation (Programmable signal via PLC)
Local/remote status for operations 1 = Local, 0 =
LOCAL/REMOTE Remote. Selectable through the front pushbutton
OPERATION MODE (Hardware) and also through communications
(software).
LOCAL/REMOTE Operation status LEDs Operations OFF status (1) Command execution block
(operations blocked both in local and remote
OPERATIONS
BLOCKED mode).Selectable through the front pushbutton
(Hardware) and also through communications
(software).
CHANGE LOCAL-
REMOTE Changing local-remote status by communications
LOCAL/REMOTE/OFF Selection
CHANGE OP BLOCKED Operations Block-Unblock signal

HMI BACKLIGHT ON "Switching on backlignt" signal (the display is switched


on by communications
HMI Backlight
"Switching off backlignt" signal (the display is switched
HMI BACKLIGHT OFF
off by communications

A-8 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)
Oscillography Digital channel 1 : (1) Active ; (0) Not
A
OSC DIG CHANNEL 1 Active
Oscillography Digital channel 2 : (1) Active ; (0) Not
OSC DIG CHANNEL 2
Active

OSC DIG CHANNEL 3 Oscillography Digital channel 3 : (1) Active ; (0) Not
Active
Oscillography Digital channel 4 : (1) Active ; (0) Not
OSC DIG CHANNEL 4 Active
Oscillography Digital channel 5 : (1) Active ; (0) Not
OSC DIG CHANNEL 5 Active

OSC DIG CHANNEL 6 Oscillography Digital channel 6 : (1) Active ; (0) Not
Active
Oscillography Digital channel 7 : (1) Active ; (0) Not
OSC DIG CHANNEL 7 Active
Oscillography Digital channel 8 : (1) Active ; (0) Not
OSC DIG CHANNEL 8 Active
Oscillography States OSC DIG CHANNEL 9 Oscillography Digital channel 9 : (1) Active ; (0) Not
Active
Oscillography Digital channel 10: (1) Active ; (0) Not
OSC DIG CHANNEL 10 Active

Oscillography Digital channel 11 : (1) Active ; (0) Not


OSC DIG CHANNEL 11
Active
Oscillography Digital channel 12 : (1) Active ; (0) Not
OSC DIG CHANNEL 12
Active

OSC DIG CHANNEL 13 Oscillography Digital channel 13 : (1) Active ; (0) Not
Active
Oscillography Digital channel 14 : (1) Active ; (0) Not
OSC DIG CHANNEL 14
Active
Oscillography Digital channel 15 : (1) Active ; (0) Not
OSC DIG CHANNEL 15
Active

OSC DIG CHANNEL 16 Oscillography Digital channel 16 : (1) Active ; (0) Not
Active
OSCILLO TRIGGER Oscillo trigger activation (1) Active ; (0) Not active
FAULT REPORT TRIGG Fault report trigger (1) Active ; (0) Not active
Fault Report (Fault locator) CLEAR FAULT Fault report removal from HMI and ModBus (volatile
REPORTS memory)
FREEZE ENERGY CNT Energy counter freeze
UNFREEZE ENERGY
Energy Counters Energy counter unfreeze
CNT
RESET ENERGY CNT Energy counter reset
DEMAND TRIGGER INP Demand trigger (for Block interval algorithm)
Demand Inputs
DEMAND RESET INP Demand reset

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-9


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)


GROUP 1 ACT ON Group 1 activation, and deactivation of groups 2 & 3
GROUP 2 ACT ON Group 2 activation, and deactivation of groups 1 & 3

GROUP 3 ACT ON Group 3 activation, and deactivation of groups 1 & 2


Setting Groups SETT GROUPS BLOCK Group change input blocked
GROUP 1 BLOCKED Settings Group 1 blocked

GROUP 2 BLOCKED Settings Group 2 blocked

GROUP 3 BLOCKED Settings Group 3 blocked

A-10 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)
Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Group 1
A
PH IOC1 HIGH A BLK phase A
Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Group 1
PH IOC1 HIGH B BLK
phase B

PH IOC1 HIGH C BLK Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Group 1


phase C
Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup high
PH IOC1 HIGH A PKP level Group 1 phase A

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC1 HIGH A OP (trip) high level Group 1 phase A

PH IOC1 HIGH B PKP Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup high


level Group 1 phase B

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC1 HIGH B OP
(trip) high level Group 1 phase B

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup high


PH IOC1 HIGH C PKP level Group 1 phase C

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC1 HIGH C OP
(trip) high level Group 1 phase C

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup high


PH IOC1 HIGH PKP
level Group 1 any phase

PH IOC1 HIGH OP Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


(trip) high level Group 1 any phase

PH IOC2 HIGH A BLK Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Group 2


phase A
Phase IOC High
Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Group 2
PH IOC2 HIGH B BLK
phase B
Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Group 2
PH IOC2 HIGH C BLK
phase C

PH IOC2 HIGH A PKP Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup high


level Group 2 phase A

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC2 HIGH A OP
(trip) high level Group 2 phase A

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup high


PH IOC2 HIGH B PKP
level Group 2 phase B

PH IOC2 HIGH B OP Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


(trip) high level Group 2 phase B

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup high


PH IOC2 HIGH C PKP
level Group 2 phase C

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC2 HIGH C OP
(trip) high level Group 2 phase C

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup high


PH IOC2 HIGH PKP
level Group 2 any phase

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC2 HIGH OP
(trip) high level Group 2 any phase
Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Group 3
PH IOC3 HIGH A BLK
phase A
Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Group 3
PH IOC3 HIGH B BLK phase B

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-11


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)

PH IOC3 HIGH C BLK


Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Group 3
phase C
Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup high
PH IOC3 HIGH A PKP
level Group 3 phase A

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC3 HIGH A OP
(trip) high level Group 3 phase A

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup high


PH IOC3 HIGH B PKP level Group 3 phase B

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


Phase IOC High PH IOC3 HIGH B OP (trip) high level Group 3 phase B

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup high


PH IOC3 HIGH C PKP
level Group 3 phase C

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC3 HIGH C OP
(trip) high level Group 3 phase C

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup high


PH IOC3 HIGH PKP level Group 3 any phase

PH IOC3 HIGH OP Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


(trip) high level Group 3 any phase

A-12 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Low


A
PH IOC1 LOW A BLK level Group 1 phase A

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Low


PH IOC1 LOW B BLK
level Group 1 phase B

PH IOC1 LOW C BLK Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Low


level Group 1 phase C

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup low


PH IOC1 LOW A PKP level Group 1 phase A

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC1 LOW A OP (trip) low level Group 1 phase A

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup low


PH IOC1 LOW B PKP
level Group 1 phase B

PH IOC1 LOW B OP Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


(trip) low level Group 1 phase B

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup low


PH IOC1 LOW C PKP
level Group 1 phase C

PH IOC1 LOW C OP Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


(trip) low level Group 1 phase C

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup low


PH IOC1 LOW PKP level Group 1 any phase

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC1 LOW OP
(trip) low level Group 1 any phase

Phase IOC Low PH IOC2 LOW A BLK Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Low
level Group 2 phase A

PH IOC2 LOW B BLK Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Low


level Group 2 phase B

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Low


PH IOC2 LOW C BLK
level Group 2 phase C

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup low


PH IOC2 LOW A PKP
level Group 2 phase A

PH IOC2 LOW A OP Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


(trip) low level Group 2 phase A

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup low


PH IOC2 LOW B PKP
level Group 2 phase B

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC2 LOW B OP
(trip) low level Group 2 phase B

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup low


PH IOC2 LOW C PKP
level Group 2 phase C

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC2 LOW C OP
(trip) low level Group 2 phase C

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup low


PH IOC2 LOW PKP level Group 2 any phase

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC2 LOW OP
(trip) low level Group 2 any phase

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Low


PH IOC3 LOW A BLK
level Group 3 phase A

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-13


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Low


PH IOC3 LOW B BLK level Group 3 phase B

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element block Low


PH IOC3 LOW C BLK
level Group 3 phase C

PH IOC3 LOW A PKP Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup low


level Group 3 phase A

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC3 LOW A OP (trip) low level Group 3 phase A

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup low


PH IOC3 LOW B PKP level Group 3 phase B
Phase IOC Low
Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation
PH IOC3 LOW B OP
(trip) low level Group 3 phase B

PH IOC3 LOW C PKP Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup low


level Group 3 phase C

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC3 LOW C OP
(trip) low level Group 3 phase C

PH IOC3 LOW PKP Phase instantaneous overcurrent element pickup low


level Group 3 any phase

Phase instantaneous overcurrent element operation


PH IOC3 LOW OP (trip) low level Group 3 any phase
Neutral instantaneous overcurrent element block Group
NEUTRAL IOC1 BLOCK
1

NEUTRAL IOC1 PKP Neutral instantaneous overcurrent element pickup Group


1
Neutral instantaneous overcurrent element operation
NEUTRAL IOC1 OP
(trip) Group 1
Neutral instantaneous overcurrent element block Group
NEUTRAL IOC2 BLOCK
2

Neutral IOC NEUTRAL IOC2 PKP Neutral instantaneous overcurrent element pickup Group
2
Neutral instantaneous overcurrent element operation
NEUTRAL IOC2 OP
(trip) Group 2

NEUTRAL IOC3 BLOCK Neutral instantaneous overcurrent element block Group


3
Neutral instantaneous overcurrent element pickup Group
NEUTRAL IOC3 PKP 3
Neutral instantaneous overcurrent element operation
NEUTRAL IOC3 OP
(trip) Group 3

A-14 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)
Ground instantaneous overcurrent element block Group
A
GROUND IOC1 BLOCK 1

Ground instantaneous overcurrent element pickup


GROUND IOC1 PKP
Group 1

GROUND IOC1 OP Ground instantaneous overcurrent element operation


(trip) Group 1
Ground instantaneous overcurrent element block Group
GROUND IOC2 BLOCK 2

Ground instantaneous overcurrent element pickup


Ground IOC GROUND IOC2 PKP Group 2

GROUND IOC2 OP Ground instantaneous overcurrent element operation


(trip) Group 2
Ground instantaneous overcurrent element block Group
GROUND IOC3 BLOCK 3

Ground instantaneous overcurrent element pickup


GROUND IOC3 PKP Group 3

GROUND IOC3 OP Ground instantaneous overcurrent element operation


(trip) Group 3
Sensitive ground instantaneous overcurrent element
SENS GND IOC1 BLK block Group 1
Sensitive ground instantaneous overcurrent element
SENS GND IOC1 PKP
pickup Group 1

SENS GND IOC1 OP Sensitive ground instantaneous overcurrent element


operation (trip) Group 1
Sensitive ground instantaneous overcurrent element
SENS GND IOC2 BLK block Group 2
Sensitive ground instantaneous overcurrent element
Sensitive Ground IOC SENS GND IOC2 PKP pickup Group 2

SENS GND IOC2 OP Sensitive ground instantaneous overcurrent element


operation (trip) Group 2

SENS GND IOC3 BLK Sensitive ground instantaneous overcurrent element


block Group 3
Sensitive ground instantaneous overcurrent element
SENS GND IOC3 PKP
pickup Group 3
Sensitive ground instantaneous overcurrent element
SENS GND IOC3 OP
operation (trip) Group 3

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-15


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)

ISOLATED GND1 BLK


Isolated ground instantaneous overcurrent element
block Group 1
Isolated ground instantaneous overcurrent element
ISOLATED GND1 PKP
pickup Group 1
Isolated ground instantaneous overcurrent element
ISOLATED GND1 OP
operation (trip) Group 1
Isolated ground instantaneous overcurrent element
ISOLATED GND2 BLK block Group 2
Isolated ground instantaneous overcurrent element
Isolated Ground ISOLATED GND2 PKP
pickup Group 2
Isolated ground instantaneous overcurrent element
ISOLATED GND2 OP
operation (trip) Group 2
Isolated ground instantaneous overcurrent element
ISOLATED GND3 BLK block Group 3
Isolated ground instantaneous overcurrent element
ISOLATED GND3 PKP
pickup Group 3

ISOLATED GND3 OP Isolated ground instantaneous overcurrent element


operation (trip) Group 3

A-16 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)
PH TOC1 HIGH A BLK Phase timed overcurrent element block Group 1 phase A
A
PH TOC1 HIGH B BLK Phase timed overcurrent element block Group 1 phase B
Phase timed overcurrent element block Group 1 phase
PH TOC1 HIGH C BLK C
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup Group 1 phase
PH TOC1 HIGH A PKP
A

PH TOC1 HIGH A OP Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group


1 phase A
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup Group 1 phase
PH TOC1 HIGH B PKP B
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group
PH TOC1 HIGH B OP
1 phase B

PH TOC1 HIGH C PKP Phase timed overcurrent element pickup Group 1 phase
C
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group
PH TOC1 HIGH C OP 1 phase C
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup Group 1 any
PH TOC1 HIGH PKP
phase

PH TOC1 HIGH OP Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group


1 any phase
PH TOC2 HIGH A BLK Phase timed overcurrent element block Group 2 phase A

Phase TOC High PH TOC2 HIGH B BLK Phase timed overcurrent element block Group 2 phase B

PH TOC2 HIGH C BLK Phase timed overcurrent element block Group 2 phase
C
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup Group 2 phase
PH TOC2 HIGH A PKP
A
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group
PH TOC2 HIGH A OP
2 phase A

PH TOC2 HIGH B PKP Phase timed overcurrent element pickup Group 2 phase
B
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group
PH TOC2 HIGH B OP
2 phase B
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup Group 2 phase
PH TOC2 HIGH C PKP
C

PH TOC2 HIGH C OP Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group


2 phase C
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup Group 2 any
PH TOC2 HIGH PKP
phase
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group
PH TOC2 HIGH OP
2 any phase
PH TOC3 HIGH A BLK Phase timed overcurrent element block Group 3 phase A
PH TOC3 HIGH B BLK Phase timed overcurrent element block Group 3 phase B

PH TOC3 HIGH C BLK Phase timed overcurrent element block Group 3 phase
C

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-17


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)

PH TOC3 HIGH A PKP


Phase timed overcurrent element pickup Group 3 phase
A
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group
PH TOC3 HIGH A OP
3 phase A

PH TOC3 HIGH B PKP Phase timed overcurrent element pickup Group 3 phase
B
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group
PH TOC3 HIGH B OP 3 phase B
Phase TOC High
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup Group 3 phase
PH TOC3 HIGH C PKP C

PH TOC3 HIGH C OP Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group


3 phase C
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup Group 3 any
PH TOC3 HIGH PKP phase
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group
PH TOC3 HIGH OP 3 any phase

PH TOC1 LOW A BLK Phase timed overcurrent element block Low level Group
1 phase A
Phase timed overcurrent element block Low level Group
PH TOC1 LOW B BLK 1 phase B
Phase timed overcurrent element block Low level Group
PH TOC1 LOW C BLK
1 phase C
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup low level Group
PH TOC1 LOW A PKP
1 phase A

PH TOC1 LOW A OP Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) low


level Group 1 phase A
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup low level Group
PH TOC1 LOW B PKP 1 phase B

PH TOC1 LOW B OP Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) low


level Group 1 phase B

PH TOC1 LOW C PKP Phase timed overcurrent element pickup low level Group
1 phase C
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) low
Phase TOC Low PH TOC1 LOW C OP
level Group 1 phase C
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup low level Group
PH TOC1 LOW PKP 1 any phase

PH TOC1 LOW OP Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) low


level Group 1 any phase

PH TOC2 LOW A BLK Phase timed overcurrent element block Low level Group
2 phase A
Phase timed overcurrent element block Low level Group
PH TOC2 LOW B BLK
2 phase B
Phase timed overcurrent element block Low level Group
PH TOC2 LOW C BLK
2 phase C
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup low level Group
PH TOC2 LOW A PKP
2 phase A
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) low
PH TOC2 LOW A OP
level Group 2 phase A
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup low level Group
PH TOC2 LOW B PKP
2 phase B

A-18 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)

Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) low


A
PH TOC2 LOW B OP level Group 2 phase B
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup low level Group
PH TOC2 LOW C PKP
2 phase C
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) low
PH TOC2 LOW C OP
level Group 2 phase C
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup low level Group
PH TOC2 LOW PKP 2 any phase
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) low
PH TOC2 LOW OP
level Group 2 any phase
Phase timed overcurrent element block Low level Group
PH TOC3 LOW A BLK
3 phase A
Phase timed overcurrent element block Low level Group
PH TOC3 LOW B BLK 3 phase B
Phase timed overcurrent element block Low level Group
PH TOC3 LOW C BLK 3 phase C
Phase TOC Low Phase timed overcurrent element pickup low level Group
PH TOC3 LOW A PKP
3 phase A

PH TOC3 LOW A OP Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) low


level Group 3 phase A

PH TOC3 LOW B PKP Phase timed overcurrent element pickup low level Group
3 phase B
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) low
PH TOC3 LOW B OP
level Group 3 phase B

PH TOC3 LOW C PKP Phase timed overcurrent element pickup low level Group
3 phase C
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) low
PH TOC3 LOW C OP level Group 3 phase C
Phase timed overcurrent element pickup low level Group
PH TOC3 LOW PKP
3 any phase
Phase timed overcurrent element operation (trip) low
PH TOC3 LOW OP
level Group 3 any phase
NEUTRAL TOC1
Neutral timed overcurrent element block Group 1
BLOCK
NEUTRAL TOC1 PKP Neutral timed overcurrent element pickup Group 1
Neutral timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group
NEUTRAL TOC1 OP
1
NEUTRAL TOC2
BLOCK Neutral timed overcurrent element block Group 2

Neutral TOC NEUTRAL TOC2 PKP Neutral timed overcurrent element pickup Group 2
Neutral timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group
NEUTRAL TOC2 OP
2
NEUTRAL TOC3
Neutral timed overcurrent element block Group 3
BLOCK
NEUTRAL TOC3 PKP Neutral timed overcurrent element pickup Group 3
Neutral timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group
NEUTRAL TOC3 OP
3

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-19


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)


GROUND TOC1 BLOCK Ground timed overcurrent element block Group 1
GROUND TOC1 PKP Ground timed overcurrent element pickup Group 1
Ground timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group
GROUND TOC1 OP 1
GROUND TOC2 BLOCK Ground timed overcurrent element block Group 2

Ground TOC GROUND TOC2 PKP Ground timed overcurrent element pickup Group 2
Ground timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group
GROUND TOC2 OP 2
GROUND TOC3 BLOCK Ground timed overcurrent element block Group 3
GROUND TOC3 PKP Ground timed overcurrent element pickup Group 3

GROUND TOC3 OP Ground timed overcurrent element operation (trip) Group


3
SENS GND TOC1 Sensitive ground timed overcurrent element block Group
BLOCK 1
Sensitive ground timed overcurrent element pickup
SENS GND TOC1 PKP
Group 1

SENS GND TOC1 OP Sensitive ground timed overcurrent element operation


(trip) Group 1
SENS GND TOC2 Sensitive ground timed overcurrent element block Group
BLOCK 2
Sensitive ground timed overcurrent element pickup
Sensitive Ground TOC SENS GND TOC2 PKP
Group 2
Sensitive ground timed overcurrent element operation
SENS GND TOC2 OP
(trip) Group 2
SENS GND TOC3 Sensitive ground timed overcurrent element block Group
BLOCK 3
Sensitive ground timed overcurrent element pickup
SENS GND TOC3 PKP
Group 3
Sensitive ground timed overcurrent element operation
SENS GND TOC3 OP
(trip) Group 3

NEG SEQ TOC1 BLOCK Negative sequence timed overcurrent element block
Group 1
Negative sequence timed overcurrent element pickup
NEG SEQ TOC1 PKP
Group 1
Negative sequence timed overcurrent element operation
NEG SEQ TOC1 OP
Group 1

NEG SEQ TOC2 BLOCK Negative sequence timed overcurrent element block
Group 2
Negative sequence timed overcurrent element pickup
Negative Sequence TOC NEG SEQ TOC2 PKP
Group 2
Negative sequence timed overcurrent element operation
NEG SEQ TOC2 OP
Group 2

NEG SEQ TOC3 BLOCK Negative sequence timed overcurrent element block
Group 3
Negative sequence timed overcurrent element pickup
NEG SEQ TOC3 PKP
Group 3
Negative sequence timed overcurrent element operation
NEG SEQ TOC3 OP
Group 3

A-20 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)
THERMAL1 BLOCK Thermal image block Group 1
A
THERMAL1 A RST Thermal image phase A Group 1 element reset
THERMAL1 B RST Thermal image phase B Group 1 element reset
THERMAL1 C RST Thermal image phase C Group 1 element reset
THERMAL1 ALARM Thermal image element alarm any phase Group 1
THERMAL1 OP Thermal image element operation any phase Group 1
THERMAL1 A ALRM Thermal image element alarm phase A Group 1
THERMAL1 A OP Thermal image element operation phase A Group 1
THERMAL1 B ALRM Thermal image element alarm phase B Group 1
THERMAL1 B OP Thermal image element operation phase B Group 1
THERMAL1 C ALRM Thermal image element alarm phase C Group 1
THERMAL1 C OP Thermal image element operation phase C Group 1
THERMAL2 BLOCK Thermal image block Group 2
THERMAL2 A RST Thermal image phase A Group 2 element reset
THERMAL2 B RST Thermal image phase B Group 2 element reset
THERMAL2 C RST Thermal image phase C Group 2 element reset
THERMAL2 ALARM Thermal image element alarm any phase Group 2
THERMAL2 OP Thermal image element operation any phase Group 2
Thermal Image
THERMAL2 A ALRM Thermal image element alarm phase A Group 2
THERMAL2 A OP Thermal image element operation phase A Group 2
THERMAL2 B ALRM Thermal image element alarm phase B Group 2
THERMAL2 B OP Thermal image element operation phase B Group 2
THERMAL2 C ALRM Thermal image element alarm phase C Group 2
THERMAL2 C OP Thermal image element operation phase C Group 2
THERMAL3 BLOCK Thermal image block Group 3
THERMAL3 A RST Thermal image phase A Group 3 element reset
THERMAL3 B RST Thermal image phase B Group 3 element reset
THERMAL3 C RST Thermal image phase C Group 3 element reset
THERMAL3 ALARM Thermal image element alarm any phase Group 3
THERMAL3 OP Thermal image element operation any phase Group 3
THERMAL3 A ALRM Thermal image element alarm phase A Group 3
THERMAL3 A OP Thermal image element operation phase A Group 3
THERMAL3 B ALRM Thermal image element alarm phase B Group 3
THERMAL3 B OP Thermal image element operation phase B Group 3
THERMAL3 C ALRM Thermal image element alarm phase C Group 3
THERMAL3 C OP Thermal image element operation phase C Group 3

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-21


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)


PHASE DIR1 BLK INP Phase directional block Group 1
PHASE DIR1 BLOCK A Phase directional element block Group 1 Phase A
PHASE DIR1 A OP Phase directional element operation Group 1 Phase A
PHASE DIR1 BLOCK B Phase directional element block Group 1 Phase B
PHASE DIR1 B OP Phase directional element operation Group 1 Phase B
PHASE DIR1 BLOCK C Phase directional element block Group 1 Phase C
PHASE DIR1 C OP Phase directional element operation Group 1 Phase C
PHASE DIR2 BLK INP Phase directional block Group 2
PHASE DIR2 BLOCK A Phase directional element block Group 2 Phase A
PHASE DIR2 A OP Phase directional element operation Group 2 Phase A
Phase Directional PHASE DIR2 BLOCK B Phase directional element block Group 2 Phase B
PHASE DIR2 B OP Phase directional element operation Group 2 Phase B
PHASE DIR2 BLOCK C Phase directional element block Group 2 Phase C
PHASE DIR2 C OP Phase directional element operation Group 2 Phase C
PHASE DIR3 BLK INP Phase directional block Group 3
PHASE DIR3 BLOCK A Phase directional element block Group 3 Phase A
PHASE DIR3 A OP Phase directional element operation Group 3 Phase A
PHASE DIR3 BLOCK B Phase directional element block Group 3 Phase B
PHASE DIR3 B OP Phase directional element operation Group 3 Phase B
PHASE DIR3 BLOCK C Phase directional element block Group 3 Phase C
PHASE DIR3 C OP Phase directional element operation Group 3 Phase C
NEUTRAL DIR1 BLK
Neutral directional element block input signal Group 1
INP
NEUTRAL DIR1 BLOCK Neutral directional element blocked Group 1
NEUTRAL DIR1 OP Neutral directional element operation Group 1
NEUTRAL DIR2 BLK Neutral directional element block input signal Group 2
INP
Neutral Directional NEUTRAL DIR2 BLOCK Neutral directional element blocked Group 2
NEUTRAL DIR2 OP Neutral directional element operation Group 2
NEUTRAL DIR3 BLK
Neutral directional element block input signal Group 3
INP
NEUTRAL DIR3 BLOCK Neutral directional element blocked Group 3
NEUTRAL DIR3 OP Neutral directional element operation Group 3

A-22 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)
GROUND DIR1 BLK INP Ground directional element block input signal Group 1
A
GROUND DIR1 BLOCK Ground directional element blocked Group 1
GROUND DIR1 OP Ground directional element operation Group 1
GROUND DIR2 BLK INP Ground directional element block input signal Group 2
Ground Directional GROUND DIR2 BLOCK Ground directional element blocked Group 2
GROUND DIR2 OP Ground directional element operation Group 2
GROUND DIR3 BLK INP Ground directional element block input signal Group 3
GROUND DIR3 BLOCK Ground directional element blocked Group 3
GROUND DIR3 OP Ground directional element operation Group 3
SENS GND DIR1 BLK IP Sensitive ground directional element block input Group 1
SENS GND DIR1
BLOCK Sensitive Ground directional element block Group 1

SENS GND DIR1 OP Sensitive Ground directional element operation Group 1


SENS GND DIR2 BLK IP Sensitive ground directional element block input Group 2
SENS GND DIR2
Sensitive Ground Directional Sensitive Ground directional element block Group 2
BLOCK
SENS GND DIR2 OP Sensitive Ground directional element operation Group 2
SENS GND DIR3 BLK IP Sensitive ground directional element block input Group 3
SENS GND DIR3
Sensitive Ground directional element block Group 3
BLOCK
SENS GND DIR3 OP Sensitive Ground directional element operation Group 3
Fuse failure VT FUSE FAILURE Fuse failure operation
PHASE UV1 BLOCK Phase undervoltage element block Group 1
PHASE UV1 A PKP Undervoltage element pickup AG Group 1
PHASE UV1 A OP Undervoltage element operation AG Group 1
PHASE UV1 B PKP Undervoltage element pickup BG Group 1
PHASE UV1 B OP Undervoltage element operation BG Group 1
PHASE UV1 C PKP Undervoltage element pickup CG Group 1
Phase UV
PHASE UV1 C OP Undervoltage element operation CG Group 1
PHASE UV1 AB PKP Undervoltage element pickup AB Group 1
PHASE UV1 AB OP Undervoltage element operation AB Group 1
PHASE UV1 BC PKP Undervoltage element pickup BC Group 1
PHASE UV1 BC OP Undervoltage element operation BC Group 1
PHASE UV1 CA PKP Undervoltage element pickup CA Group 1

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-23


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)


PHASE UV1 CA OP Undervoltage element operation CA Group 1
PHASE UV1 PKP Pickup of any of the above mentioned elements
PHASE UV1 OP Operation of any of the above mentioned elements
PHASE UV2 BLOCK Phase undervoltage element block Group 2
PHASE UV2 A PKP Undervoltage element pickup AG Group 2
PHASE UV2 A OP Undervoltage element operation AG Group 2
PHASE UV2 B PKP Undervoltage element pickup BG Group 2
PHASE UV2 B OP Undervoltage element operation BG Group 2
PHASE UV2 C PKP Undervoltage element pickup CG Group 2
PHASE UV2 C OP Undervoltage element operation CG Group 2
PHASE UV2 AB PKP Undervoltage element pickup AB Group 2
PHASE UV2 AB OP Undervoltage element operation AB Group 2
PHASE UV2 BC PKP Undervoltage element pickup BC Group 2
PHASE UV2 BC OP Undervoltage element operation BC Group 2
PHASE UV2 CA PKP Undervoltage element pickup CA Group 2
PHASE UV2 CA OP Undervoltage element operation CA Group 2
Phase UV PHASE UV2 PKP Pickup of any of the above mentioned elements
PHASE UV2 OP Operation of any of the above mentioned elements
PHASE UV3 BLOCK Phase undervoltage element block Group 3
PHASE UV3 A PKP Undervoltage element pickup AG Group 3
PHASE UV3 A OP Undervoltage element operation AG Group 3
PHASE UV3 B PKP Undervoltage element pickup BG Group 3
PHASE UV3 B OP Undervoltage element operation BG Group 3
PHASE UV3 C PKP Undervoltage element pickup CG Group 3
PHASE UV3 C OP Undervoltage element operation CG Group 3
PHASE UV3 AB PKP Undervoltage element pickup AB Group 3
PHASE UV3 AB OP Undervoltage element operation AB Group 3
PHASE UV3 BC PKP Undervoltage element pickup BC Group 3
PHASE UV3 BC OP Undervoltage element operation BC Group 3
PHASE UV3 CA PKP Undervoltage element pickup CA Group 3
PHASE UV3 CA OP Undervoltage element operation CA Group 3
PHASE UV3 PKP Pickup of any of the above mentioned elements
PHASE UV3 OP Operation of any of the above mentioned elements

A-24 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)
PHASE OV1 BLOCK Phase overvoltage element block Group 1
A
PHASE OV1 AB PKP Overvoltage element pickup AB Group 1
PHASE OV1 AB OP Overvoltage element operation AB Group 1
PHASE OV1 BC PKP Overvoltage element pickup BC Group 1
PHASE OV1 BC OP Overvoltage element operation BC Group 1
PHASE OV1 CA PKP Overvoltage element pickup CA Group 1
PHASE OV1 CA OP Overvoltage element operation CA Group 1
PHASE OV1 PKP Pickup of any of the above mentioned elements
PHASE OV1 OP Operation of any of the above mentioned elements
PHASE OV2 BLOCK Phase overvoltage element block Group 2
PHASE OV2 AB PKP Overvoltage element pickup AB Group 2
PHASE OV2 AB OP Overvoltage element operation AB Group 2
PHASE OV2 BC PKP Overvoltage element pickup BC Group 2
Phase OV PHASE OV2 BC OP Overvoltage element operation BC Group 2
PHASE OV2 CA PKP Overvoltage element pickup CA Group 2
PHASE OV2 CA OP Overvoltage element operation CA Group 2
PHASE OV2 PKP Pickup of any of the above mentioned elements
PHASE OV2 OP Operation of any of the above mentioned elements
PHASE OV3 BLOCK Phase overvoltage element block Group 3
PHASE OV3 AB PKP Overvoltage element pickup AB Group 3
PHASE OV3 AB OP Overvoltage element operation AB Group 3
PHASE OV3 BC PKP Overvoltage element pickup BC Group 3
PHASE OV3 BC OP Overvoltage element operation BC Group 3
PHASE OV3 CA PKP Overvoltage element pickup CA Group 3
PHASE OV3 CA OP Overvoltage element operation CA Group 3
PHASE OV3 PKP Pickup of any of the above mentioned elements
PHASE OV3 OP Operation of any of the above mentioned elements

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-25


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)


NEUTRAL OV1 HIGH
Neutral overvoltage element block high level Group 1
BLK
NEUTRAL OV1 HIGH
Neutral overvoltage element pickup high level Group 1
PKP
NEUTRAL OV1 HIGH Neutral overvoltage element operation high level Group
OP 1
NEUTRAL OV2 HIGH
BLK Neutral overvoltage element block high level Group 2

NEUTRAL OV2 HIGH


Neutral OV High PKP Neutral overvoltage element pickup high level Group 2

NEUTRAL OV2 HIGH Neutral overvoltage element operation high level Group
OP 2
NEUTRAL OV3 HIGH
BLK Neutral overvoltage element block high level Group 3

NEUTRAL OV3 HIGH


PKP Neutral overvoltage element pickup high level Group 3

NEUTRAL OV3 HIGH Neutral overvoltage element operation high level Group
OP 3
NEUTRAL OV1 LOW
BLK Neutral overvoltage element block low level Group 1

NEUTRAL OV1 LOW


Neutral overvoltage element pickup low level Group 1
PKP
NEUTRAL OV1 LOW
Neutral overvoltage element operation low level Group 1
OP
NEUTRAL OV2 LOW Neutral overvoltage element block low level Group 2
BLK
NEUTRAL OV2 LOW
Neutral OV Low Neutral overvoltage element pickup low level Group 2
PKP
NEUTRAL OV2 LOW
Neutral overvoltage element operation low level Group 2
OP
NEUTRAL OV3 LOW Neutral overvoltage element block low level Group 3
BLK
NEUTRAL OV3 LOW
Neutral overvoltage element pickup low level Group 3
PKP
NEUTRAL OV3 LOW
Neutral overvoltage element operation low level Group 3
OP
AUXILIARY UV1 BLOCK Auxiliary undervoltage element block Group 1
AUXILIARY UV1 PKP Auxiliary undervoltage element pickup Group 1
AUXILIARY UV1 OP Auxiliary undervoltage element operation Group 1
AUXILIARY UV2 BLOCK Auxiliary undervoltage element block Group 2
Auxiliary UV AUXILIARY UV2 PKP Auxiliary undervoltage element pickup Group 2
AUXILIARY UV2 OP Auxiliary undervoltage element operation Group 2
AUXILIARY UV3 BLOCK Auxiliary undervoltage element block Group 3
AUXILIARY UV3 PKP Auxiliary undervoltage element pickup Group 3
AUXILIARY UV3 OP Auxiliary undervoltage element operation Group 3

A-26 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)
AUXILIARY OV1 BLOCK Auxiliary overvoltage element block Group 1
A
AUXILIARY OV1 PKP Auxiliary Overvoltage element pickup Group 1
AUXILIARY OV1 OP Auxiliary overvoltage element operation Group 1
AUXILIARY OV2 BLOCK Auxiliary overvoltage element block Group 2
Auxiliary OV AUXILIARY OV2 PKP Auxiliary Overvoltage element pickup Group 2
AUXILIARY OV2 OP Auxiliary overvoltage element operation Group 2
AUXILIARY OV3 BLOCK Auxiliary overvoltage element block Group 3
AUXILIARY OV3 PKP Auxiliary Overvoltage element pickup Group 3
AUXILIARY OV3 OP Auxiliary overvoltage element operation Group 3
NEG SEQ OV1 BLOCK Negative sequence overvoltage element block Group 1
NEG SEQ OV1 PKP Negative sequence overvoltage element pickup Group 1

NEG SEQ OV1 OP Negative sequence overvoltage element operation


Group 1
NEG SEQ OV2 BLOCK Negative sequence overvoltage element block Group 2

Negative Sequence OV NEG SEQ OV2 PKP Negative sequence overvoltage element pickup Group 2
Negative sequence overvoltage element operation
NEG SEQ OV2 OP Group 2
NEG SEQ OV3 BLOCK Negative sequence overvoltage element block Group 3
NEG SEQ OV3 PKP Negative sequence overvoltage element pickup Group 3
Negative sequence overvoltage element operation
NEG SEQ OV3 OP
Group 3
OVERFREQ1 BLOCK Overfrequency element block Group 1
OVERFREQ1 PKP Overfrequency element pickup Group 1
OVERFREQ1 OP Overfrequency element operation Group 1
OVERFREQ2 BLOCK Overfrequency element block Group 2
Overfrequency OVERFREQ2 PKP Overfrequency element pickup Group 2
OVERFREQ2 OP Overfrequency element operation Group 2
OVERFREQ3 BLOCK Overfrequency element block Group 3
OVERFREQ3 PKP Overfrequency element pickup Group 3
OVERFREQ3 OP Overfrequency element operation Group 3

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-27


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)


UNDERFREQ1 BLOCK Underfrequency element block Group 1
UNDERFREQ1 PKP Underfrequency element pickup Group 1
UNDERFREQ1 OP Underfrequency element operation Group 1
UNDERFREQ2 BLOCK Underfrequency element block Group 2
Underfrequency UNDERFREQ2 PKP Underfrequency element pickup Group 2
UNDERFREQ2 OP Underfrequency element operation Group 2
UNDERFREQ3 BLOCK Underfrequency element block Group 3
UNDERFREQ3 PKP Underfrequency element pickup Group 3
UNDERFREQ3 OP Underfrequency element operation Group 3
FREQ RATE1 BLOCK Frequency rate of change element block Group 1
FREQ RATE1 PKP Frequency rate of change element pickup Group 1
FREQ RATE1 OP Frequency rate of change element operation Group 1
FREQ RATE2 BLOCK Frequency rate of change element block Group 2
Frequency rate of change FREQ RATE2 PKP Frequency rate of change element pickup Group 2
FREQ RATE2 OP Frequency rate of change element operation Group 2
FREQ RATE3 BLOCK Frequency rate of change element block Group 3
FREQ RATE3 PKP Frequency rate of change element pickup Group 3
FREQ RATE3 OP Frequency rate of change element operation Group 3
BROKEN CONDUCT1 Broken conductor block Group 1
BLK
BROKEN CONDUCT1
Broken conductor element Pickup Group 1
PKP
BROKEN CONDUCT1
Broken conductor element operation Group 1
OP
BROKEN CONDUCT2 Broken conductor block Group 2
BLK
BROKEN CONDUCT2
Broken Conductor Broken conductor element Pickup Group 2
PKP
BROKEN CONDUCT2
Broken conductor element operation Group 2
OP
BROKEN CONDUCT3 Broken conductor block Group 3
BLK
BROKEN CONDUCT3
Broken conductor element Pickup Group 3
PKP
BROKEN CONDUCT3
Broken conductor element operation Group 3
OP

A-28 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)
FWD PWR1 BLOCK Forward power element block Group 1
A
FWD PWR1 STG1 PKP Forward Power element pickup level 1 Group 1
FWD PWR1 STG1 OP Forward Power element operation level 1 Group 1
FWD PWR1 STG2 PKP Forward Power element pickup level 2 Group 1
FWD PWR1 STG2 OP Forward Power element operation level 2 Group 1
FWD PWR2 BLOCK Forward power element block Group 2
FWD PWR2 STG1 PKP Forward Power element pickup level 1 Group 2
Forward Power (32FP) FWD PWR2 STG1 OP Forward Power element operation level 1 Group 2
FWD PWR2 STG2 PKP Forward Power element pickup level 2 Group 2
FWD PWR2 STG2 OP Forward Power element operation level 2 Group 2
FWD PWR3 BLOCK Forward power element block Group 3
FWD PWR3 STG1 PKP Forward Power element pickup level 1 Group 3
FWD PWR3 STG1 OP Forward Power element operation level 1 Group 3
FWD PWR3 STG2 PKP Forward Power element pickup level 2 Group 3
FWD PWR3 STG2 OP Forward Power element operation level 2 Group 3
KI2t PHASE A ALARM K·I2t phase A Alarm
KI2t PHASE B ALARM K·I2t phase B Alarm
KI2t PHASE C ALARM K·I2t phase C Alarm
BKR OPENINGS
Breaker Maintenance Maximum Breaker openings alarm
ALARM
BKR OPEN 1 HOUR Maximum Breaker openings in one hour alarm
ALRM
RESET KI2t
COUNTERS KI2t Breaker ageing counter reset
RESET BKR
Breaker openings and closings counters reset
COUNTERS
BREAKER OPEN Breaker Opened
Breaker Status BREAKER CLOSED Breaker closed
BREAKER UNDEFINED Breaker undefined (52a and 52b have the same status)
BKR FAIL INITIATE Breaker failure initiation
BKR FAIL NO
CURRENT Breaker failure without current

BKR FAIL
Breaker failure 1st level (supervision – retrip)
SUPERVISION
Breaker Failure
BKR FAIL HISET Breaker failure 2nd level (high level)
BKR FAIL LOWSET Breaker failure 3rd level (low level)
INTERNAL ARC Internal arc
BKR FAIL 2nd STEP Breaker failure second step

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-29


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)


Synchrocheck BLK INP Synchronism element block

Synchrocheck OP Synchronsim condition (Dv, Dj and Df are within the set


range)
Closing permission for the synchronism element:
SYNCHK CLOSE PERM (SYNCHK OP) OR (SYNCHK CON OP)

Synchrocheck COND Active if when it is set, any of the three following


OP conditions is met:
Synchrocheck DL-DB OPERATION Dead line – dead bus condition
DL-LB OPERATION Dead line – live bus condition
LL-DB OPERATION Live line – dead bus condition
SLIP CONDITION Slip conditions are met
BUS FREQ > LINE
Bus Frequency higher than line frequency
FREQ
BUS FREQ < LINE
FREQ Bus Frequency lower than line frequency

AR LEVEL BLOCK Recloser element block by level


AR PULSE BLOCK Recloser element block by pulse
AR PULSE UNBLOCK Recloser element unblock by pulse
AR INITIATE Reclose initiate

AR CONDS INPUT Reclose permission condition in input to Function 1 =


there are conditions

AR CLOSE BREAKER Closing permission for the recloser


AR OUT OF SERVICE Recloser out of service
AR READY Recloser READY
AR LOCKOUT Recloser in LOCKOUT
AR BLOCK Recloser BLOCKed
AR RCL IN PROGRESS Recloser – Cycle in progress
Autorecloser Recloser – LOCKOUT by anomaly (reclosing command
AR LCK BY ANOMALY during cycle in progress)

AR LCK BY FAIL OPEN Recloser – LOCKOUT by failure to open


AR LCK BY FAIL CLOSE Recloser – LOCKOUT by failure to close

AR LCK BY USER Recloser – LOCKOUT by external operation (e.g.:


manual opening with cycle in progress)

AR LCK BY CONDS Recloser – LOCKOUT by lack of reclosing conditions


AR LCK BY TRIPS Recloser – LOCKOUT by number of trips
AR LCK BY SHOTS Recloser – LOCKOUT by number of shots
AR BLK AFTER 1 SHOT Recloser – Block after first shot
AR BLK AFTER 2 SHOT Recloser – Block after second shot
AR BLK AFTER 3 SHOT Recloser – Block after third shot
AR BLK AFTER 4 SHOT Recloser – Block after fourth shot

A-30 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)
AR BLOCK BY LEVEL Recloser – Block by level
A
Autorecloser
AR BLOCK BY PULSE Recloser – Block by command (pulse)
Default Channel (not used) Default Channel Channel not used
DIR PWR1 BLOCK Directional power element block Group 1
DIR PWR1 STG1 PKP Directional Power element pickup level 1 Group 1
DIR PWR1 STG1 OP Directional Power element operation level 1 Group 1
DIR PWR1 STG2 PKP Directional Power element pickup level 2 Group 1
DIR PWR1 STG2 OP Directional Power element operation level 2 Group 1
DIR PWR1 STG PKP Directional power element pickup Group 1
DIR PWR1 STG OP Directional Power element operation Group 1
DIR PWR2 BLOCK Directional power element block Group 2
DIR PWR2 STG1 PKP Directional Power element pickup level 1 Group 2
DIR PWR2 STG1 OP Directional Power element operation level 1 Group 2
Directional Power DIR PWR2 STG2 PKP Directional Power element pickup level 2 Group 2
DIR PWR2 STG2 OP Directional Power element operation level 2 Group 2
DIR PWR2 STG PKP Directional power element pickup Group 2
DIR PWR2 STG OP Directional Power element operation Group 2
DIR PWR3 BLOCK Directional power element block Group 3
DIR PWR3 STG1 PKP Directional Power element pickup level 1 Group 3
DIR PWR3 STG1 OP Directional Power element operation level 1 Group 3
DIR PWR3 STG2 PKP Directional Power element pickup level 2 Group 3
DIR PWR3 STG2 OP Directional Power element operation level 2 Group 3
DIR PWR3 STG PKP Directional power element pickup Group 3
DIR PWR3 STG OP Directional Power element operation Group 3
LOCKED ROTOR1 BLK Locked rotor element block Group 1
LOCKED ROTOR1 PKP Locked rotor element pickup Group 1
LOCKED ROTOR1 OP Locked rotor element operation Group 1
LOCKED ROTOR2 BLK Locked rotor element block Group 2
Locked Rotor LOCKED ROTOR2 PKP Locked rotor element pickup Group 2
LOCKED ROTOR2 OP Locked rotor element operation Group 2
LOCKED ROTOR3 BLK Locked rotor element block Group 3
LOCKED ROTOR3 PKP Locked rotor element pickup Group 3
LOCKED ROTOR3 OP Locked rotor element operation Group 3

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-31


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)


PulseCntr Value 1 Pulse counter element value Group 1
PulseCntr Value 2 Pulse counter element value Group 2
... ...
PulseCntr Value 8 Pulse counter element value Group 8
Pulse Counters
PulseCntr Freeze 1 Pulse counter element freeze value Group 1
PulseCntr Freeze 2 Pulse counter element freeze value Group 2
... ...
PulseCntr Freeze 8 Pulse counter element freeze value Group 8
Analog Level 01 Analog comparator element level Group 1
Analog Level 02 Analog comparator element level Group 2
Analog comparators
... ...
Analog Level 20 Analog comparator element level Group 20
LOAD ENCR1 BLK Load Encroachment element block Group 1
LOAD ENCR1 PKP Load Encroachment element pickup Group 1
LOAD ENCR1 OP Load Encroachment element operation Group 1
LOAD ENCR2 BLK Load Encroachment element block Group 2
Load Encroachment LOAD ENCR2 PKP Load Encroachment element pickup Group 2
LOAD ENCR2 OP Load Encroachment element operation Group 2
LOAD ENCR3 BLK Load Encroachment element block Group 3
LOAD ENCR3 PKP Load Encroachment element pickup Group 3
LOAD ENCR3 OP Load Encroachment element operation Group 3

A-32 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)
32N1 HIGH BLOCK wattmetric Ground Fault Element Block High Level
A
Group 1
32N1 HIGH PKP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Global Pickup (current,
voltage and power) High Level Group 1
32N1 HIGH OC PKP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Overcurrent Pickup
High Level Group 1
32N1 HIGH OP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Operation High Level
Group 1
32N2 HIGH BLOCK wattmetric Ground Fault Element Block High Level
Group 2
32N2 HIGH PKP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Global Pickup (current,
voltage and power) High Level Group 2
wattmetric Ground Fault High (Logic Operands)
32N2 HIGH OC PKP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Overcurrent Pickup
High Level Group 2
32N2 HIGH OP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Operation High Level
Group 2
32N3 HIGH BLOCK wattmetric Ground Fault Element Block High Level
Group 3
32N3 HIGH PKP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Global Pickup (current,
voltage and power) High Level Group 3
32N3 HIGH OC PKP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Overcurrent Pickup
High Level Group 3
32N3 HIGH OP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Operation High Level
Group 3
32N1 HIGH POWER wattmetric Ground Fault Element High Level Group 1
Power Value (watts)
wattmetric Ground Fault High (Power 32N2 HIGH POWER wattmetric Ground Fault Element High Level Group 2
Measurements) Power Value (watts)
32N3 HIGH POWER wattmetric Ground Fault Element High Level Group 3
Power Value (watts)

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-33


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX

A INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)


32N1 LOW BLOCK wattmetric Ground Fault Element Block Low Level
Group 1
32N1 LOW PKP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Global Pickup (current,
voltage and power) Low Level Group 1
32N1 LOW OC PKP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Overcurrent Pickup
Low Level Group 1
32N1 LOW OP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Operation Low Level
Group 1
32N2 LOW BLOCK wattmetric Ground Fault Element Block Low Level
Group 2
32N2 LOW PKP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Global Pickup (current,
voltage and power) Low Level Group 2
wattmetric Ground Fault Low (Logic Operands)
32N2 LOW OC PKP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Overcurrent Pickup
Low Level Group 2
32N2 LOW OP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Operation Low Level
Group 2
32N3 LOW BLOCK wattmetric Ground Fault Element Block Low Level
Group 3
32N3 LOW PKP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Global Pickup (current,
voltage and power) Low Level Group 3
32N3 LOW OC PKP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Overcurrent Pickup
Low Level Group 3
32N3 LOW OP wattmetric Ground Fault Element Operation Low Level
Group 3
32N1 LOW POWER wattmetric Ground Fault Element Low Level Group 1
Power Value (watts)
wattmetric Ground Fault Low (Power 32N2 LOW POWER wattmetric Ground Fault Element Low Level Group 2
Measurements) Power Value (watts)
32N3 LOW POWER wattmetric Ground Fault Element Low Level Group 3
Power Value (watts)

A-34 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX A A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS

OPERANDS - F650 - MODEL FX - GX


INTERNAL SYSTEM STATUS (CONT.)
1 output on. Remote Output DNA 1 Operation (GSSE/
A
DNA 1 GOOSE)
1 output on. Remote Output DNA 2 Operation (GSSE/
DNA 2
GOOSE)
... ...
1 output on. Remote Output DNA 32 Operation (GSSE/
DNA 32
GOOSE)

User St 1 1 output on. Remote Output UserSt 1 Operation (GSSE/


GOOSE)
1 output on. Remote Output UserSt 2 Operation (GSSE/
User St 2 GOOSE)
Remote Outputs
... ...

User St 64 1 output on. Remote Output UserSt 64 Operation


(GSSE/GOOSE)
1 output on. Remote Output GOOSE 1 Operation
Rem GOOSE Dig Out 1 (GOOSE)
1 output on. Remote Output GOOSE 2 Operation
Rem GOOSE Dig Out 2
(GOOSE)
... ...
1 output on. Remote Output GOOSE 32 Operation
Rem GOOSE Dig Out 32
(GOOSE)
Remote Input 1 Flag is set, logic =1
Remote Input 2 Flag is set, logic =1
Remote Inputs
... ...
Remote Input 32 Flag is set, logic =1
Remote Device 1 Flag is set, logic =1
Remote Device 2 Flag is set, logic =1
Remote Devices
... ...
Remote Device 16 Flag is set, logic =1
Rem GOOSE Dig Input 1 Flag is set, logic = 1
Rem GOOSE Dig Input 2 Flag is set, logic =1
GOOSE DIG INPUTS ... ...
Rem GOOSE Dig Input Flag is set, logic =1
32
Rem Ana Inp FLOAT 1 Analog Input 1 (Float type)
Rem Ana Inp FLOAT 2 Analog Input 2 (Float type)
... ...
Rem Ana Inp FLOAT 8 Analog Input 8 (Float type)
GOOSE Analog Inputs (FLOAT AND INTEGER)
Rem Ana Inp INT 1 Analog Input 1 (Integer type)
Rem Ana Inp INT 2 Analog Input 2 (Integer type)
... ...
Rem Ana Inp INT 8 Analog Input 8 (Integer type)

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller A-35


A.1 LOGIC OPERANDS APPENDIX A

A-36 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX B B.1 PRP AND HSR ETHERNET PROTOCOLS

APPENDIX B REDUNDANCY PROTOCOLSB.1 PRP AND HSR ETHERNET PROTOCOLS


Industrial real-time Ethernets typically demand much higher availability and uninterrupted operation than office Ethernet
solutions can provide. Even a short loss of connectivity can result in loss of functionality, as for example in some
automation, vehicular, power generation, and power distribution systems.

To recover from a network failure, different standard redundancy schemes are applied such as Parallel Redundancy
Protocol (PRP), High-availability Seamless Redundancy (HSR) and others.

The basic concept of both protocols, PRP and HSR, is to send practically identical frames over different paths and discard
one of the copies in reception, at best. If an error occurs or one of the paths is down, the frame travelling through that path
will not reach its destination, but its copy will.

If the node to be attached to a redundant network has not the capability to do it (e.g. has only one p ort), it could be
connected through a Redundancy Box (RedBox). This type of node allows single attached nodes connect transparently to
a redundant network. An example can be seen in Figures 1.

PRP operates on two independent networks. Each frame is replicated on the sending node and transmitted over both
networks. The receiving node processes the frame arriving first and discards the subsequent copy. The PRP layer is
responsible for this replicate/discard function and hides the two networks from the upper layers. This scheme works without
explicit reconfiguration and switchover and therefore does not show a period of unavailability.

Figure B–1: EXAMPLE OF PRP WITH TWO LANS (LAN A AND LAN B)

The two LANs, named LAN_A and LAN_B, are identical in protocol at the MAC level, but they can differ in performance and
topology. Transmission delays can also be different. The LANs have no direct connection among them and they are
assumed to be fail independent.
In some applications, only availability-critical nodes need a double attachment, while others do not. In order to meet the
specific requirements, PRP defines different kinds of end nodes.
• The Dual Attached Node (DAN) is connected to both LANs.
• Uncritical nodes can be attached to only one LAN and are therefore called Single Attached Nodes (SAN). SANs that
need to communicate with each other are on the same LAN.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller B-1


B.1 PRP AND HSR ETHERNET PROTOCOLS APPENDIX B

• The Redundancy Box (RedBox) is used when a single interface node has to be attached to both networks. Such a
node can communicate with all other nodes. Since a node behind a RedBox appears for other nodes like a DAN, it is
called Virtual DANs (VDAN). The RedBox itself is a DAN and acts as a proxy on behalf of its VDANs. The RedBox has
its own IP address for management purposes
Similarly to PRP, HSR is based in the duplication of every frame sent, but in a ring topology. Each copy of the frame is
injected in a different direction of the ring. If any of the links between nodes is down, all nodes are still reachable. This
topology forces every node in the net to be HSR aware because they have to forward every message until it reaches its
destination. With that purpose, the redundancy information is located at the beginning of the frame allowing a faster
forwarding, see next figure.

Figure B–2: EXAMPLE OF HSR WITH HSR RING

B
Definitions:
• PRP – Parallel Redundancy Protocol - redundancy protocol for high availability in substation automation networks
based on IEC 62439-3 Clause 4 and applicable to networks based on Ethernet technology (ISO/IEC 8802-3).
• OSI - Open Systems Interconnection - model defined by the International Organization for Standardization (ISO) for
standardizing the functions of a communication system in terms of abstraction layers. Similar communication functions
are grouped into logical layers. A layer serves the layer above it and is served by the layer below it. There are 7 layers:
physical, data link, network, transport, session, presentation, application.
• DANP – Doubly Attached Node running PRP – a node that has two ports which operate in parallel and are attached to
the upper layers of the OSI communications stack through a Link Redundancy Entity module.
• DANH – Doubly Attached Node with HSR protocol.
• LRE - Link Redundancy Entity – module operating at the link layer of the OSI stack and responsible for handling
duplicates and managing redundancy.
• SAN – Singly Attached Node – regular nodes with non-redundant network adapters
• RedBox – device attaching singly attached nodes (SANs) to a redundant network.

B-2 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX B B.1 PRP AND HSR ETHERNET PROTOCOLS

• RCT – Redundancy Check Trailer – PRP trailer added to frames and consisting of the following fields:
~16-bit sequence number (SeqNr);
~4-bit LAN identifier (LanId);
~12 bit frame size (LSDUsize)
~16-bit suffix (PRPsuffix).

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller B-3


B.1 PRP AND HSR ETHERNET PROTOCOLS APPENDIX B

B.1.1 PRP

PRP defines a redundancy protocol for high availability in substation automation networks. It is applicable to networks
based on Ethernet technology (ISO/IEC 8802-3).

PRP is designed to provide seamless recovery in case of a single failure in the network, by using a combination of LAN
duplication and frame duplication technique. Identical frames are sent on two completely independent networks that
connect source and destination, see next figure.

Figure B–1: EXAMPLE OF PRP REDUNDANT NETWORK

Under normal circumstances both frames will reach their destination and one of them will be sent up the OSI stack to the
destination application, while the second one will be discarded. If an error occurs in one of the networks and traffic is
B prevented from flowing on that path, connectivity will still be provided through the other network to ensure continuous
communication. However, care must be taken when designing the two LANs, so that no single point of failure (such as a
common power supply) is encountered, as such scenarios can bring down both LANs simultaneously.

PRP uses specialized nodes called doubly attached nodes (DANPs) for handling the duplicated frames. DANPs devices
have an additional module at the link layer level, called the Link Redundancy Entity (LRE). LRE is responsible for
duplicating frames and adding the specific PRP trailer when sending the frames out on the LAN, as well as making
decisions on received frames as to which one is sent up the OSI stack to the application layer and which one is discarded.
In essence LRE is responsible for making PRP transparent to the higher layers of the stack. There is a second type of
specialized device used in PRP networks, called RedBox, with the role of connecting Single Attached Nodes (SANs) to a
redundant network.

F650 relays implement only the DANP functionality. The RedBox functionality is not implemented.

The original standard IEC 62439-3 (2010) was amended to align PRP with the High availability Seamless Redundancy
(HSR) protocol. To achieve this, the original PRP was modified at the cost of losing compatibility with the PRP 2010
version. The revised standard IEC 62439-3 (2012) is commonly referred to as PRP-1, while the original standard is PRP-0.
The F650 relays support only PRP-1.

B-4 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX B B.1 PRP AND HSR ETHERNET PROTOCOLS

PRP can be enabled in configuration through a setting available on the network configuration menu (Product Setup?
Communication Settings? Network (Ethernet), REDUNDANCY, which already has the capability of enabling Failover
redundancy. When REDUNDANCY is set to PRP, the ports dedicated for PRP will operate in redundant mode.

The rights associated with configuring PRP follow the security requirements for network configuration.

PRP management through SNMP MIB is not supported, as F650 doesn’t currently support SNMP for configuration.
Settings and actual values are only available through the front panel and through EnerVista.

The PRP solution to implement must ensure that performance requirements stated in IEC 61850-5 Clause 13 are still met.
It is specified under Clause 13 (Message performance requirements) that messages of type 1A must meet the performance
class P2/3, which is 3ms (See 3.7.1.1).

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller B-5


B.1 PRP AND HSR ETHERNET PROTOCOLS APPENDIX B

B.1.2 HSR

HSR defines a redundancy protocol for high availability in substation automation networks, based on PRP principles,
provides the property of zero recovery time, typically used in ring topology but applicable to any topology.
In the F650 relay, HSR is implemented in devices with communication option number K (for Fiber; 100 Base Fx) and M (for
cooper; Base 100 Tx). A frame is sent over both ports. A destination should receive, in the fault-free state, two identical
frames within a certain time skew, forward the first frame to the application and discard the second frame when (and if) it
comes. A sequence number is used to recognize such duplicates.
In contrast to PRP (IEC 62439-3- Clause 4), with which it shares the operating principle, HSR nodes are arranged into a
ring, which allows the network to operate without dedicated switches, since every node is able to forward frames from port
to port. HSR originally meant "High-availability Seamless Ring", but HSR is not limited to a simple ring topology.
Redundant connections to other HSR rings and to PRP networks are possible.

B-6 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX B B.2 RSTP (IEEE 802.1D-2004) AND DAISY CHAIN

B.2RSTP (IEEE 802.1D-2004) AND DAISY CHAIN B.2.1 RSTP DESCRIPTION

The Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol (RTSP), like STP, was designed to avoid loops in an Ethernet network. Rapid Spanning
Tree Protocol (RSTP) (IEEE 802.1w) is an evolution of the Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) (802.1d standard) and provides
for faster spanning tree convergence after a topology change.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller B-7


B.2 RSTP (IEEE 802.1D-2004) AND DAISY CHAIN APPENDIX B

B.2.2 RSTP CONCEPTS

The IEEE 802.1d Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) was developed to allow the construction of robust networks that
incorporate redundancy while pruning the active topology of the network to prevent loops. While STP is effective, it requires
that frame transfer must halt after a link outage until all bridges in the network are sure to be aware of the new topology.

Using STP (IEEE 802.1d) recommended values, this period lasts 30 seconds. The Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol (IEEE
802.1w) is a further evolution of the 802.1d Spanning Tree Protocol. It replaces the settling period with an active handshake
between switches (bridges) that guarantees topology information to be rapidly propagated through the network. RSTP
converges in less than one second. RSTP also offers a number of other significant innovations. These include:

• Topology changes in STP must be passed to the root bridge before they can be propagated to the network. Topology
changes in RSTP can be originated from and acted upon by any designated switch (bridge), leading to more rapid
propagation of address information
• STP recognizes one state - blocking for ports that should not forward any data or information. RSTP explicitly
recognizes two states or blocking roles - alternate and backup port including them in computations of when to learn
and forward and when to block
• STP relays configuration messages received on the root port going out of its designated ports. If an STP switch
(bridge) fails to receive a message from its neighbor it cannot be sure where along the path to the root a failure
occurred. RSTP switches (bridges) generate their own configuration messages, even if they fail to receive one from
the root bridge. This leads to quicker failure detection
• RSTP offers edge port recognition, allowing ports at the edge of the network to forward frames immediately after
activation while at the same time protecting them against loops
• An improvement in RSTP allows configuration messages to age more quickly preventing them from “going around in
circles” in the event of a loop RSTP has three states. They are discarding, learning and forwarding.

The discarding state is entered when the port is first taken into service. The port does not learn addresses in this state and
does not participate in frame transfer. The port looks for STP traffic in order to determine its role in the network. When it is
determined that the port will play an active part in the network, the state will change to learning. The learning state is
entered when the port is preparing to play an active member of the network. The port learns addresses in this state but
does not participate in frame transfer. In a network of RSTP switches (bridges) the time spent in this state is usually quite
short. RSTP switches (bridges) operating in STP compatibility mode will spend between 6 to 40 seconds in this state. After
'learning' the bridge will place the port in the forwarding state. While in this state the port both learn addresses and
B participates in frame transfer while in this state. The result of these enhanced states is that the IEEE 802.1d version of
spanning tree (STP) can take a fairly long time to resolve all the possible paths and to select the most efficient path through
the network. The IEEE 802.1w Rapid reconfiguration of Spanning Tree significantly reduces the amount of time it takes to
establish the network path. The result is reduced network downtime and improved network robustness. In addition to faster
network reconfiguration, RSTP also implements greater ranges for port path costs to accommodate the higher connection
speeds that are being implemented.

Proper implementations of RSTP (by switch vendors) is designed to be compatible with IEEE 802.1d STP. GE
recommends that you employ RSTP or STP in your network.

B-8 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX B B.2 RSTP (IEEE 802.1D-2004) AND DAISY CHAIN

B.2.3 USE IN MESHED NETWORKS

One great strength of RSTP is its support for all kinds of meshed topologies. The resulting flexibility regarding the
installation is a clear advantage over the stringent restrictions that are imposed by ring protocols such as MRP and ring
installations. However, this flexibility harbors one great disadvantage, namely the reconfiguration time, which for an
interconnected network will depend – among other things – on the complexity of the network topology and the location in
the network at which the failure occurred. Since RSTP is a decentralized protocol, it may also provoke highly unpredictable
race conditions in the establishment of new communications paths, particularly when choosing a new root bridge. This
gives rise to network reconfiguration times that can be estimated only very roughly, and this does restrict the use of RSTP,
particularly in meshed networks. In the case of meshed networks with very little complexity (such as ring networks with two
or three additional loops or subrings), a detailed analysis can make it possible to determine upper limits, but these will
always need to be worked out individually. Unlike with the protocols MRP, HSR and PRP, it is not possible to make a
general statement.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller B-9


B.2 RSTP (IEEE 802.1D-2004) AND DAISY CHAIN APPENDIX B

B.2.4 DAISY CHAIN

A daisy chain is an interconnection of devices where each device is connected in series to the next.

With an Ethernet daisy-chain redundancy selected, the F650 has two Ethernet ports and it is working as an Ethernet
unmanaged switch. The two Ethernet ports are used for connecting each device to the ports of its two neighboring devices.

Each device in the daisy chain forwards the message until it reaches the destination.

Ports A and B use the same MAC (physical device) address and operate by chaining one device with the next one.
Note that it is important not to create a loop in this topology. Both ends of the chain can be connected to different
networks. The device operates only with one IP address through these 2 ports.

B-10 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX B B.3 LINK LOSS ALERT (LLA)

B.3LINK LOSS ALERT (LLA) B.3.1 LLA

(Link Loss Alert) operation: The operation of ports A and B are as follows:

Ports A and B use port A’s MAC and IP address settings while port B is in standby mode in that it does not actively
communicate on the Ethernet network but monitors its link.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller B-11


B.3 LINK LOSS ALERT (LLA) APPENDIX B

B.3.2 LLA PRIORITY

If this setting is set to enabled, the port A has the priority. If PORTA’s LLA detects a problem with the link, communications
is switched to Port B. Port B is, in effect, acting as a redundant or backup link to the network for port A.

B-12 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX B B.3 LINK LOSS ALERT (LLA)

B.3.3 LLA TIMEOUT

This setting will be active only when the LLA PRIORITY is set to ENABLED. When the link on primary port is detected
again after it fails, there is LLA TIMEOUT (ms) monitoring time for the health of the network. During this time, the secondary
port remains active. If primary network is healthy for more than LLA TOIMEOUT value, the switch over to primary port is
automatic.

If the setting LLA PRIORITY is enabled:


• The primary port is port A while secondary (redundant) port is port B.
• The primary port will always be used if available.
• If the link on primary port is lost switch over to secondary port occurs immediately.
• When the link on primary port is detected again, there is a monitoring timeout (LLA TIMEOUT) for the health of the
network. After that period the communication switch over to primary port automatically.

If the setting LLA PRIORITY is disabled:


• There is no priority, therefore there is no primary port. The communication switch over from one Port to the other
occurs when the link fails.
• In this case the LLA TIMEOUT setting does not act.

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller B-13


B.3 LINK LOSS ALERT (LLA) APPENDIX B

B-14 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX C C.1 FACTORY DEFAULT LOGIC

APPENDIX C FACTORY DEFAULT LOGICC.1 FACTORY DEFAULT LOGIC

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller C-1


APPENDIX C C.1 FACTORY DEFAULT LOGIC

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller C-2


APPENDIX C C.1 FACTORY DEFAULT LOGIC

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller C-3


APPENDIX C C.1 FACTORY DEFAULT LOGIC

111
45
OVERFREQ1 PKP 25
112 VO_054_81O_PKP
inOR1 OR3 outOR1
OVERFREQ2 PKP
inOR2
113
OVERFREQ3 PKP inOR3
114
46
UNDERFREQ1 PKP 26
VO_055_81U_PKP
115 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
UNDERFREQ2 PKP
inOR2
116
UNDERFREQ3 PKP inOR3
FREQUENCY
PICKUPS
410 413
409
FREQ RATE1 PKP VO_052_81DF-DT PKP
411 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
FREQ RATE2 PKP
412 inOR2
FREQ RATE3 PKP
inOR3

415 49
414
VO_052_81DF-DT PKP VO_056_ALL_FREQUENCY_PKP
47 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
VO_054_81O_PKP
48 inOR2
VO_055_81U_PKP
274 inOR3
BROKEN CONDUCT1 PKP 277
273
VO_018_BROKEN_CONDUCTOR_PKP
275 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
BROKEN
BROKEN CONDUCT2 PKP
CONDUCTOR inOR2
276
BROKEN CONDUCT3 PKP inOR3
347
FWD PWR1 STG1 PKP 353
348 346
VO_023_FORWARD_POWER_PKP
FWD PWR1 STG2 PKP inOR1 OR6 outOR1
349
inOR2
FWD PWR2 STG1 PKP
FORWARD 350 inOR3
POWER
FWD PWR2 STG2 PKP inOR4
351
FWD PWR3 STG1 PKP
352
inOR5
C
inOR6
FWD PWR3 STG2 PKP
390
370
DIR PWR1 STG PKP 373
VO_025_DIRECTIONAL_POWER_PKP
371 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
DIRECTIONAL
POWER DIR PWR2 STG PKP
372 inOR2
DIR PWR3 STG PKP
inOR3
AUXILIARY SIGNALS (NOT INCLUDED IN GENERAL POWER PKP)
458 456
454
32N1 HIGH OC PKP VO_094_32N_HIGH_OC_PKP
459 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
WATTIMETRIC 32N2 HIGH OC PKP
460 inOR2
GROUND
FAULT 32N3 HIGH OC PKP
inOR3
OVERCURRENT 461 457
455
PKP 32N1 LOW OC PKP VO_095_32N_LOW_OC_PKP
462 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
32N2 LOW OC PKP
463 inOR2
32N3 LOW OC PKP
inOR3

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller C-4


APPENDIX C C.1 FACTORY DEFAULT LOGIC

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller C-5


APPENDIX C C.1 FACTORY DEFAULT LOGIC

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller C-6


APPENDIX C C.1 FACTORY DEFAULT LOGIC

138
61
GROUND IOC1 OP 15
VO_068_50G_TRIP
139 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
GROUND IOC2 OP
inOR2
140
GROUND IOC3 OP inOR3
63 16
VO_067_51G_TRIP OR 62
64 VO_069_GROUND_OVERCURRENT
VO_068_50G_TRIP
147
SENS GND TOC1 OP 65
18
VO_070_51SG_TRIP
148 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
SENS GND TOC2 OP
inOR2
149
SENS GND TOC3 OP inOR3
144
66
SENS GND IOC1 OP 17
VO_071_50SG_TRIP
145 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
SENS GND IOC2 OP
inOR2
146
SENS GND IOC3 OP inOR3
181
184
ISOLATED GND1 OP 180
VO_044_50IG_TRIP
182 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
ISOLATED GND2 OP
OVERCURRENT inOR2
TRIPS 183
ISOLATED GND3 OP inOR3
68
67
VO_070_51SG_TRIP 174
VO_072_SENSITIVE_GROU
69 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
VO_071_50SG_TRIP
inOR2
185
VO_044_50IG_TRIP inOR3
126
53
C
NEG SEQ TOC1 OP 4
VO_061_I2_TOC_TRIP
127 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
NEG SEQ TOC2 OP
inOR2
128
NEG SEQ TOC3 OP inOR3
288
VO_019_PHASE_OVERCURRENT_TRIP
289 314
VO_066_NEUTRAL_OVERCURRENT_TRIP
inOR1 OR6 outOR1
290
inOR2
VO_069_GROUND_OVERCURRENT_TRIP
291 inOR3
VO_072_SENSITIVE_GROUND_TRIP
inOR4
292
287
VO_061_I2_TOC_TRIP inOR5
VO_020_ALL_OVERCURREN
315
inOR6
VO_062_THERMAL_TRIP

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller C-7


APPENDIX C C.1 FACTORY DEFAULT LOGIC

150
70
PHASE UV1 OP 5
VO_073_27P_TRIP
151 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
PHASE UV2 OP
152 inOR2

PHASE UV3 OP inOR3


153
71
PHASE OV1 OP 6
VO_074_59P_TRIP
154 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
PHASE OV2 OP
inOR2
155
PHASE OV3 OP inOR3
156
72
NEUTRAL OV1 HIGH OP 19
VO_075_59NH_TRIP
157 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
NEUTRAL OV2 HIGH OP
inOR2
158
NEUTRAL OV3 HIGH OP inOR3
159
73
NEUTRAL OV1 LOW OP 20
VO_076_59NL_TRIP
160 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
NEUTRAL OV2 LOW OP
inOR2
161
NEUTRAL OV3 LOW OP inOR3
162
74
AUXILIARY OV1 OP 21
VO_077_59X_TRIP
163 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
AUXILIARY OV2 OP
164 inOR2
VOLTAGE
TRIPS AUXILIARY OV3 OP inOR3
165
75
AUXILIARY UV1 OP 22
VO_078_27X_TRIP
166 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
AUXILIARY UV2 OP
167 inOR2 C
AUXILIARY UV3 OP inOR3
294
297
NEG SEQ OV1 OP 293
VO_021_V2_OV_TRIP
295 inOR1 OR3 outOR1
NEG SEQ OV2 OP
inOR2
296
NEG SEQ OV3 OP inOR3
77
VO_073_27P_TRIP
82 299
VO_078_27X_TRIP In OR1 OR7 OutOR1
78
In OR2
VO_074_59P_TRIP
79 In OR3
VO_075_59NH_TRIP In OR4
80
I OR5 76

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller C-8


APPENDIX C C.1 FACTORY DEFAULT LOGIC

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller C-9


APPENDIX C C.1 FACTORY DEFAULT LOGIC

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller C-10


APPENDIX C C.1 FACTORY DEFAULT LOGIC

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller C-11


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

APPENDIX D FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATIOND.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >SERIAL PORTS


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Baud rate for COM1 COM1 Baud Rate 19200 N/A [300 : 115200]
Baud rate for COM2 COM2 Baud Rate 19200 N/A [300 : 115200]
Parity for COM1 COM1 Parity NONE N/A [NONE:ODD:EVEN]
Parity for COM2 COM2 Parity NONE N/A [NONE:ODD:EVEN]

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >NETWORK (ETHERNET)


NETWORK (ETHERNET)1 > NETWORK (ETHERNET)2
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
1st octet of IP address IP Address Oct1 0 N/A [0 : 255]
2nd octet of IP address IP Address Oct2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
3rd octet of IP address IP Address Oct3 0 N/A [0 : 255]
4th octet of IP address IP Address Oct4 0 N/A [0 : 255]
1st octet of Netmask Netmask Oct1 0 N/A [0 : 255]
2nd octet of Netmask Netmask Oct2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
3rd octet of Netmask Netmask Oct3 0 N/A [0 : 255]
4th octet of Netmask Netmask Oct4 0 N/A [0 : 255]
1st octet of Gateway Gateway IP Oct1 0 N/A [0 : 255]
2nd octet of Gateway Gateway IP Oct2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
3rd octet of Gateway Gateway IP Oct3 0 N/A [0 : 255]
4th octet of Gateway Gateway IP Oct4 0 N/A [0 : 255]

**For firmware versions 7.00 or higher; the Network settings are the ethernet communication parameters are as follow

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >NETWORK (ETHERNET)


NETWORK (ETHERNET)1 > NETWORK (ETHERNET)

SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE USER


VALUE
1st octet of IP address IP Address Oct1 0 N/A [0 : 255]
2nd octet of IP address IP Address Oct2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
3rd octet of IP address IP Address Oct3 0 N/A [0 : 255]
4th octet of IP address IP Address Oct4 0 N/A [0 : 255]
1st octet of Netmask
2nd octet of Netmask
Netmask Oct1
Netmask Oct2
0
0
N/A
N/A
[0 : 255]
[0 : 255]
D
3rd octet of Netmask Netmask Oct3 0 N/A [0 : 255]
4th octet of Netmask Netmask Oct4 0 N/A [0 : 255]

**For firmware versions 7.00 or higher; on the Network settings are also located the settings for Redundancy.

USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission REDUNDANCY INDEPENDENT N/A [INDEPENDENT; LLA;
MODE PRP; HSR; RSTP;
DAISY_CHAIN]
Stablish priority for Port A LLA Priority DISABLED N/A [ENABLED; DISABLED]

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-1


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

Switch over time from port B to port LLA Timeout 5000 N/A [0 : 600000]
A
Switch (bridge) priority value RSTP BRIDGE 32768 N/A [0 : 61440]
PRIORITY
determine which ports are used for RSTP PORT A 128 N/A [0 : 240]
forwarding PRIORITY
assigned port cost value used for the RSTP PORT A 200000 N/A [0 : 2000000]
switch PATHCOST
Determine which ports are used for RSTP PORT B 128 N/A [0 : 240]
forwarding PRIORITY
Assigned port cost value used for RSTP PORT B 200000 N/A [0 : 2000000]
the switch PATHCOST

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >MODBUS PROTOCOL

SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE USER


VALUE
Modbus Address
Slave address for COM1 254 N/A [1 : 255]
COM1

Slave address for COM2 Modbus Address 254 N/A [1 : 255]


COM2
Modbus port number for Modbus TCP/
Modbus Port Number 502 N/A [0 : 65535]
IP

D-2 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >DNP3 SLAVE


DNP3 SLAVE 1 > DNP3 SLAVE 2 > DNP3 SLAVE 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Communications port assigned to the
DNP protocol Physical Port NONE N/A [COM1:COM2:NETWORK]

DNP slave address Address 255 N/A [0 : 65534]


1st Octect of IP address of DNP
IP Addr Client1 Oct1 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 1
2nd Octect of IP address of DNP
IP Addr Client1 Oct2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 1
3nd Octect of IP address of DNP
master 1 IP Addr Client1 Oct3 0 N/A [0 : 255]

4th Octect of IP address of DNP


master 1 IP Addr Client1 Oct4 0 N/A [0 : 255]

1st Octect of IP address of DNP


IP Addr Client2 Oct1 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 2
2nd Octect of IP address of DNP
master 2 IP Addr Client2 Oct2 0 N/A [0 : 255]

3nd Octect of IP address of DNP


master 2 IP Addr Client2 Oct3 0 N/A [0 : 255]

4th Octect of IP address of DNP


IP Addr Client2 Oct4 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 2
1st Octect of IP address of DNP
master 3 IP Addr Client3 Oct1 0 N/A [0 : 255]

2nd Octect of IP address of DNP


IP Addr Client3 Oct2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 3
3nd Octect of IP address of DNP
IP Addr Client3 Oct3 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 3
4th Octect of IP address of DNP
IP Addr Client3 Oct4 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 3
1st Octect of IP address of DNP
master 4 IP Addr Client4 Oct1 0 N/A [0 : 255]

2nd Octect of IP address of DNP


IP Addr Client4 Oct2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 4
3nd Octect of IP address of DNP
IP Addr Client4 Oct3 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 4
4th Octect of IP address of DNP
master 4 IP Addr Client4 Oct4 0 N/A [0 : 255]

1st Octect of IP address of DNP


IP Addr Client5 Oct1 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 4
2nd Octect of IP address of DNP
IP Addr Client5 Oct2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 4
3nd Octect of IP address of DNP
IP Addr Client5 Oct3 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 4
4th Octect of IP address of DNP
IP Addr Client5 Oct4 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 4
TCP/UDP port number for DNP over
Ethernet
TCP/UDP Port 20000 N/A [0 : 65535] D
Unsolicited responses permission Unsol Resp Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Time out to confirm an unsolicited
Unsol Resp TimeOut 5 1s [0 : 60]
response
Number of retransmissions of an unsol
Unsol Resp Max Ret 10 N/A [0 : 255]
resp w/o confirmation
Address to which all unsolicited
Unsol Resp Dest Adr 200 N/A [0 : 65519]
responses are sent
[0.00001-0.0001-0.001-
Scale for currents Current Scale Factor 1 N/A 0.01-0.1-1-10-100-1000]

[0.00001-0.0001-0.001-
Scale for voltages Voltage Scale Factor 1 N/A
0.01-0.1-1-10-100-1000]

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-3


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >DNP3 SLAVE (CONT.)


DNP3 SLAVE 1 > DNP3 SLAVE 2 > DNP3 SLAVE 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE

[0.00001-0.0001-0.001-
Scale for power Power Scale Factor 1 N/A 0.01-0.1-1-10-100-1000]

[0.00001-0.0001-0.001-
Scale for energy Energy Scale Factor 1 N/A
0.01-0.1-1-10-100-1000]

[0.00001-0.0001-0.001-
Other Scale factor Other Scale Factor 1 N/A 0.01-0.1-1-10-100-1000]
Default deadband for Current Analog
Input points to trigger unsolicited Current Deadband 30000 N/A [0 : 65535]
responses
Default deadband for Voltage Analog
Input points to trigger unsolicited Voltage Deadband 30000 N/A [0 : 65535]
responses
Default deadband for Power Analog
Input points to trigger unsolicited Power Deadband 30000 N/A [0 : 65535]
responses
Default deadband for Energy Analog
Input points to trigger unsolicited Energy Deadband 30000 N/A [0 : 65535]
responses
Default deadband for Other Analog
Input points to trigger unsolicited Other Deadband 30000 N/A [0 : 65535]
responses
Size (in bytes) for message Msg Fragment Size 240 1 byte [30 : 2048]
fragmentation
Size customization and change of
DNP Binary Inputs point list Binary Input Block 1 CTL EVENTS 1-16 N/A [See DNP note2]

Size customization and change of


Binary Input Block 2 CTL EVENTS 17-32 N/A [See DNP note2]
DNP Binary Inputs point list

Size customization and change of


DNP Binary Inputs point list Binary Input Block 3 CTL EVENTS 33-48 N/A [See DNP note2]

Size customization and change of


Binary Input Block 4 CTL EVENTS 49-64 N/A [See DNP note2]
DNP Binary Inputs point list

Size customization and change of


DNP Binary Inputs point list Binary Input Block 5 CTL EVENTS 65-80 N/A [See DNP note2]

Size customization and change of


Binary Input Block 6 CTL EVENTS 81-96 N/A [See DNP note2]
DNP Binary Inputs point list

Size customization and change of CTL EVENTS 97-


DNP Binary Inputs point list Binary Input Block 7 112 N/A [See DNP note2]

Size customization and change of CTL EVENTS 113-


Binary Input Block 8 N/A [See DNP note2]
DNP Binary Inputs point list 128
D Size customization and change of
DNP Binary Inputs point list Binary Input Block 9 SWITCHGEAR 1-8 N/A [See DNP note2]

Size customization and change of SWITCHGEAR 9-


Binary Input Block 10 N/A [See DNP note2]
DNP Binary Inputs point list 16

Default Analog Map permission Default Analog Map ENABLED N/A [ENABLED; DISABLE]
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 0 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 1 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 2 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 3 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 4 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 5 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 6 End of list N/A

D-4 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >DNP3 SLAVE (CONT.)


DNP3 SLAVE 1 > DNP3 SLAVE 2 > DNP3 SLAVE 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE

DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 7 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 8 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 9 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 10 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 11 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 12 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 13 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 14 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 15 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 16 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 17 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 18 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 19 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 20 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 21 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 22 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 23 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 24 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 25 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 26 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 27 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 28 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 29 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 30 End of list N/A
DNP Analog Input Points point list Analog Input Point 31 End of list N/A

DNP NOTES
Note 1: Scale Factor Note that a scale factor of 0.1 is equivalent to a multiplier of 10 (i.e. the value will be 10 times
[NOT USED, CTL EVENTS 1-16, CTL EVENTS 17-32, CTL EVENTS 33-48,CTL EVENTS 49-
Note 2: Binary Input Block Selection: 64, CTL EVENTS 65-80, CTL EVENTS 81-96, CTL EVENTS 97-112, CTL EVENTS 113-128,
SWITCHGEAR 1-8, SWITCHGEAR 9-16]

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >IEC 870-5-104

SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE USER


D
VALUE
Enable or disable the protocol
Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
operation
Listening TCP port in the relay TCP Port 2404 N/A [0 : 65535]
Common Addr of
Address in the ASDU header 255 N/A [0 : 65535]
ASDU
Number of seconds for instantaneous
Cyclic Meter Period 0 1s [0 : 3600]
metering
Synchronization Event Synchronization Event 0 0 N/A [0 : 3600]
1st Octect of IP address of 104 master IEC104 NET1 CLI1 0 N/A [0 : 255]
1 OCTET1
2nd Octect of IP address of 104 IEC104 NET1 CLI1 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 1 OCTET2

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-5


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >IEC 870-5-104 (CONT.)


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE

3nd Octect of IP address of 104 IEC104 NET1 CLI1 0 N/A [0 : 255]


master 1 OCTET3
4th Octect of IP address of 104 master IEC104 NET1 CLI1 0 N/A [0 : 255]
1 OCTET4
1st Octect of IP address of 104 master IEC104 NET1 CLI2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
2 OCTET1
2nd Octect of IP address of 104 IEC104 NET1 CLI2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 2 OCTET2
3nd Octect of IP address of 104 IEC104 NET1 CLI2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 2 OCTET3
4th Octect of IP address of 104 master IEC104 NET1 CLI2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
2 OCTET4
Enable or disable the protocol Function 2 DISABLED N/A
operation
Listening TCP port in the relay TCP Port 2 2404 N/A [0 : 65535]
Address in the ASDU header Common Addr of 255 N/A [0 : 65535]
ASDU 2
1st Octect of IP address of 104 master IEC104 NET2 CLI1 0 N/A [0 : 255]
1 OCTET1
2nd Octect of IP address of 104 IEC104 NET2 CLI1 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 1 OCTET2
3nd Octect of IP address of 104 IEC104 NET2 CLI1 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 1 OCTET3
4th Octect of IP address of 104 master IEC104 NET2 CLI1 0 N/A [0 : 255]
1 OCTET4
1st Octect of IP address of 104 master IEC104 NET2 CLI2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
2 OCTET1
2nd Octect of IP address of 104 IEC104 NET2 CLI2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 2 OCTET2
3nd Octect of IP address of 104 IEC104 NET2 CLI2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
master 2 OCTET3
4th Octect of IP address of 104 master IEC104 NET2 CLI2 0 N/A [0 : 255]
2 OCTET4
IEC104 SCALE CURRENT IEC104 SCALE 1 [0,00001; 0,0001; 0,001;
CURRENT 0,01; 0,1; 1; 10; 100; 1000;
10000]
IEC104 SCALE VOLTAGE IEC104 SCALE 1
VOLTAGE
D IEC104 SCALE POWER IEC104 SCALE 1
POWER
IEC104 SCALE ENERGY IEC104 SCALE 1
ENERGY
IEC104 SCALE OTHER IEC104 SCALE 1
OTHER
IEC104 DEADBAND CURRENT IEC104 DEADBAND 30000 [0 : 65535]
CURRENT
IEC104 DEADBAND VOLTAGE IEC104 DEADBAND 30000 [0 : 65535]
VOLTAGE
IEC104 DEADBAND POWER IEC104 DEADBAND 30000 [0 : 65535]
POWER

D-6 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >IEC 870-5-104 (CONT.)


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE

IEC104 DEADBAND ENERGY IEC104 DEADBAND 30000 [0 : 65535]


ENERGY
IEC104 DEADBAND OTHER IEC104 DEADBAND 30000 [0 : 65535]
OTHER
IEC104 IOA BINARIES IEC104 IOA 1000 [0 : 65535]
BINARIES
IEC104 IOA DOUBLE POINTS IEC104 IOA DOUBLE 1500 [0 : 65535]
POINTS
IEC104 IOA ANALOGS IEC104 IOA 2000 [0 : 65535]
ANALOGS
IEC104 IOA COUNTERS IEC104 IOA 4000 [0 : 65535]
COUNTERS
IEC104 IOA COMMANDS IEC104 IOA 3000 [0 : 65535]
COMMANDS
IEC104 IOA ANALOG PARAMETERS IEC104 IOA ANALOG 5000 [0 : 65535]
PARAMETERS

IEC 870-5-104 NOTES


Note 1: Cyclic Meter Period 0 value means no spontaneous metering

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS > SNTP


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Port used UDP port 123 1 [1 : 65535]
IP Address OCT 1 Server IP Oct 1 0 1 [1 : 255]
IP Address OCT 2 Server IP Oct 2 0 1 [1 : 255]
IP Address OCT 3 Server IP Oct 3 0 1 [1 : 255]
IP Address OCT 4 Server IP Oct 4 0 1 [1 : 255]

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >PROCOME

SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE USER


VALUE
Serial Remote Com Port selection COMM Port NONE [NONE – COM1]
Slave number for procome Slave Number 0 [0 : 254]

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >PTP 1588


D
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Function permission PTP FUNCTION DISABLE [DISABLE; ENABLE]
PORTA DELAY 0 ns [0 : 60000]
Port A, B Path Delay Adder ADDER
Port A Path Delay Asymmetry PORTA DELAY ASYM 0 ns [-1000 : 1000]
PORTB DELAY 0 ns [0 : 60000]
Port B Path Delay Adder ADDER
Port B Path Delay Asymmetry PORTB DELAY ASYM 0 ns [-1000 : 1000]
STRICT POWER DISABLED DISABLED/ENABLED
Strict Power Profile PROFILE

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-7


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

PTP DOMAIN 0 [0 : 255]


PTP domain number NUMBER
PTP VLAN Priority PTP VLAN PRIORITY 4 [0 : 7]
PTP VLAN Identification PTP VLAN ID 0 [0 : 4095]
PTP EPOCH UTC SINCE 2000 UTC SINCE 2000; UTC
Reference time defining the origin of SINCE 1970; UTC SINCE
a time scale is termed the epoch. 1900

PRODUCT SETUP>COMMUNICATION SETTINGS >ROUTING


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE

1st octet of Gateway Default RT GWY Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]


2nd octet of Gateway Default RT GWY Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
3nd octet of Gateway Default RT GWY Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
4th octet of Gateway Default RT GWY Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT1 IP Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT1 IP Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT1 IP Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT1 IP Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT1 Mask Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT1 Mask Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT1 Mask Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT1 Mask Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT1 GWY Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT1 GWY Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT1 GWY Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT1 GWY Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT2 IP Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT2 IP Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT2 IP Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]

D sets the destination IPv4 route


sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT2 IP Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]

Static RT2 Mask Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]


route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT2 Mask Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT2 Mask Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT2 Mask Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT2 GWY Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT2 GWY Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT2 GWY Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route

D-8 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

sets the gateway to reach the


Static RT2 GWY Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT3 IP Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT3 IP Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT3 IP Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT3 IP Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT3 Mask Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT3 Mask Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT3 Mask Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT3 Mask Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT3 GWY Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT3 GWY Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT3 GWY Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT3 GWY Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT4 IP Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT4 IP Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT4 IP Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT4 IP Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT4 Mask Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT4 Mask Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT4 Mask Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT4 Mask Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT4 GWY Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT4 GWY Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT4 GWY Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT4 GWY Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT5 IP Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
D
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT5 IP Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT5 IP Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT5 IP Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT5 Mask Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT5 Mask Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT5 Mask Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT5 Mask Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
route

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-9


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

sets the gateway to reach the


Static RT5 GWY Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT5 GWY Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT5 GWY Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT5 GWY Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT6 IP Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT6 IP Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT6 IP Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the destination IPv4 route Static RT6 IP Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT6 Mask Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT6 Mask Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT6 Mask Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the IP mask associated with the
Static RT6 Mask Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT6 GWY Oct1 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT6 GWY Oct2 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT6 GWY Oct3 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route
sets the gateway to reach the
Static RT6 GWY Oct4 0 1 [0 : 255]
destination IP route

D-10 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

SETPOINT > PRODUCT SETUP > MODBUS USER MAP


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Address 00 for Modbus user map Address 00 0 N/A [0000 : FFFF]
Address 01 for Modbus user map Address 01 0 N/A [0000 : FFFF]
... ... ...
Address 254 for Modbus user map Address 254 0 N/A [0000 : FFFF]
Address 255 for Modbus user map Address 255 0 N/A [0000 : FFFF]

SETPOINT > PRODUCT SETUP > FAULT REPORT


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Positive sequence impedance module Pos Seq Module 3.00 0.01 Ohm [0.01 : 250.00]
Positive sequence impedance angle Pos Seq Angle 75 1 Deg [25 : 90]
Zero sequence impedance module Zero Seq Module 9.00 0.01 Ohm [0.01 : 750.00]
Zero sequence impedance angle Zero Seq Angle 75 1 Deg [25 : 90]
Line length Line Length 100.0 0.1 [0.0 : 2000.0]
Display fault on HMI Show Fault On HMI DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
CT Direction CT Direction REVERSE NA REVERSE; FORWARD

SETPOINT > PRODUCT SETUP > OSCILLOGRAPHY


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function Permission Function ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Prefault Trigger Position 30 1% [5 : 95]
Samples per cycle Samples/Cycle 64 N/A [4 – 8 – 16 –32 – 64]
Maximum number of oscillos Max. Number Osc. 4 1 oscillo [1 : 20]
Automatic oscillography overwrite Automatic Overwrite DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PRODUCT SETUP > DATA LOGGER


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
[1 s, 5 min, 10 min, 15 min,
Data logger Rate Data Logger Rate 1s N/A
20 min, 30 min, 60 min.]
Data Logger analog channels X Data Logger Chnl X None N/A [1 to 16] D

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-11


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

SETPOINT > PRODUCT SETUP > DEMAND


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Function permission Demand Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
[BLOCK INTERVAL -
CRNT Demand THERMAL
Demand method for current values Method EXPONENTIAL N/A ROLLING DEMAND -
THERMAL EXPONENTIAL]
[BLOCK INTERVAL -
POWER Demand THERMAL
Demand method for Power values Method EXPONENTIAL N/A ROLLING DEMAND -
THERMAL EXPONENTIAL]
Demand interval Demand Interval 5 Minutes N/A [5 – 10 – 15 – 20– 30–60]
Trigger Enabled Trigger Enabled DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

D-12 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

SETPOINT > PRODUCT SETUP > TIME SETTINGS


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Local time zone offset Universal LOC. TIME OFFS.
Coodinated Time UTC 0 1 [-24,0 : 24,0]
DAYLIG. SAVINGS
To follow DST rules TIME DISABLED NA [DISBLED; ENABLED]
DST START
Set the start month of the DST MONTH MAR MONTH January to December
DST START
Set the start weekday of the DST WEEKDAY SUNDAY DAY Monday to Sunday
DST START DAY First; Second; Third;
Set the start day instance INST LAST NA Fourth; Last
Set the starting hour of the DST DST START HOUR 2 1 [0 : 23]
Set the Stop month of the DST DST STOP MONTH OCT Month January to December
DST STOP
Set the stop weekday of the DST WEEKDAY SUNDAY Day Monday to Sunday
DST STOP DAY First; Second; Third;
Set the stop day instance INST LAST NA Fourth; Last
Set the stop hour of the DST DST STOP HOUR 2 1 [0 : 23]
IRIG-B local time IRIG-B LOCAL TIME OFF NA [ON; OFF]
Function permission IRIGB Function DISABLED NA ENABLLED; DISABLED
Stablish the sync priority PTP IRIGB Priority PTP-1588 NA PTP-1588; IRIG_B

SETPOINT > SYSTEM SETUP > GENERAL SETTINGS


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Phase CT ratio Phase CT Ratio 1.0 0.1 [1.0 : 6000.0]
Ground CT ratio Ground CT Ratio 1.0 0.1 [1.0 : 6000.0]
Sensitive ground CT ratio Stv Ground CT Ratio 1.0 0.1 [1.0 : 6000.0]
Phase VT ratio Phase VT Ratio 1.0 0.1 [1.0 : 6000.0]
Phase VT connection Phase VT Connection WYE N/A [WYE – DELTA]
Rated voltage Nominal Voltage 100.0 0.1 [1.0 : 250.0]
Rated Frequency Nominal Frequency 50 Hz Hz [50-60]
Phase rotation Phase Rotation ABC N/A [ABC – ACB]
Frequency reference Frequency Reference VI N/A [VI-VII-VIII]
Auxiliary Voltage Auxiliary Voltage VX N/A [VX – VN]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Primary meter units Primary meter units kA_kV NA A_V; kA_kV
Device name Device name NA NA NA
D
SETPOINT > SYSTEM SETUP > FLEX CURVES
FLEX CURVES A > FLEX CURVES B> FLEX CURVES C > FLEX CURVES D
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Values for reset points 0.00 pkp Time 0.00xPKP [RST] 0.000 0.001 s [0.000 : 65.535]
Values for reset points 0.05 pkp Time 0.05xPKP [RST] 0.000 0.001 s [0.000 : 65.535]
… … … 0.001 s [0.000 : 65.535]
Values for reset points 0.97 pkp Time 0.97xPKP [RST] 0.000 0.001 s [0.000 : 65.535]
Values for reset points 0.98 pkp Time 0.98xPKP [RST] 0.000 0.001 s [0.000 : 65.535]
Values for operation points 1.03 pkp Time 1.03xPKP [OP] 0.000 0.001 s [0.000 : 65.535]

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-13


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

Values for operation points 1.05 pkp Time 1.05xPKP [OP] 0.000 0.001 s [0.000 : 65.535]
… … … 0.001 s [0.000 : 65.535]
Values for operation points 19.50 pkp Time 19.50xPKP [OP] 0.000 0.001 s [0.000 : 65.535]
Values for operation points 20.00 pkp Time 20.00xPKP [OP] 0.000 0.001 s [0.000 : 65.535]

D-14 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

SETPOINT > SYSTEM SETUP > BREAKER > BREAKER SETTINGS


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Number of Switchgear selected as
Number of Switchgear 1 1 [1 : 16]
breaker
0.01(KA)2
Maximum value of KI2t Maximum KI2t 9999.99 [0.00 : 9999.99]
s
KI2t integration time KI2t Integ. Time 0.03 0.01s [0.03 : 0.25]
Maximum number of openings Maximum Openings 9999 1 [0 : 9999]
Maximum Openings in one hour Max.Openings 1 hour 40 1 [1 : 60]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > SYSTEM SETUP > BREAKER > BREAKER MAINTENANCE

SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE USER


VALUE
0.01 (KA)2
KI2t Counter Phase A KI2t BKR Ph A Cnt 0.00 s [0.00 : 9999.99]

0.01 (KA)2
KI2t Counter Phase B KI2t BKR Ph B Cnt 0.00 s [0.00 : 9999.99]

0.01 (KA)2
KI2t Counter Phase C KI2t BKR Ph C Cnt 0.00 [0.00 : 9999.99]
s
Openings counter BKR Openings Cnt 0 1 [0 : 9999]
Closings counter BKR Closings Cnt 0 1 [0 : 9999]

SETPOINT > SYSTEM SETUP > SWITCHGEAR

SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE USER


VALUE
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
switchgear #1 SWGR 1
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
switchgear #2 SWGR 2
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
switchgear #3 SWGR 3 DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events


DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
switchgear #4 SWGR 4
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
switchgear #5 SWGR 5
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
switchgear #6 SWGR 6
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
switchgear #7 SWGR 7
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
switchgear #8 SWGR 8
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
switchgear #9 SWGR 9
DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
D
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
switchgear #10 SWGR 10
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
switchgear #11 SWGR 11
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
switchgear #12 SWGR 12
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
switchgear #13 SWGR 13
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
switchgear #14 SWGR 14
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
switchgear #15 SWGR 15
Snapshot Event generation for Snapshot Events
DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
switchgear #16 SWGR 16

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-15


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

SETPOINT > SYSTEM SETUP > MISCELLANIOUS >


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Relay Out Of
Relay out of service status ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Service
Local/Remote
Set to local or remote OFF N/A ON; OFF
Blocked
Active language on the relay Active Language 0 N/A [0 : 1]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > PHASE CURRENT >


> PHASE TOC HIGH > PHASE TOC HIGH 1> PHASE TOC HIGH 2 > PHASE TOC HIGH 3
> PHASE TOC LOW > PHASE TOC LOW 1 > PHASE TOC LOW 2 > PHASE TOC LOW 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Input type Input PHASOR(DFT) N/A [PHASOR – RMS]
Pickup level Pickup Level 1.00 0.01 A [0.05 : 160.00]
Curve shape Curve IEEE Ext Inv N/A [See list of curves]
Time Dial TD Multiplier 1.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]

Reset type Reset INSTANTANEOUS N/A [INSTANTANEOUS –


LINEAR]
Voltage Restraint Voltage Restraint DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > PHASE CURRENT >


> PHASE IOC HIGH > PHASE IOC HIGH 1> PHASE IOC HIGH 2 > PHASE IOC HIGH 3
> PHASE IOC LOW > PHASE IOC LOW 1 > PHASE IOC LOW 2 > PHASE IOC LOW 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Input type Input PHASOR(DFT) N/A [PHASOR – RMS]
Pickup level Pickup Level 30.00 0.01 A [0.05 : 160.00]
Trip time Trip Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Reset time Reset Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > PHASE CURRENT > PHASE DIRECTIONAL >
PHASE DIRECTIONAL 1> PHASE DIRECTIONAL 2 > PHASE DIRECTIONAL 3
USER
D SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Maximum Torque Angle MTA 45 1 Deg [-90 : +90]
Operation Direction Direction FORWARD N/A [FORWARD – REVERSE]
Block logic Block Logic PERMISSION N/A [BLOCK – PERMISSION]
Polarization voltage threshold Pol V Threshold 40 1V [0 : 300]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Voltage Memory Voltage Memory 0,00 s 0,01 s [0,00 : 3,00]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > PHASE CURRENT > THERMAL MODEL >
THERMAL MODEL 1> THERMAL MODEL 2 > THERMAL MODEL 3

D-16 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Heating constant Heat Time Constant 6.0 0.1 min [3.0 : 600.0]
0.01 times
Cooling constant Cool Time Constant 2.00 Heat Time [1.00 : 6.00]
Ct.
Pickup level Pickup Level 1.00 0.01 A [0.05 : 160.00]
Alarm level Alarm Level 80.0 0.10% [1.0 : 110.0]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-17


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > NEUTRAL CURRENT > NEUTRAL TOC
NEUTRAL TOC 1> NEUTRAL TOC 2 > NEUTRAL TOC 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Pickup level Pickup Level 1.00 0.01 A [0.05 : 160.00]
Curve shape Curve IEEE Ext Inv N/A [See list of curves]
Time Dial TD Multiplier 1.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
[INSTANTANEOUS –
Reset type Reset INSTANTANEOUS N/A LINEAR]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > NEUTRAL CURRENT > NEUTRAL IOC
NEUTRAL IOC 1> NEUTRAL IOC 2 > NEUTRAL IOC 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Pickup level Pickup Level 30.00 0.01 A [0.05 : 160.00]
Trip time Trip Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Reset time Reset Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > NEUTRAL CURRENT > NEUTRAL DIRECTIONAL >
NEUTRAL DIRECTIONAL 1> NEUTRAL DIRECTIONAL 2 > NEUTRAL DIRECTIONAL 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Maximum Torque Angle MTA -45 1 Deg [-90 : +90]
Operation Direction Direction FORWARD N/A [FORWARD – REVERSE]
Polarization type Polarization VO N/A [V0 – IP – V0+IP – V0*IP ]
Block logic type Block Logic PERMISSION N/A [BLOCK – PERMISSION]
Polarization voltage threshold Pol V Threshold 10 1V [0 : 300]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > GROUND CURRENT > GROUND TOC
GROUND TOC 1> GROUND TOC 2 > GROUND TOC 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE

D Function permission
Input type
Function
Input
DISABLED
PHASOR(DFT)
N/A
N/A
[DISABLED – ENABLED]
[PHASOR – RMS]
Pickup level Pickup Level 1.00 0.01 A [0.05 : 160.00]
Curve shape Curve IEEE Ext Inv N/A [See list of curves]
Time Dial TD Multiplier 1.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
[INSTANTANEOUS –
Reset type Reset INSTANTANEOUS N/A
LINEAR]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

D-18 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > GROUND CURRENT > GROUND IOC
GROUND IOC 1> GROUND IOC 2 > GROUND IOC 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Input type Input PHASOR(DFT) N/A [PHASOR – RMS]
Pickup level Pickup Level 30.00 0.01 A [0.05 : 160.00]
Trip time Trip Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Reset time Reset Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > GROUND CURRENT > GROUND DIRECTIONAL >
GROUND DIRECTIONAL 1> GROUND DIRECTIONAL 2 > GROUND DIRECTIONAL 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Maximum Torque Angle MTA -45 1 Deg [-90 : +90]
Operation Direction Direction FORWARD N/A [FORWARD – REVERSE]
Polarization type Polarization VO N/A [V0 – IP – V0+IP – V0*IP ]
Block logic type Block Logic PERMISSION N/A [BLOCK – PERMISSION]
Polarization voltage threshold Pol V Threshold 10 1V [0 : 300]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > SENSITIVE GROUND CURRENT > SENSITIVE GROUND TOC
SENSITIVE GROUND TOC 1> SENSITIVE GROUND TOC 2 > SENSITIVE GROUND TOC 3

SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE USER


VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Input type Input PHASOR(DFT) N/A [PHASOR – RMS]
Pickup level Pickup Level 0.050 0.001 A [0.005 : 16.000]
Curve shape Curve IEEE Ext Inv N/A [See list of curves]
Time Dial TD Multiplier 1.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]

Reset type Reset INSTANTANEOUS N/A [INSTANTANEOUS –


LINEAR]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-19


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > SENSITIVE GROUND CURRENT > SENSITIVE GROUND IOC
SENSITIVE GROUND IOC 1> SENSITIVE GROUND IOC 2 > SENSITIVE GROUND IOC 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Input type Input PHASOR(DFT) N/A [PHASOR – RMS]
Pickup level Pickup Level 0.100 0.001 A [0.005 : 16.000]
Trip time Trip Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Reset time Reset Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > SENSITIVE GROUND CURRENT > ISOLATED GROUND IOC
ISOLATED GROUND IOC 1> ISOLATED GROUND IOC 2 > ISOLATED GROUND IOC 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Function Permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
High Voltage level Vh Level 20 1V [2 : 70]
Low Current level Il LEVEL 0.005 0.001 A [0.005 : 0.400]
Low Voltage level Vl LEVEL 2 1V [2 : 70]
High Current level Ih LEVEL 0.025 0.001 A [0.005 : 0.400]
Operation time Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Deviation time to instantaneous Time to inst 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > SENSITIVE GROUND CURRENT > SENSITIVE GROUND DIRECTIONAL >
SENSITIVE GROUND DIRECTIONAL 1> SENSITIVE GROUND DIRECTIONAL 2 > SENSITIVE GROUND DIRECTIONAL 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Maximum Torque Angle MTA -45 1 Deg [-90 : +90]
Operation Direction Direction FORWARD N/A [FORWARD – REVERSE]
Block logic type Block Logic PERMISSION N/A [BLOCK – PERMISSION]
Polarization voltage threshold Pol V Threshold 10 1V [0 : 300]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > NEGATIVE SEQUENCE CURRENT > NEGATIVE SEQUENCE TOC >
NEGATIVE SEQUENCE TOC 1> NEGATIVE SEQUENCE TOC 2 > NEGATIVE SEQUENCE TOC 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
D Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
VALUE

Pickup level Pickup Level 1.00 0.01 A [0.05 : 160.00]


Curve shape Curve IEEE Ext Inv N/A [See list of curves]
Time Dial TD Multiplier 1.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
[INSTANTANEOUS –
Reset type Reset INSTANTANEOUS N/A
LINEAR]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

D-20 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > VOLTAGE ELEMENTS > PHASE UV >
PHASE UV 1> PHASE UV 2 > PHASE UV 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
[PHASE-PHASE, PHASE-
Input mode Mode PHASE-PHASE N/A GROUND]
Pickup Level Pickup Level 10 1V [3 : 300]
[DEFINITE TIME –
Curve shape Curve DEFINITE TIME N/A INVERSE TIME]
Time Dial Delay 10.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Minimum Voltage Threshold Minimum Voltage 5 1V [0 : 300]
[ANY PHASE – TWO
Operation logic Logic ANY PHASE N/A PHASES – ALL PHASES]
Supervision by breaker status Supervised by 52 DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > VOLTAGE ELEMENTS > PHASE OV >
PHASE OV 1> PHASE OV 2 > PHASE OV 3

SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE USER


VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Pickup Level Pickup Level 10 1V [3 : 300]
Trip time Trip Delay 10.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Reset time Reset Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
[ANY PHASE – TWO
Operation logic Logic ANY PHASE N/A
PHASES – ALL PHASES]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > VOLTAGE ELEMENTS >


>NEUTRAL OV HIGH > NEUTRAL OV HIGH 1> NEUTRAL OV HIGH 2 > NEUTRAL OV HIGH 3
>NEUTRAL OV LOW > NEUTRAL OV LOW 1> NEUTRAL OV LOW 2 > NEUTRAL OV LOW 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Pickup Level Pickup Level 10 1V [3 : 300]
Trip time Trip Delay 10.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Reset time Reset Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
D
SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > VOLTAGE ELEMENTS>NEGATIVE SEQUENCE OV >
NEGATIVE SEQUENCE OV 1> NEGATIVE SEQUENCE OV 2 > NEGATIVE SEQUENCE OV 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Pickup Level Pickup Level 10 1V [3 : 300]
Trip time Trip Delay 10.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Reset time Reset Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-21


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS >VOLTAGE ELEMENTS>AUXILIARY OV


AUXILIARY OV 1> AUXILIARY OV 2 > AUXILIARY OV 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Pickup Level Pickup Level 10 1V [3 : 300]
Trip Time Trip Delay 10.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]]
Reset Time Reset Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS >VOLTAGE ELEMENTS>AUXILIARY UV


AUXILIARY UV 1> AUXILIARY UV 2 > AUXILIARY UV 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Pickup Level Pickup Level 10 1V [3 : 300]
[DEFINITE TIME –
Curve shape Curve DEFINITE TIME N/A INVERSE TIME]
Time Dial Delay 10.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > POWER > FORWARD POWER


FORWARD POWER 1> FORWARD POWER 2 > FORWARD POWER 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Block from off-line Blk Time After Close 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Pickup level for stage 1 Stage 1 Tap 10.00 0.01MW [0.00 : 10000.00]
Trip time for stage 1 Stage 1 Time 60.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Pickup level for stage 2 Stage 2 Tap 20.00 0.01MW [0.00 : 10000.00]
Trip time for stage 2 Stage 2 Time 60.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

D-22 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > POWER > DIRECTIONAL POWER>


DIRECTIONAL POWER 1> DIRECTIONAL POWER 2 > DIRECTIONAL POWER 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Block from off-line Blk Time After Close 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Directional Angle for stage 1 Dir Power Angle 1 0.00 0.01 Deg [0.00 : 359.99]
Pickup level for stage 1 Stage 1 Tap 10.00 0.01MW [-10000.00 : 10000.00]
Trip time for stage 1 Stage 1 Time 60.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Directional Angle for stage 2 Dir Power Angle 2 0.00 1 Deg [0.00 : 359.99]
Pickup level for stage 2 Stage 2 Tap 20.00 0.01MW [-10000.00 : 10000.00]
Trip time for stage 2 Stage 2 Time 60.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > PROTECTION ELEMENTS > POWER


WATT GND FLT HIGH 1> WATT GND FLT HIGH 2 > WATT GND FLT HIGH 3
WATT GND FLT LOW 1> WATT GND FLT LOW 2 > WATT GND FLT LOW 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED-ENABLED]
Supervision minimum voltage Voltage Pickup Level 2 0.01 V [2.00 : 70.00]
Source of operating current. Current selection IN N/A [IN-IG]
Pickup Level for Overcurrent OC Pickup Level 0,005 0.001A [0.005 : 0.400]
Pickup Delay for Overcurrent OC Pickup Delay 0,2 0.01 s [0.00 : 600.00]
Pickup Level for operating Power Power Pickup 0,01 0.01 W [0.01 : 4.50]
Max torque angle MTA 0 1 Deg [0 : 360]
Pickup Delay for Operating Power Power Pickup Delay 0,2 0.01 s [0.00 : 600.00]
Curve shape Curve DEFINITE TIME N/A [DEFINITE TIME -
INVERSE TIME - USER
CURVE A - USER CURVE
B - USER CURVE C -
USER CURVE D]
Multiplier Multiplier 1 0.01 s [0.02 : 2.00]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Event DISABLED N/A [DISABLED-ENABLED]

SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > SETTING GROUP


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Setting Grouping Permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
[GROUP 1 – GROUP 2 –
Active Group Active Group GROUP 1 N/A
GROUP 3]
Snapshot Event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
D
SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > UNDERFREQUENCY
UNDERFREQUENCY 1 > UNDERFREQUENCY 2 > UNDERFREQUENCY 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Pickup level Pickup Level 49.50 0.01 Hz [20.00 : 65.00]
Trip time Trip Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Reset time Reset Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Minimum voltage threshold Minimum Voltage 30 1V [10 : 300]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-23


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > OVERFREQUENCY


OVERFREQUENCY 1 > OVERFREQUENCY 2 > OVERFREQUENCY 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Pickup level Pickup Level 50.50 0.01 Hz [20.00 : 65.00]
Trip time Trip Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Reset time Reset Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Minimum voltage threshold Minimum Voltage 30 1V [10 : 300]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > SYNCHROCHECK


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Dead bus voltage level Dead Bus Level 10.00 0.01 V [0.00 : 300.00]
Live bus voltage level Live Bus Level 50.00 0.01 V [0.00 : 300.00]
Dead line voltage level Dead Line Level 10.00 0.01 V [0.00 : 300.00]
Live line voltage level Live Line Level 50.00 0.01 V [0.00 : 300.00]
Voltage Difference Max Volt Difference 10.00 0.01 V [2.00 : 300.00]
Angle Difference Max Angle Difference 10.0 0.1 Deg [2.0 : 80.0]
Frequency Slip Max Freq Difference 20 10 mHz [10 : 5000]
Breaker Closing time Time 0.50 0.01 s [0.01 : 600.00]
Dead Line – Dead Bus Function
permission DL-DB Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

Live Line – Dead Bus Function LL-DB Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
permission
Dead Line – Live Bus Function
permission DL-LB Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > AUTORECLOSE

SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE USER


VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Maximum Number of shots Max Number Shots 1 N/A [1 : 4]
Dead time 1 Dead Time 1 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Dead time 2 Dead Time 2 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Dead time 3 Dead Time 3 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]

D Dead time 4
Reclaim time or reset lockout delay
Dead Time 4
Reclaim Time
0.00
0.00
0.01 s
0.01 s
[0.00 : 900.00]
[0.00 : 900.00]
Reclose conditions permission Cond. Permission DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Hold time Hold Time 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Reset time Reset Time 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

D-24 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > BREAKER FAILURE


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Supervision (retrip) pickup level Supervision Pickup 1.00 0.01 A [0.05 : 160.00]
Hiset pickup level Hiset Pickup 5.00 0.01 A [0.05 : 160.00]
Lowset pickup level Lowset Pickup 2.00 0.01 A [0.05 : 160.00]
Internal arc pickup level Internal Arc Pickup 0.10 0.01 A [0.05 : 160.00]
Internal arc time delay Internal Arc Delay 10.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Retrip time delay Supervision Delay 10.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Hiset time delay HiSet Delay 10.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Lowset time delay LowSet Delay 10.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Second stage time delay 2nd Step Delay 10.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
WITHOUT current element time delay No Current Delay 10.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > VT FUSE FAILURE)


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > BROKEN CONDUCTOR


BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 >BROKEN CONDUCTOR 2 >BROKEN CONDUCTOR 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Tap Level in percentage of I2/I1 Tap 20 0.10% [20.0 : 100.0]
Trip Time Trip Delay 60 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Current Inhibition Level setting Operation Threshold 0.005 0.001 A [0.000 : 1.000]

SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > LOCKED ROTOR


LOCKED ROTOR 1 >LOCKED ROTOR 2 >LOCKED ROTOR 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Input type Input PHASOR(DFT) N/A [PHASOR – RMS]
Full load current Full Load Current 0.50 KA [0.10 : 10.00] D
Pickup level Pickup Level 1.01 N/A [1.01 : 109.00]
Trip time Trip Delay 0.00 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Reset time Reset Delay 0.00 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-25


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > PULSE COUNTERS


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Pulse counter enabling setting CntPulses Enabled X DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Name of the pulse counter CntPulses Name X Pulse Counter 1 N/A N/A
Multiplier factor for the pulse counter CntPulses Factor X 1.000 0.001 [0.000 : 65000.000]
Overflow value for the pulse counter CntPulses Overflow X 65535 1 [0 : 1000000]
CntPulses Board
Board selection for the pulse counter F N/A [F,G,H,I]
Origin X

Input index inside the selected board CntPulses Input Origin 1 1 [1 : 32]
X
Note: X is the pulse counter index, up to 8.

SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > ANALOG COMPARATORS


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Generic Analog Function Permission Analog Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Analog Snapshot
Generic Snapshot Events Generation DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Events
Analog Input Value Selection Analog Input X None N/A [All available analog values]
Analog Maximum Threshold Value Analog Maximum X 1.000 0.001 [-100000.000 : 100000.000]
Analog Minimum Threshold Value Analog Minimum X 1.000 0.001 [-100000.000 : 100000.000]
Analog Delay for Activation Signal Analog Delay X 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 900.00]
Analog Hysteresis for the Deadband Analog Hysteresis X 1.0 0.1 [0.0 : 50.0]
Analog Direction for Activation Inside Analog Direction X OUT N/A [IN-OUT]
or Outside the Deadband
Note: X is the analog comparator index, up to 20

SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > FREQUENCY RATE OF CHANGE


FREQUENCY RATE OF CHANGE 1 > FREQUENCY RATE OF CHANGE 2 > FREQUENCY RATE OF CHANGE 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function Permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
[INCREASING -
Direction of the frequency change Freq. Rate Trend INCREASING N/A DECREASING - BI-
DIRECTIONAL]
Operation Value in Hz/s Freq. Rate Pickup 0.50 0.01 Hz/s [0.10 : 10.00]
Minimum required voltage in %
Freq. Rate OV Supv 40.00 0.01% [0.00 : 110.00]
nominal voltage
Minimum Frequency Threshold Freq. Rate Min 45.00 0.01 Hz [20.00 : 80.00]
Maximum Frequency Threshold Freq. Rate Max 65.00 0.01 Hz [20.00 : 80.00]
Frequency rate Trip Delay Freq. Rate Delay 0.00 0.01 s [0.00 : 60.00]
Snapshot Events Generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

D SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > LOAD ENCROACHMENT


LOAD ENCROACHMENT 1 > LOAD ENCROACHMENT 2 > LOAD ENCROACHMENT 3
USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function Permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]
Minimum positive-sequence voltage
Min. Voltage 25.00 0.01 V [0.00 : 300.00]
required
Impedance reach of the element Reach 1.00 0.01 Ohm [0.02 : 250.00]
Angle (Size of the blocking region) Angle 5 1 Deg [5 : 50]
Trip Time Pickup Delay 0.000 0.001 s [0.000 : 65.535]
Reset Time Reset Delay 0.000 0.001 s [0.000 : 65.535]
Snapshot Events Generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

D-26 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > MAX. NUMBERS OF STARTS


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE VALUE
Function Permission Function DISABLED N/A [DISABLED- ENABLED]
Motor Full Load Current Full Load Amps 5.0 0.1 A [0.5: 10.0]
Stop condition supervised by breaker Breaker Supervision DISABLED N/A [DISABLED- ENABLED]
Min. Stop Time 0.0 0.1s [0.0: 900.0]
Number of Starts per tour Number of Starts 5 1 [0: 100]
Reset counter setting Reset Counter DISABLED N/A [DISABLED- ENABLED]
Snapshot Event Generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED- ENABLED]

SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > DIGITAL COUNTERS


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Function permission DigCnt 1 Function DISABLED NA
Digital Counter 1 name DigCnt 1 Name NA
[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 1 Preset DigCnt 1 Preset 0 1 2147483647]
[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 1 Compare DigCnt 1 Compare 0 1 2147483647]
Function permission DigCnt 2 Function DISABLED NA
Digital Counter 2 name DigCnt 2 Name NA
[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 2 Preset DigCnt 2 Preset 0 1 2147483647]
[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 2 Compare DigCnt 2 Compare 0 1 2147483647]
Function permission DigCnt 3 Function DISABLED NA
Digital Counter 3 name DigCnt 3 Name NA
[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 3 Preset DigCnt 3 Preset 0 1 2147483647]
[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 3 Compare DigCnt 3 Compare 0 1 2147483647]
Function permission DigCnt 4 Function DISABLED NA
Digital Counter 4 name DigCnt 4 Name NA
[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 4 Preset DigCnt 4 Preset 0 1 2147483647]
[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 4 Compare DigCnt 4 Compare 0 1 2147483647]
Function permission DigCnt 5 Function DISABLED NA
Digital Counter 5 name DigCnt 5 Name NA
[-2147483648 : D
Digital counter 5 Preset DigCnt 5 Preset 0 1 2147483647]
[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 5 Compare DigCnt 5 Compare 0 1 2147483647]
Function permission DigCnt 6 Function DISABLED NA
Digital Counter 6 name DigCnt 6 Name NA
[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 6 Preset DigCnt 6 Preset 0 1 2147483647]
[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 6 Compare DigCnt 6 Compare 0 1 2147483647]
Function permission DigCnt 7 Function DISABLED NA
Digital Counter 7 name DigCnt 7 Name NA

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-27


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 7 Preset DigCnt 7 Preset 0 1 2147483647]
[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 7 Compare DigCnt 7 Compare 0 1 2147483647]
Function permission DigCnt 8 Function DISABLED NA
Digital Counter 8 name DigCnt 8 Name NA
[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 8 Preset DigCnt 8 Preset 0 1 2147483647]
[-2147483648 :
Digital counter 8 Compare DigCnt 8 Compare 0 1 2147483647]
Snapshot Event Generation Snapshot Events ENABLED NA [ENABLED; DISABLED]

SETPOINT > CONTROL ELEMENTS > COAL LOAD PICK UP

SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE USER


VALUE
Function permsision Cold Load Function DISABLED NA [ENABLED; DISABLED]
Cold Load Pickup Outage Time Cold Outage Time 20 min [1 : 1000]
Cold Load Pickup Blocking Time Cold Blocking Time 5 s [1 : 1000]
Snapshot Event Generation Cold Load Events ENABLED NA [ENABLED; DISABLED]

D-28 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS

SETPOINT > INPUTS/OUTPUTS > CONTACT I/O >


BOARD F > BOARD G >BOARD H>BOARD J

SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE USER


VALUE
I/O board type (available only for CIO I/O Board Type_X NONE N/A [NONE,
modules) 16 INP + 8OUT,
8 INP + 8OUT + SUPV
32 INP
16 INP + 8 ANA]
Input activation voltage threshold Voltage Threshold 80 1V [10 : 230]
Group A A_X
Input activation voltage threshold Voltage Threshold 80 1V [10 : 230]
Group B B_X
Input activation voltage threshold Voltage Threshold 80 1V [10 : 230]
Group C C_X
Input activation voltage threshold Voltage Threshold 80 1V [10 : 230]
Group D D_X
Debounce time for Group A Debounce Time A_X 15 1 ms [1 : 50]
Debounce time for Group B Debounce Time B_X 15 1 ms [1 : 50]
Debounce time for Group C Debounce Time C_X 15 1 ms [1 : 50]
Debounce time for Group D Debounce Time D_X 15 1 ms [1 : 50]
Input type Input Type_X_CCY POSITIVE N/A [POSITIVE-EDGE,
(CCY) NEGATIVE-EDGE,
POSITIVE,
NEGATIVE]
Input signal time delay Delay Input 0 1 ms [0 : 60000]
Time_X_CCY (CCY)
Output logic type Output Logic_X_0Z POSITIVE N/A [POSITIVE,
NEGATIVE]
Output type Output Type_X_0Z NORMAL N/A [NORMAL,
PULSE,
LATCH]
Output pulse length Pulse Output 10000 1 ms [0 : 60000]
Time_X_0Z
Analog Inputs Range Range_X_0Z NONE N/A [NONE,
-1 to 0mA,
0 to 1 mA,
-1 to 1 mA,
0 to 5 mA,
0 to 10 mA]
Minimum Value Min_Value_X_0Z 0.00 0.01 [ -9999.99 : 9999.99]
Maximum Value Max_Value_X_0Z 0.00 0.01 [ -9999.99 : 9999.99]
Snapshot event generation Snapshot Events ENABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-29


D.1 FACTORY DEFAULT SETTINGS APPENDIX D

NOTE 2: DESCRIPTION OF X, Y AND Z IN INPUT/OUTPUT BOARDS


F, G, H or J, the I/O board name, depending on the Relay model.
X F and G are internal Relay boards, and H and J are additional boards available in CIO modules
(remote Bus CAN I/O module)
I/O BOARD TYPE

ENERVISTA 650
ASSOCIATED DIGIT SETUP BOARD BOARD TYPE
SETTINGS

For the I/O board selection in the relay 0 NONE None


model:
1 16 INP+ 8 OUT Mixed
8 INP +8 OUT
2 Supervision
+SUPV
4 32 INP 32 digital inputs
5 16 INP + 8 ANA 16 digital inputs + 8 analog inputs
Is the name used for inputs in I/O boards
Mixed, 16 digital inputs: CC1….CC16
CCY
Supervision: 8 digital inputs: CC1,..., CC8
32 INP: 32 digital inputs; CC1,...,CC32
Is the name used for the different outputs in I/O boards, 8 outputs available for any of the two
0Z
types of board (01,…., 08)

SETPOINT > INPUTS/OUTPUTS > REMOTE COMMS


USER
SETTING DESCRIPTION NAME DEFAULT VALUE STEP RANGE
VALUE
Remote comms selection Remote Comms NONE N/A [NONE – GSSE – GOOSE]

SETTING DESCRIPTION FOR GSSE

Remote comms selection Remote Comms GSSE N/A [NONE – GSSE – GOOSE]
Device Identification 650 ID F650 N/A
Hold time signal send by the
Hold Time 10000 1 ms [1000 : 60000]
transmiting device

Snapshot Events Generation Snapshot Events DISABLED N/A [DISABLED – ENABLED]


Remote Out
Remote Device Description Remote Device X Remote Device X N/A
[DNA-1 to DNA-32 –
Bit Pair Selection Bit Pair X None N/A UserSt-1 to UserSt-64]
[OFF – ON – LATEST OFF
Default Value Selection Default Value X OFF N/A
– LATEST ON]
SETTING DESCRIPTION FOR GOOSE
Remote comms selection Remote Comms GOOSE N/A [NONE – GSSE – GOOSE]
Default Value Selection Default Value X OFF N/A [OFF – ON – LATEST OFF

D Note: X is the Remote Device index, up to 32


– LATEST ON]

LIST OF TIME OVERCURRENT CURVES AVAILABLE IN


F650
IEEE extremely/very/moderately inverse
IEC Curve A/B/C/Long-Time Inverse/ Short-Time Inverse
IAC extremely/very/normally/moderately inverse
ANSI extremely/very/normally/moderately inverse
I2t
Definite time
Rectifier curve
User Curve - FlexCurve™ A/B/C/D

D-30 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.2 FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATION

D.2FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATION

NOTE:
SOURCE COLUMN:
This columns allow selecting the simple or complex (OR signal or Virtual output) operand that actives the selected
elements on relay configuration
If more than one operands are selected, the relay performs an OR gate with them to activate the selected element.
SIGNAL LOGIC COLUMN:
Refers to each individual signal selected on its left. NOT legend means that the refered signal is inverted
SOURCE LOGIC COLUMN:
Refers to the whole SOURCE signal selected on its left. NOT legend means that SOURCE signal is inverted
If more than one operand were selected, the OR gate output is inverted

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>OUTPUTS
OUTPUT SOURCE SOURCE LOGIC LOGIC
CONT OP OPER_F_01 VO_000_PROTECTION_ALARM -
VO_046_59P_PKP -
CONT OP OPER_F_02
VO_045_27P_PKP -
CONT OP OPER_F_03 VO_048_50G_PKP -
CONT OP OPER_F_04 VO_049_51G_PKP -
VO_051_50PH_PKP -
CONT OP OPER_F_05
VO_050_50PL_PKP -
CONT OP OPER_F_06 VO_053_51P_PKP -
OPERATION BIT 1 -
CONT OP OPER_F_07
AR CLOSE BREAKER -
OPERATION BIT 2 -
CONT OP OPER_F_08
VO_083_GENERAL_TRIP -

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>LEDS
LED SOURCE SOURCE LOGIC LOGIC LED NAME
LED01 VO_000_PROTECTION ALARM - PROT ALARM
LED02 VO_083_GENERAL_TRIP - TRIP
LED03 VO_019_PHASE_OVERCURRENT_TRIP - 50/51P TRIP
LED04 VO_069_GROUND_OVERCURRENT_TRIP - 50/51G TRIP
VO_074_59P_TRIP
LED05 - - 27/59 TRIP
VO_073_27P_TRIP
LED06 VO_085_GENERAL_PKP - PICKUP
LED07 VO_007_PHASE_OVERCURRENT_PKP - 50/51P PICKUP
LED08 VO_009_GROUND_OVERCURRENT_PKP - 50/51G PICKUP
LED09 VO_045_27P_PKP - 27 PICKUP D
LED10 VO_046_59P_PKP - 59 PICKUP
LED11 AR READY - 79 READY
LED12 AR RCL IN PROGRESS - 79 IN-PROG
LED13 AR BLOCK - 79 BLOCK
LED14 AR CONDS INPUT NOT 79 INHIBIT
LED15 AR LOCKOUT - 79 LOCKOUT
SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>PROTECTION ELEMENTS
PROTECTION ELEMENT SOURCE SIGNAL LOGIC SOURCE LOGIC
LED RESET INPUT OPERATION BIT 3
CHANGE LOCAL-
Not Configured
REMOTE
CHANGE OP BLOCKED Not Configured

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-31


D.2 FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATION APPENDIX D

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>PROTECTION ELEMENTS


PROTECTION ELEMENT SOURCE SIGNAL LOGIC SOURCE LOGIC
HMI BACKLIGHT ON Not Configured
HMI BACKLIGHT OFF Not Configured
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC1 HIGH A BLK
PHASE DIR1 A OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 1
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC1 HIGH B BLK
PHASE DIR1 B OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 1
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC1 HIGH C BLK
PHASE DIR1 C OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 1
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC2 HIGH A BLK
PHASE DIR2 A OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 1
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC2 HIGH B BLK
PHASE DIR2 B OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 1
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC2 HIGH C BLK
PHASE DIR2 C OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 1
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC3 HIGH A BLK
PHASE DIR3 A OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 1
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC3 HIGH B BLK
PHASE DIR3 B OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 1
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC3 HIGH C BLK
D PHASE DIR3 C OP
LATCHED VIRT IP 1
NOT

GROUP 1 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC1 LOW A BLK
PHASE DIR1 A OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 2
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC1 LOW B BLK
PHASE DIR1 B OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 2

D-32 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.2 FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATION

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>PROTECTION ELEMENTS


PROTECTION ELEMENT SOURCE SIGNAL LOGIC SOURCE LOGIC
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC1 LOW C BLK
PHASE DIR1 C OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 2
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC2 LOW A BLK
PHASE DIR2 A OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 2
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC2 LOW B BLK
PHASE DIR2 B OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 2
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC2 LOW C BLK
PHASE DIR2 C OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 2
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC3 LOW A BLK
PHASE DIR3 A OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 2
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC3 LOW B BLK
PHASE DIR3 B OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 2
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC2 (50P BLOCK)(CC2)
PH IOC3 LOW C BLK
PHASE DIR3 C OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 2
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
NEUTRAL IOC1 BLOCK
NEUTRAL DIR1 OP NOT
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
NEUTRAL IOC2 BLOCK
NEUTRAL DIR2 OP NOT
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
NEUTRAL IOC3 BLOCK
NEUTRAL DIR3 OP NOT
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC5 (50G BLOCK)(CC5)
GROUND IOC1 BLOCK
GROUND DIR1 OP
LATCHED VIRT IP 3
NOT
D
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC5 (50G BLOCK)(CC5)
GROUND IOC2 BLOCK
GROUND DIR2 OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 3
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC5 (50G BLOCK)(CC5)
GROUND IOC3 BLOCK
GROUND DIR3 OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 3
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
SENS GND IOC1 BLK SENS GND DIR1 OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 4

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-33


D.2 FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATION APPENDIX D

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>PROTECTION ELEMENTS


PROTECTION ELEMENT SOURCE SIGNAL LOGIC SOURCE LOGIC
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
SENS GND IOC2 BLK SENS GND DIR2 OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 4
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
SENS GND IOC3 BLK SENS GND DIR3 OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 4
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC1 HIGH A BLK
PHASE DIR1 A OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 5
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC1 HIGH B BLK
PHASE DIR1 B OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 5
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC1 HIGH C BLK
PHASE DIR1 C OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 5
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC2 HIGH A BLK
PHASE DIR2 A OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 5
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC2 HIGH B BLK
PHASE DIR2 B OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 5
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC2 HIGH C BLK
PHASE DIR2 C OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 5
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC3 HIGH A BLK
PHASE DIR3 A OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 5
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC3 HIGH B BLK
D PHASE DIR3 B OP
LATCHED VIRT IP 5
NOT

GROUP 3 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC3 HIGH C BLK
PHASE DIR3 C OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 5
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
NEUTRAL TOC1 BLOCK
NEUTRAL DIR1 OP NOT
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
NEUTRAL TOC2 BLOCK
NEUTRAL DIR2 OP NOT
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
NEUTRAL TOC3 BLOCK
NEUTRAL DIR3 OP NOT

D-34 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.2 FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATION

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>PROTECTION ELEMENTS


PROTECTION ELEMENT SOURCE SIGNAL LOGIC SOURCE LOGIC
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC6 (51G BLOCK)(CC6)
GROUND TOC1 BLOCK
GROUND DIR1 OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 7
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC6 (51G BLOCK)(CC6)
GROUND TOC2 BLOCK
GROUND DIR2 OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 7
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC6 (51G BLOCK)(CC6)
GROUND TOC3 BLOCK
GROUND DIR3 OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 7
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
SENS GND TOC1 BLOCK SENS GND DIR1 OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 8
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
SENS GND TOC2 BLOCK SENS GND DIR2 OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 8
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
SENS GND TOC3 BLOCK SENS GND DIR3 OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 8
PHASE UV1 BLOCK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
PHASE UV2 BLOCK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
PHASE UV3 BLOCK GROUP 3 BLOCKED
NEG SEQ OV1 BLOCK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
NEG SEQ OV2 BLOCK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
NEG SEQ OV3 BLOCK GROUP 3 BLOCKED
THERMAL1 BLOCK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
THERMAL2 BLOCK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
THERMAL3 BLOCK GROUP 3 BLOCKED
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
PHASE DIR1 BLK INP CONT IP_F_CC4 (67P BLOCK)(CC4)
LATCHED VIRT IP 9
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
PHASE DIR2 BLK INP CONT IP_F_CC4 (67P BLOCK)(CC4)
LATCHED VIRT IP 9
GROUP 3 BLOCKED D
PHASE DIR3 BLK INP CONT IP_F_CC4 (67P BLOCK)(CC4)
LATCHED VIRT IP 9
NEUTRAL DIR1 BLK INP GROUP 1 BLOCKED
NEUTRAL DIR2 BLK INP GROUP 2 BLOCKED
NEUTRAL DIR3 BLK INP GROUP 3 BLOCKED
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
GROUND DIR1 BLK INP
LATCHED VIRT IP 10
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
GROUND DIR2 BLK INP
LATCHED VIRT IP 10
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
GROUND DIR3 BLK INP
LATCHED VIRT IP 10

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-35


D.2 FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATION APPENDIX D

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>PROTECTION ELEMENTS


PROTECTION ELEMENT SOURCE SIGNAL LOGIC SOURCE LOGIC
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
NEUTRAL OV1 HIGH BLK
LATCHED VIRT IP 12
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
NEUTRAL OV2 HIGH BLK
LATCHED VIRT IP 12
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
NEUTRAL OV3 HIGH BLK
LATCHED VIRT IP 12
NEUTRAL OV1 LOW BLK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
NEUTRAL OV2 LOW BLK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
NEUTRAL OV3 LOW BLK GROUP 3 BLOCKED
AUXILIARY UV1 BLOCK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
AUXILIARY UV2 BLOCK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
AUXILIARY UV3 BLOCK GROUP 3 BLOCKED
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
PHASE OV1 BLOCK
LATCHED VIRT IP 11
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
PHASE OV2 BLOCK
LATCHED VIRT IP 11
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
PHASE OV3 BLOCK
LATCHED VIRT IP 11
AUXILIARY OV1 BLOCK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
AUXILIARY OV2 BLOCK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
AUXILIARY OV3 BLOCK GROUP 3 BLOCKED
NEG SEQ TOC1 BLOCK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
NEG SEQ TOC2 BLOCK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
NEG SEQ TOC3 BLOCK GROUP 3 BLOCKED
OVERFREQ1 BLOCK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
OVERFREQ2 BLOCK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
OVERFREQ3 BLOCK GROUP 3 BLOCKED
UNDERFREQ1 BLOCK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
UNDERFREQ2 BLOCK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
UNDERFREQ3 BLOCK GROUP 3 BLOCKED
SETT GROUPS BLOCK Not Configured
BROKEN CONDUCT1
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
BLK
BROKEN CONDUCT2
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
BLK
BROKEN CONDUCT3
BLK GROUP 3 BLOCKED

D ISOLATED GND1 BLK


GROUP 1 BLOCKED
SENS GND DIR1 OP NOT
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
ISOLATED GND2 BLK
SENS GND DIR2 OP NOT
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
ISOLATED GND3 BLK
SENS GND DIR3 OP NOT
SENS GND DIR1 BLK IP GROUP 1 BLOCKED
SENS GND DIR2 BLK IP GROUP 2 BLOCKED
SENS GND DIR3 BLK IP GROUP 3 BLOCKED
FWD PWR1 BLOCK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
FWD PWR2 BLOCK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
FWD PWR3 BLOCK GROUP 3 BLOCKED

D-36 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.2 FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATION

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>PROTECTION ELEMENTS


PROTECTION ELEMENT SOURCE SIGNAL LOGIC SOURCE LOGIC
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC1 LOW A BLK
PHASE DIR1 A OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 6
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC1 LOW B BLK
PHASE DIR1 B OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 6
GROUP 1 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC1 LOW C BLK
PHASE DIR1 C OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 6
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC2 LOW A BLK
PHASE DIR2 A OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 6
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC2 LOW B BLK
PHASE DIR2 B OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 6
GROUP 2 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC2 LOW C BLK
PHASE DIR2 C OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 6
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC3 LOW A BLK
PHASE DIR3 A OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 6
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC3 LOW B BLK
PHASE DIR3 B OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 6
GROUP 3 BLOCKED
CONT IP_F_CC3 (51P BLOCK)(CC3)
PH TOC3 LOW C BLK
PHASE DIR3 C OP NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 6
DIR PWR1 BLOCK GROUP 1 BLOCKED D
DIR PWR2 BLOCK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
DIR PWR3 BLOCK GROUP 3 BLOCKED
LOCKED ROTOR1 BLK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
LOCKED ROTOR2 BLK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
LOCKED ROTOR3 BLK GROUP 3 BLOCKED
FREQ RATE1 BLOCK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
FREQ RATE2 BLOCK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
FREQ RATE3 BLOCK GROUP 3 BLOCKED
LOAD ENCR1 BLOCK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
LOAD ENCR2 BLOCK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
LOAD ENCR3 BLOCK GROUP 3 BLOCKED

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-37


D.2 FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATION APPENDIX D

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>PROTECTION ELEMENTS


PROTECTION ELEMENT SOURCE SIGNAL LOGIC SOURCE LOGIC
32N1 HIGH BLOCK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
32N2 HIGH BLOCK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
32N3 HIGH BLOCK GROUP 3 BLOCKED
32N1 LOW BLOCK GROUP 1 BLOCKED
32N2 LOW BLOCK GROUP 2 BLOCKED
32N3 LOW BLOCK GROUP 3 BLOCKED
THERMAL1 A RST OPERATION BIT 4
THERMAL1 B RST OPERATION BIT 4
THERMAL1 C RST OPERATION BIT 4
THERMAL2 A RST OPERATION BIT 4
THERMAL2 B RST OPERATION BIT 4
THERMAL2 C RST OPERATION BIT 4
THERMAL3 A RST OPERATION BIT 4
THERMAL3 B RST OPERATION BIT 4
THERMAL3 C RST OPERATION BIT 4
Synchrocheck BLK INP Not Configured
CONT IP_F_CC8 (79 BLOCK)(CC8)
AR LEVEL BLOCK
LATCHED VIRT IP 14
AR PULSE BLOCK Not Configured
AR PULSE UNBLOCK Not Configured
VO_083_GENERAL_TRIP
AR INITIATE CONT IP_F_CC7 (79 INITIATE)(CC7)
LATCHED VIRT IP 13
SYNCHK CLOSE PERM NOT
AR CONDS INPUT NOT
LATCHED VIRT IP 15
BKR FAIL INITIATE Not Configured
GROUP 1 ACT ON Not Configured
GROUP 2 ACT ON Not Configured
GROUP 3 ACT ON Not Configured
FAULT REPORT TRIGG VO_083_GENERAL_TRIP
CLEAR FAULT REPORTS Not Configured
DEMAND TRIGGER INP Not Configured
DEMAND RESET INP OPERATION BIT 7
FREEZE ENERGY CNT Not Configured
UNFREEZE ENERGY
Not Configured
CNT
RESET ENERGY CNT OPERATION BIT 6
D RESET KI2t COUNTERS OPERATION BIT 5
RESET BKR COUNTERS OPERATION BIT 5

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>OSCILLOGRAPHY
DIGITAL CHANNEL NAME SOURCE SIGNAL LOGIC SOURCE LOGIC
DIG_CHANNEL#1 TRIP VO_083_GENERAL_TRIP
DIG_CHANNEL#2 50/51P TRIP VO_019_PHASE_OVERCURRENT_TRIP

DIG_CHANNEL#3 50/51G TRIP VO_069_GROUND_OVERCURRENT_T


RIP
DIG_CHANNEL#4 27 TRIP VO_073_27P_TRIP
DIG_CHANNEL#5 59 TRIP VO_074_59P_TRIP
DIG_CHANNEL#6 PICKUP VO_085_GENERAL_PKP

D-38 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.2 FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATION

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>OSCILLOGRAPHY
DIGITAL CHANNEL NAME SOURCE SIGNAL LOGIC SOURCE LOGIC
DIG_CHANNEL#7 50/51P PICKUP VO_007_PHASE_OVERCURRENT_PKP
VO_009_GROUND_OVERCURRENT_P
DIG_CHANNEL#8 50/51G PICKUP KP
DIG_CHANNEL#9 27 PICKUP VO_045_27P_PKP
DIG_CHANNEL#10 59 PICKUP VO_046_59P_PKP
DIG_CHANNEL#11 79 READY AR READY
DIG_CHANNEL#12 79 IN-PROG AR RCL IN PROGRESS
DIG_CHANNEL#13 79 BLOCK AR BLOCK
DIG_CHANNEL#14 79 INHIBIT AR CONDS INPUT NOT
DIG_CHANNEL#15 79 LOCKOUT AR LOCKOUT
DIG_CHANNEL#16 Not Configured
OPERATION BIT 8
OSCILLO TRIGGER OSCILLO TRIGGER
VO_083_GENERAL_TRIP

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>OPERATIONS
OPERATION OPERATION TEXT SETTINGS VALUE/SOURCE
INTERLOCK(LOGIC) SYNCHK CLOSE PERM
FINAL STATES AND LOGIC BREAKER CLOSED
FRONT KEY I Key
Operation1 CLOSE BREAKER INPUT Not configured
VIRTUAL OUTPUT Not configured
TIMEOUT 1000
CHANNELS ALL
INTERLOCK(LOGIC) Not configured
FINAL STATES AND(LOGIC) BREAKER OPEN
FRONT KEY O Key
Operation2 OPEN BREAKER INPUT Not configured
VIRTUAL OUTPUT Not configured
TIMEOUT 1000
CHANNELS ALL
INTERLOCK(LOGIC) Not configured
FINAL STATES AND(LOGIC) Not configured
FRONT KEY Not configured
Operation3 LEDS RESET INPUT Not configured
VIRTUAL OUTPUT Not configured
TIMEOUT 500
CHANNELS ALL
INTERLOCK(LOGIC) Not configured D
FINAL STATES AND(LOGIC) Not configured
FRONT KEY Not configured
Operation4 THERMAL RESET INPUT Not configured
VIRTUAL OUTPUT Not configured
TIMEOUT 500
CHANNELS ALL

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-39


D.2 FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATION APPENDIX D

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>OPERATIONS
OPERATION OPERATION TEXT SETTINGS VALUE/SOURCE
INTERLOCK(LOGIC) Not configured
FINAL STATES AND(LOGIC) Not configured
FRONT KEY Not configured
Operation5 BRK COUNTERS INPUT Not configured
RESET
VIRTUAL OUTPUT Not configured
TIMEOUT 500
CHANNELS ALL
INTERLOCK(LOGIC) Not configured
FINAL STATES AND(LOGIC) Not configured
FRONT KEY Not configured
Operation6 ENERGY RESET INPUT Not configured
VIRTUAL OUTPUT Not configured
TIMEOUT 500
CHANNELS ALL
INTERLOCK(LOGIC) Not configured
FINAL STATES AND(LOGIC) Not configured
FRONT KEY Not configured
Operation7 DEMAND RESET INPUT Not configured
VIRTUAL OUTPUT Not configured
TIMEOUT 500
CHANNELS ALL
INTERLOCK(LOGIC) Not configured
FINAL STATES AND(LOGIC) Not configured
FRONT KEY Not configured
Operation8 TRIGGER OSCILLO INPUT Not configured
VIRTUAL OUTPUT Not configured
TIMEOUT 500
CHANNELS ALL
INTERLOCK(LOGIC) Not configured
FINAL STATES AND(LOGIC) Not configured
FRONT KEY Not configured
Operation9 Not configured INPUT Not configured
VIRTUAL OUTPUT Not configured
TIMEOUT Not configured
CHANNELS Not configured
INTERLOCK(LOGIC) Not configured

D FINAL STATES AND(LOGIC)


FRONT KEY
Not configured
Not configured
..... ...... INPUT Not configured
VIRTUAL OUTPUT Not configured
TIMEOUT Not configured
CHANNELS Not configured
INTERLOCK(LOGIC) Not configured
FINAL STATES AND(LOGIC) Not configured
FRONT KEY Not configured
Operation24 Not configured INPUT Not configured
VIRTUAL OUTPUT Not configured
TIMEOUT Not configured
CHANNELS Not configured

D-40 F650 Digital Bay Controller GEK-113000AD


APPENDIX D D.2 FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATION

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>OPERATIONS
OPERATION OPERATION TEXT SETTINGS VALUE/SOURCE

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>EVENTS
EVENT NAME SOURCE SIGNAL LOGIC SOURCE LOGIC
EV1 Not Configured
EV2 Not Configured
... ...
EV128 Not Configured

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>SWITCHGEAR
SWITCHGEAR SETTING VALUE/SOURCE SIGNAL LOGIC SOURCE LOGIC
CONTACTS 52b
OPENING TIME 1000
CLOSING TIME 1000
CONTACT A SOURCE N/A
CONTACT B SOURCE CONT IP_F_CC1 (52b)(CC1)
OPEN TEXT 52 OPEN
ALARM NO
SWITCHGEAR 1 CLOSED TEXT 52 CLOSE
ALARM NO
ERROR 00 TEXT 52 ERROR
ALARM N/A
ERROR 11 TEXT 52 UNDEFINED
ALARM N/A
OPENING INIT OPERATION BIT 2
CLOSING INIT OPERATION BIT 1
CONTACTS Not Configured
OPENING TIME Not Configured
CLOSING TIME Not Configured
CONTACT A SOURCE Not Configured
CONTACT B SOURCE Not Configured
OPEN TEXT Not Configured
ALARM Not Configured
SWITCHGEAR 2 CLOSED TEXT Not Configured
ALARM Not Configured
ERROR 00 TEXT Not Configured
ALARM Not Configured
ERROR 11 TEXT Not Configured D
ALARM Not Configured
OPENING INIT Not Configured
CLOSING INIT Not Configured
... ... ... ... ...

GEK-113000AD F650 Digital Bay Controller D-41


D.2 FACTORY DEFAULT CONFIGURATION APPENDIX D

SETPOINT>RELAY CONFIGURATION>SWITCHGEAR
SWITCHGEAR SETTING VALUE/SOURCE SIGNAL LOGIC SOURCE LOGIC
CONTACTS Not Configured
OPENING TIME Not Configured
CLOSING TIME Not Configured
CONTACT A SOURCE Not Configured
CONTACT B SOURCE Not Configured
OPEN TEXT Not Configured
ALARM Not Configured
SWITCHGEAR 16 CLOSED TEXT Not Configured
ALARM Not Configured
ERROR 00 TEXT Not Configured
ALARM Not Configured
ERROR 11 TEXT Not Configured
ALARM Not Configured
OPENING INIT Not Configured
CLOSING INIT Not Configured

You might also like